UCBH HOLDINGS INC
S-1/A, 1998-09-01
SAVINGS INSTITUTION, FEDERALLY CHARTERED
Previous: WEBQUEST INTERNATIONAL INC, 10SB12G/A, 1998-09-01
Next: UCBH HOLDINGS INC, S-4/A, 1998-09-01




   
    As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on September 1, 1998
                                                     Registration No. 333-58897
    
================================================================================

                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             Washington, D.C. 20549
   
                            PRE-EFFECTIVE AMENDMENT
                                  NO. 1 TO THE
                                    FORM S-1
    
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                        UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                               UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
   ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
   (exact name of registrant as specified in its certificate of incorporation)

   
<TABLE>
<S>                                <C>                               <C>
           DELAWARE                           6035                            94-3072450
- -------------------------------         -----------------            --------------------------------- 
(state or other jurisdiction of         (Primary Standard            (IRS Employer Identification No.) 
incorporation or organization)     Classification Code Number)  
</TABLE>
    
                        
                               711 Van Ness Avenue
                         San Francisco, California 94102
                                 (415) 928-0700
        -----------------------------------------------------------------
               (Address, including zip code, and telephone number,
        including area code, of registrant's principal executive offices)

                                   Tommy S. Wu
                      President and Chief Executive Officer
                             United Commercial Bank
                               711 Van Ness Avenue
                         San Francisco, California 94102
                                 (415) 928-0700
            ---------------------------------------------------------
            (Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number,
                   including area code, of agent for service)

                                   Copies to:
                         Joseph G. Passaic, Jr., Esquire
                            Mary M. Sjoquist, Esquire
                            Geoffrey W. Ryan, Esquire
                                Patton Boggs LLP
                               2550 M Street, N.W.
                             Washington, D.C. 20037
                                 (202) 457-6000

         Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to public: From time
to time after the effective date of this Registration Statement.

         If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be
offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the
Securities Act of 1933, check the following box. /X/

         If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box
and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier
effective registration statement for the same offering. / /

         If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule
462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities
Act registration number of the earlier effective registration statement for the
same offering. / /

         If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule
434, please check the following box. / /
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

=======================================================================================================================
                                                            Proposed                Proposed
                                                            Maximum                 Maximum
    Title of each Class of            Amount to          Offering Price             Aggregate            Registration
  Securities to be Registered       be Registered          Per Share             Offering Price                Fee
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                   <C>                  <C>                    <C>                        <C>
         Common Stock                 9,333,333
        $.01 par Value                 Shares              $15.00(1)               $139,999,995               (2)
=======================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
(1)  Based upon the fair value of the Common Stock of June 29, 1998.
(2)  The registration fee of $41,300 was paid upon the initial filing of the
     Form S-1.
    

The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates
as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file
a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement
shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the
Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become
effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to Section 8(a), may
determine.


<PAGE>

 PROSPECTUS

                        9,333,333 Shares of Common Stock
                               UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
   
         This Prospectus relates to the public offer and sale of up to 9,333,333
shares of common stock, par value $0.01 per share (the "Common Stock"), of UCBH
Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"). For additional
information with respect to the terms of the Common Stock, see "Description of
Common Stock." The Common Stock was issued and sold in the Private Offerings (as
defined herein) exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act
of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), to persons reasonably believed by
the Company to be "qualified institutional buyers" (as defined by Rule 144A
under the Securities Act) or other "accredited investors" (as defined in Rule
501(a) of Regulation D under the Securities Act. In connection with the Private
Offerings, the Company executed and delivered for the benefit of the holders of
the Common Stock a Registration Rights Agreement dated April 13, 1998 (the
"Registration Rights Agreement"), providing for, among other things, the filing
with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") of the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part. The Common Stock
offered hereby may be offered and sold from time to time (the "Offering") by the
holders named herein or, if required, by holders named in an accompanying
supplement (a "Prospectus Supplement") or by their respective transferees,
pledgees, donees, or their successors (collectively, the "Selling Holders")
pursuant to this Prospectus and a Prospectus Supplement, if required.
    
   
         The Common Stock may be sold by the Selling Holders from time to time
directly to purchasers or through underwriters, dealers or agents at market
prices or negotiated prices. See "Plan of Distribution." If required, the names
of any such underwriters, dealers or agents involved in the sale of the Common
Stock in respect of which this Prospectus is being delivered and the applicable
underwriter's discount, dealer's purchaser price or agent's commission, if any,
will be set forth in a Prospectus Supplement. The Selling Holders will receive
all of the net proceeds from the sale of the Common Stock and will pay all
underwriting discounts and selling commissions, if any, applicable to the sale
of the Common Stock. The Company will not receive any proceeds from the sale of
shares of the Common Stock in the Offering. The Company is responsible for
payment of all other expenses incident to the offer and sale of the Common
Stock.
    

         The Selling Holders and any underwriters, dealers or agents which
participate in the distribution of the Common Stock may be deemed to be
"underwriters" within the meaning of the Securities Act, and any commission
received by them and any profit on the resale of the Common Stock purchased by
them may be deemed to be underwriting commissions or discounts under the
Securities Act. See "Plan of Distribution" for a description of indemnification
arrangements.

         The Company has applied to the NASDAQ National Market ("NASDAQ") to
have the Common Stock quoted on the NASDAQ under the symbol "UCBH." Prior to
this Offering, there has not been a public market for the Common Stock and there
can be no assurance that an active public trading market for the Common Stock
will develop or be sustained.

         SEE "RISK FACTORS" COMMENCING ON PAGE ___ FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN
FACTORS THAT SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS.

         THE COMMON STOCK OFFERED HEREBY ARE NOT SAVINGS ACCOUNTS OR DEPOSITS
AND ARE NOT INSURED BY THE FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION, THE SAVINGS
ASSOCIATION INSURANCE FUND, THE BANK INSURANCE FUND OR ANY GOVERNMENT AGENCY.
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES
AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE
ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

                 The date of this Prospectus is _________, 1998


<PAGE>



                                     SUMMARY

         The following is a summary of certain information contained elsewhere
in this Prospectus. Reference is made to, and this summary is qualified in its
entirety by, the more detailed information and the Company's Consolidated
Financial Statements, including the Notes thereto, appearing elsewhere in this
Prospectus.

                                   The Company

   
         The Company is a Delaware corporation and conducts business as a bank
holding company, the sole subsidiary of which is United Commercial Bank (the
"Bank"). The Company's assets consist primarily of all of the issued and
outstanding common stock of the Bank.

         Since its founding in 1974, the Company has grown to total assets of
$1.91 billion, total deposits of $1.47 billion and stockholders' equity of $98.1
million at June 30, 1998. The Bank currently has 25 retail banking offices in
the state of California, located in areas with high concentrations of ethnic
Chinese, including the San Francisco Bay area (which includes Oakland), and the
Sacramento/Stockton and Los Angeles metropolitan areas. The Bank is the largest
financial institution focused on serving the ethnic Chinese market within
California.

         Substantially all of the Bank's loans are secured by real property. At
June 30, 1998, approximately $712.3 million, or 56% of the Bank's gross loan
portfolio was secured by residential properties (1-4 family), approximately
$334.2 million, or 26% of the Bank's gross loans were secured by commercial real
estate-multi-family mortgages, and $142.7 million, or 11% of the Bank's gross
loans were secured by commercial real estate-non-residential. The Bank's
deposits are obtained primarily from ethnic Chinese individuals and small and
medium sized businesses, business executives and professionals. As a result of
its focus on these deposit sources, at June 30, 1998, the Bank was able to
achieve a cost of funds approximately 60 basis points below the Eleventh
District Cost of Funds Index ("COFI"). Based upon June 30, 1997, FDIC deposit
market share data, the Bank believes it has the leading deposit market share in
the principal ethnic Chinese market within Oakland and is among the leaders in
deposit market share in the principal ethnic Chinese markets within the San
Francisco Bay area.
    

         Through its network of banking offices, the Bank provides a wide range
of personal and commercial banking services to small and medium sized
businesses, business executives, professional and other individuals in the
financial services, professional services, real estate construction, computer
and semi-conductor manufacturing, and wholesale and retail trade industries. The
Bank offers a variety of deposit products, from traditional savings and business
accounts to the specialized services designed to serve the personal banking
needs of its customers. The Bank also engages in a full complement of lending
activities, including residential and commercial real estate, construction,
commercial and consumer credit facilities and working capital loans. The Bank
offers Chinese multilingual services to all of its customers.

         Historically, the Bank has operated as a traditional thrift engaged
primarily in mortgage banking activities and the origination of residential
mortgages (1-4 family) which were generally pooled and sold in the secondary
market, with loan servicing rights retained. From time to time, the Bank sold
its loan servicing rights and also purchased agency servicing rights in
connection with its mortgage banking activities. Since 1993, the Bank has also
specialized in the origination of limited documentation residential mortgages
(1-4 family). The Bank has historically maintained a heavy concentration of
assets with interest rates based on COFI, which generally lags market interest
rate changes and which can suppress net interest margins during periods of
rapidly escalating interest rates. From 1993 to 1995, the Bank experienced a
decline in earnings primarily as a result of (i) depressed net interest margins
due to COFI-indexed assets and a larger volume of LIBOR-based borrowings; (ii)
an increase in the Bank's allowance for loan losses; and (iii) the competitive
pressures in the mortgage banking business. In addition, in 1996, the Bank's
earnings were reduced by the payment of a onetime $7.7 million Savings
Association Insurance Fund ("SAIF") recapitalization assessment.


                                        2

<PAGE>



   
         From 1995 to June 1998, the Company experienced steady growth in its
net interest income. Notwithstanding this improvement in net interest income,
the Company's net income was adversely impacted by a $7.7 million SAIF
recapitalization assessment in 1996 and an $8.8 million provision for loan
losses during 1995. The $8.8 million provision for loan losses was $4.1 million
greater than the five year average provision for loan losses of $4.7 million and
was recorded to address the continued depressed California economy and real
estate market and to significantly increase the Company's overall level of
allowance for loan losses to over 1.00% of gross loans. Without giving effect to
the SAIF recapitalization assessment, in 1996, the Company's net income would
have amounted to $4.3 million as compared to the $306,000 actual net loss.
    

Balance Sheet Restructuring

         In recent years, the mortgage banking industry became highly
competitive and, combined with the availability of more efficient delivery
systems through brokers and the Internet, the industry has experienced shrinking
profit margins and reduced loan servicing values. Higher levels of prepayment
activity resulting from the lower interest rate environment and the willingness
of lenders to offer mortgage loans with no points and, in many cases, no fees,
have reduced servicing values. To respond to these market factors and to improve
the long-term prospects of the Bank, the Bank since 1995 has taken the following
measures:

   
         COFI Asset Reduction. In the fourth quarter of 1996, the Bank ceased
all COFI-based mortgage lending and began to reduce the Bank's COFI-based
mortgage-backed securities portfolio. From December 31, 1996 to June 30, 1998,
COFI-based loans have been reduced from 60.2% of the Bank's total gross loan
portfolio to 39.8%. From December 31, 1996 to June 30, 1998, total COFI exposure
has been reduced from 64.9% of the Bank's interest-earning assets to 40.2%.
    

         Closure of Mortgage Banking Division. In 1997, the Bank closed its
mortgage banking division and ceased the origination of nonconventional mortgage
loans (i.e., loans insured by the Federal Housing Administration or partially
guaranteed by the Veterans Administration) for sale in the secondary market and
sold its agency loan servicing portfolio. While the Bank no longer engages in
the origination of nonconventional mortgage loans, the Bank continues to
originate conventional residential mortgage loans for portfolio retention and
conforming mortgage loans for resale in the secondary market through its retail
branching networks. See "Business--Lending Activities."

   
         Reduced Non-Performing Assets. The Bank reduced its non-performing
assets from $22.3 million as of December 31, 1995, to $9.1 million as of June
30, 1998.

         Reduced Mismatched Borrowings. The Bank reduced its predominantly high
cost LIBOR-based borrowings (which were mismatched with COFI-based assets) from
$265.3 million at the beginning of 1995 to zero at December 31, 1996 and 1997.
As a result of the proceeds received by the Company and made available to the
Bank following the Private Offerings (as described herein), the Bank implemented
a plan to leverage such proceeds through purchases of investment grade
securities and municipal bonds and to fund such purchases with Federal Home Loan
Bank ("FHLB") advances and cash made available from the proceeds. At June 30,
1998, the Bank had entered into $298 million of borrowings to fund such asset
purchases. Included in these borrowings were $96 million of short-term
borrowings and $202 million of long-term borrowings. The Bank also entered into
certain interest rate cap agreements to reduce the Bank's exposure to rising
interest rates. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations--Financial Condition."
    


                                        3

<PAGE>



Implementation of Strategy

         In conjunction with the implementation of the balance sheet
restructuring described above which returned the Bank to profitability in 1996,
excluding the one-time SAIF recapitalization assessment, to further improve the
Bank's long-term prospects and to take advantage of the Bank's significant
deposit market share and the potential cross selling opportunities to the ethnic
Chinese and Asian communities within its market area, the Board of Directors
adopted a business strategy to shift the primary business focus of the Bank from
a traditional thrift to a full service commercial banking operation. To
implement its business strategy, the Bank took the actions and adopted the
initiatives outlined below.

         Management. The Bank realigned senior management responsibilities, and
hired commercial banking officers and Small Business Administration ("SBA")
business banking officers with lending experience in the Bank's market area. See
"Management of the Company and the Bank."

   
         Established Commercial Banking Division. In 1996, to take advantage of
the opportunities in the Bank's targeted markets, the Bank established its
commercial banking division to offer an array of commercial bank services and
products to its customers particularly focused on the ethnic Chinese
communities. Since its establishment, the commercial banking division has
originated approximately $110.1 million in commercial loan commitments and had
$98.7 million in outstanding loans as of June 30, 1998. As of June 30, 1998,
the division had a current committed pipeline of approximately $129 million. To
support its commercial banking activities, the Bank installed a commercial
banking data processing system to replace a system designed for thrift
institutions. The new system provides customer profitability reports, account
analysis and other commercial banking management tracking and reporting
mechanisms. The installation of this new system was completed in February 1998.
The Bank installed software to enhance commercial real estate loan marketing and
development. The PC based system provides key information on substantially all
commercial real estate transactions in the Bank's market area in California. The
software provides information instrumental to identifying lending and
refinancing opportunities, screening potential credit opportunities and
evaluating collateral values to facilitate efficient solicitation of borrowers
and related depository relationships from commercial and multi-family property
owners. The Bank opened a commercial, construction and SBA lending office in
Pasadena, California during the second quarter of 1998. In addition to other
personnel, the Bank has hired a team of three experienced SBA business banking
officers to staff the Pasadena office. These officers were previously affiliated
with one of the leading lenders focusing on SBA lending to Asians.

         Core Deposit Solicitation. To further develop the Bank's core deposit
base, the Bank is evaluating the establishment of mini-branches in or adjacent
to Asian supermarkets in selected target market areas. By continuing to
emphasize multilingual services at its automated teller machines ("ATMs"),
through its telephone banking system and by its customer service and loan
officers, the Bank expects to continue to further expand its presence in the
Asian, and specifically the ethnic Chinese, markets in California. At June 30,
1998, less than 2% of the Bank's deposits were held by customers located outside
the United States. In addition, as of such date, the 100 depositors with the
largest aggregate average deposit balances comprised less than 10% of the Bank's
total deposits. The Bank also expects to increase its business accounts as the
commercial lending portfolio grows and correspondent account relationships are
established.

         Capital Enhancement. On April 17, 1998, the Company completed a $140.0
million placement of its Common Stock and a $30.0 million placement of 9.375%
Capital Securities through UCBH Trust Co. (together the "Private Offerings").
The Private Offerings were consummated pursuant to Rule 506 of Regulation D,
Regulation S and Rule 144A under the Securities Act. At March 31, 1998, the
Company's stockholders' equity was $64.6 million, or 4.2% of total assets. Prior
to the Private Offerings, management of the Company entered into an agreement to
buy out the interests of the two owners of the Company, in conjunction with the
private placement of Common Stock. Chief Investments Limited and United Holdings
Int'l, Ltd. (the "Selling Shareholders") owned in the aggregate, prior to the
buyout, 100% of the Common Stock of the Company and 100% of the Company's Senior
Debt (the "Notes") totaling $20.6 million, including accrued interest. In
connection with the Private Offerings,


                                        4

<PAGE>

the Company exchanged 329 shares of its common stock (1,974,000 shares giving
effect to the 6000:1 stock split on April 17, 1998) for the Notes and
subsequently used $120.0 million of the proceeds of the Private Offerings to
redeem all shares of common stock then outstanding, including those shares of
common stock issued to the Selling Shareholders in exchange for the Notes (the
"Redemption"). As a result of the Redemption, the Selling Shareholders are no
longer affiliated with the Company or the Bank. The Company then issued
9,333,333 shares of Common Stock to purchasers in the Private Offering.
Following the Private Offerings and the Redemption, the Company's stockholders'
equity increased to $98.1 million at June 30, 1998 and the Company's
consolidated Tier 1 capital increased from $63.9 million at December 31, 1997 to
$128.2 million at June 30, 1998. See "Supervision and Regulation--Bank Holding
Company and Bank Regulation--the Bank--Capital Requirements."


         Charter Conversion. In the first quarter of 1998, the Bank changed its
name to United Commercial Bank to reflect the Bank's new emphasis on providing
commercial banking services to its customers. As part of its strategy to shift
its business focus from mortgage banking to commercial banking, the Bank
converted to a California-chartered commercial bank and the Company become a
bank holding company on July 31, 1998.
    

         As a result of the measures taken to effect the Bank's shift in its
primary business focus from mortgage banking to commercial banking, and the
implementation of its strategic initiatives, management believes that the Bank
is and will continue to be well positioned to take advantage of the
opportunities in its market area and particularly in the growing ethnic Chinese
market in California.

   
         The Company, as a bank holding company, is subject to examination and
regulation by the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco. The Bank, as a
state-chartered commercial bank, is subject to comprehensive regulation and
examination by the Department of Financial Institutions ("DFI") as its primary
regulator and by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC"), which
administers the Savings Association Insurance Fund ("SAIF") which insures the
Bank's deposits to the maximum extent permitted by law. The Bank is a member of
the FHLB of San Francisco, which is one of the 12 regional banks which comprise
the FHLB system. The Bank is further subject to regulations of the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System ("Federal Reserve Board") governing
reserves required to be maintained against deposits and certain other matters.
See "Supervision and Regulation."
    

         The Company's executive offices are located at 711 Van Ness Avenue, San
Francisco, California 94102 and its main telephone number is (415) 928-0700.


                                        5

<PAGE>



                                  THE OFFERING

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
<S>                                                          <C>
The Private Placement.....................................   The Common Stock issued to investors in the Private
                                                             Placement was sold by the Company on April 17, 1998.
                                                             An aggregate of 9.3 million shares of Common Stock
                                                             were sold to 246 purchasers. In connection therewith,
                                                             the Company executed and delivered for the benefit of
                                                             the holders of the Common Stock the Registration
                                                             Rights Agreement, providing for, among other things,
                                                             the filing of the Registration Statement of which this
                                                             Prospectus forms a part. See "The Private Offerings and
                                                             the Redemption Transactions" and "Selling Holders."

Securities Offered........................................   9,333,333 shares of Common Stock.

Market for Common Stock...................................   The Company has applied to have the Common Stock
                                                             quoted on the NASDAQ under the symbol "UCBH."
                                                             Prior to the Offering, there has not been a public market
                                                             for the Common Stock and there can be no assurance
                                                             that an active public trading market the Common Stock
                                                             will develop or be sustained.

Use of Proceeds...........................................   The Selling Holders will receive all of the proceeds from
                                                             the Common Stock sold pursuant to this Prospectus.
                                                             See "Use of Proceeds" for a discussion of the use of the
                                                             net proceeds from the Private Offerings.

Risk Factors..............................................   See "Risk Factors--Increased Lending Risks Associated
                                                             with Expansion into Commercial Banking Activities,"
                                                             "--Interest Rate Risk," "--Risks Associated with
                                                             Leveraging Strategy," "--Potential Adverse Credit
                                                             Quality," "--Risks Associated with Limited
                                                             Documentation Lending," "--No Assurances as to the
                                                             Adequacy of Allowance for Loan Losses," "--External
                                                             Factors with Potential to Adversely Affect Asset
                                                             Quality," "--Risks Related to Government Regulation
                                                             and Monetary Policy," "--Competition," "--Dependence
                                                             on Economic Conditions and Geographic Concentration
                                                             in Market Areas," "--Risk of Adverse Accounting
                                                             Treatment of Private Offerings," "--Dependence on Key
                                                             Management Personnel," "--Ability of Company to
                                                             Execute its Business Strategy and Generate Earnings,"
                                                             "--Year 2000 Risks," "--Risk of Adverse Tax
                                                             Determination," "--Lack of Market for Common Stock,"
                                                             "--No Present Intention to Pay Dividends" and "--Certain
                                                             Provision and Agreements Which May Discourage Takeover
                                                             Attempts" for a discussion of certain factors that should
                                                             be considered by prospective investors.
    
</TABLE>


                                        6

<PAGE>



                      SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

   
The following selected consolidated financial data with respect to the
consolidated financial position of the Company as of December 31, 1997 and 1996,
and operating data for the fiscal years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995
have been derived from, and should be read in conjunction with, and is qualified
in its entirety by, the audited Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes
thereto of the Company presented elsewhere in this Prospectus. The selected
consolidated financial data with respect to the Company's consolidated financial
position as of December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993 and operating data for the years
ended December 31, 1994 and 1993 have been derived from the audited Consolidated
Financial Statements of the Company, which are not presented herein. The data
presented at June 30, 1998 and for the six months ended June 30, 1998 and 1997
were derived from unaudited consolidated financial statements and reflect, in
the opinion of management, all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring
adjustments) which are necessary to present fairly the results for such interim
periods. The results of operations for the six months ended June 30, 1998 are
not necessarily indicative of the results of operations that may be expected for
the year ended December 31, 1998.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 At June                                      At December 31,
                                                   30,          --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                  1998           1997           1996          1995           1994           1993
                                                 ------         ------         ------        ------         ------         -----
                                                                              (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                           <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>       
Financial Condition And Other Data:
Total assets .............................    $1,910,379     $1,561,650     $1,474,617     $1,521,699     $1,522,412     $1,456,892
Net loans ................................     1,258,944      1,202,095      1,054,686      1,011,909        965,668        878,001
Securities(1) ............................       575,310        270,103        343,739        429,005        467,426        491,278
Deposits .................................     1,474,270      1,468,987      1,393,125      1,311,604      1,168,031      1,032,868
Borrowings ...............................       298,000             --             --        128,600        265,341        309,975
Long-term debt to affiliates .............            --         20,060         16,736         13,000         13,500         14,000
Stockholders' equity .....................        98,109         62,552         54,344         55,457         59,350         58,440
Non-performing assets ....................         9,296         10,266         21,096         22,287         16,347         29,006

Ratio of equity to assets ................          5.14%          4.01%          3.69%          3.64%          3.90%          4.01%
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   For the Six Months
                                                     Ended June 30,                     For the Year Ended December 31,
                                                    ----------------       ---------------------------------------------------------
                                                      1998      1997       1997        1996        1995          1994        1993
                                                      ----      ----       ----        ----        ----          ----        ----
                                                                              (Dollars in Thousands)
Operating Data:
<S>                                                 <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>           <C>           <C>       <C>     
Interest income ..................................  $ 58,191   $ 52,106   $107,591   $102,964      $ 99,034      $ 87,079  $ 90,203
Interest expense .................................    33,759     30,690     64,252     63,955        70,196        53,621    48,724
                                                    --------   --------   --------   --------      --------      --------  --------

Net interest income ..............................    24,432     21,416     43,339     39,009        28,838        33,458    41,479
Provision for loan losses ........................     1,401        132      1,154      1,476         8,777         3,206     8,898
                                                    --------   --------   --------   --------      --------      --------  --------

    Net interest income after provision for loan
      losses .....................................    23,031     21,284     42,185     37,533        20,061        30,252    32,581
Noninterest income ...............................     1,732      1,165      3,094      3,397         3,767         8,603    17,897
SAIF recapitalization assessment .................        --         --         --      7,716(2)         --            --        --
Noninterest expense ..............................    17,294     15,945     32,190     33,697        30,142        35,603    38,677
                                                    --------   --------   --------   --------      --------      --------  --------

    Income (loss) before taxes ...................     7,469      6,504     13,089       (483)       (6,314)        3,252    11,801
Income tax expense (benefit) .....................     3,070      2,677      5,790       (177)       (3,406)          772     5,281
                                                    --------   --------   --------   --------      --------      --------  --------

Net income (loss) ................................  $  4,399   $  3,827   $  7,299   $   (306)(2)  $ (2,908)(2)  $  2,480  $  6,520
                                                    ========   ========   ========   ========      ========      ========  ========

Operating Ratios And Other Data:
Return (loss) on average assets ..................      0.54%      0.51%      0.47%     (0.02)%       (0.19)%        0.17%     0.45%
Return (loss) on average equity ..................     11.50      13.15      12.33      (0.48)        (4.89)         3.45      9.50
Interest rate spread .............................      2.95       2.78       2.71       2.58          1.85          2.29      3.17
Net interest margin ..............................      3.13       2.93       2.89       2.68          1.96          2.36      2.85
Efficiency ratio(3)(4) ...........................     66.10      70.61      69.33      79.46(3)      92.45         84.65     65.14
Noninterest expense to average assets(4) .........      2.14       2.11       2.08       2.23          1.98          2.40      2.69

Asset Quality Data:
Non-performing assets to total assets ............      0.49%      0.66%      0.66%      1.43%         1.46%         1.07%     1.99%
Non-performing loans to total gross loans ........      0.71       0.84       0.81       1.83          2.00          1.17      1.79
Allowance for loan losses to total gross loans ...      1.04       1.05       1.00       1.10          1.34          0.78      0.90
Allowance for loan losses to non-performing
  loans ..........................................    145.84     124.36     123.22      59.98         66.88         66.67     54.83
Net charge-offs to average gross loans ...........      0.05       0.06       0.06       0.34          0.26          0.41      0.96

Bank Regulatory Capital Ratios:
Tier 1 risk-based capital ........................     12.35%      9.85%      9.90%      9.41%         9.21%         9.95%     9.84%
Total risk-based capital .........................     13.61      11.11      11.15      10.67         10.47         10.95     10.93
Core (leverage) ..................................      6.56       5.12       5.37       4.90          4.50          4.80      4.72
Tangible .........................................      6.56       5.12       5.37       4.90          4.50          4.77      4.68
    
</TABLE>
                                                   (footnotes on following page)


                                        7

<PAGE>


   
- ----------
(1)  Includes available-for-sale securities and held-to-maturity securities.
(2)  During 1996, the Company's net income was adversely affected by the
     one-time SAIF recapitalization assessment which was recognized by the Bank
     during the third quarter of the year. Without giving effect to the SAIF
     recapitalization assessment, the Company's net income would have amounted
     to $4.3 million for 1996.
(3)  Represents noninterest expense divided by the aggregate of net interest
     income before provision for loan losses and noninterest income.
(4)  During the year ended December 31, 1996, such ratios exclude the one-time
     SAIF recapitalization assessment. Including the SAIF recapitalization
     assessment, the Bank's efficiency ratio and noninterest expense to average
     assets would amount to 97.66% and 2.74%, respectively.
    


                                  RISK FACTORS

         Prospective investors should carefully review the information contained
elsewhere in this Prospectus and should particularly consider the following
matters. Information contained in this Prospectus contains "forward-looking
statements" which can be identified by the use of forward-looking terminology
such as "believes," "expects," "may," "will," "should," "projected,"
"contemplates" or "anticipates" or the negative thereof or other variations
thereon or comparable terminology. No assurance can be given that the future
results covered by the forward-looking statements will be achieved. The
following matters constitute cautionary statements identifying important factors
with respect to such forward-looking statements, including certain risks and
uncertainties, that could cause actual results to vary materially from the
future results covered in such forward-looking statements. Other factors, such
as the general state of the economy, could also cause actual results to vary
materially from the future results covered in such forward-looking statements.

Increased Lending Risks Associated with Expansion into Commercial Banking
Activities

   
         At June 30, 1998, $334.2 million, or 26.3% of the Bank's gross loans
consisted of multi-family loans. In addition, with the change in the Bank's
business strategy and focus on commercial banking activities, the Bank's
commercial real estate loans, construction loans and commercial business loans
are expected to increase. Loans secured by apartment buildings and other
multi-family properties and loans secured by commercial real estate properties
are generally larger and involve a greater degree of risk than residential
mortgage (1-4 family) loans. Because payments on loans secured by multi-family
and commercial real estate properties are often dependent on successful
operation or management of the properties, repayment of such loans may be
subject to a greater extent to the then prevailing conditions in the real estate
market or the economy. Moreover, construction financing is generally considered
to involve a higher degree of credit risk than long-term financing on improved,
owner-occupied real estate. Risk of loss on a construction loan is dependent
largely upon the accuracy of the initial estimate of the property's value at
completion of construction or development compared to the estimated cost
(including interest) of construction. If the estimate of value proves to be
inaccurate, the Bank may be confronted with a project, when completed, having a
value which is insufficient to assure full repayment.
    

         Unlike mortgage loans, which generally are made on the basis of the
borrower's ability to make repayment from his or her employment or other income,
and which are secured by real property whose value tends to be more readily
ascertainable, commercial business loans are of higher risk and typically are
made on the basis of the borrower's ability to make repayment from the cash flow
of the borrower's business. As a result, the availability of funds for the
repayment of commercial business loans may be substantially dependent on the
success of the business itself. Furthermore, any collateral securing such loans
may depreciate over time, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in
value based on the success of the business.

         Although the Bank seeks to minimize the above risks through its
underwriting and credit administration policies, there can be no assurance that
such risks would not materialize, in which event the Company's result of
operations, financial condition and prospects could be materially adversely
affected.


                                        8

<PAGE>



Interest Rate Risk

         The Bank's earnings depend largely on the relationship between its cost
of funds, primarily deposits, and the yield on earning assets. This
relationship, known as the interest spread, is subject to fluctuation and is
affected by economic and competitive factors which influence market interest
rates, the volume and mix of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing
liabilities, and the level of non-performing assets. Fluctuations in market
interest rates affect the demand of customers for the Bank's products and
services. The Bank is subject to interest rate risk to the degree that its
interest-bearing liabilities reprise or mature more slowly or more rapidly or on
a different basis than its interest-earning assets. Given the Bank's current
volume and mix of interest-bearing liabilities and interest-earning assets, the
Bank's interest rate spread could be expected to decrease during periods of
rising and falling interest rates. Although the Bank believes its current level
of interest rate sensitivity is reasonable, significant fluctuations in interest
rates may have an adverse effect on the Bank's results of operations. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations--Market Risk and Net Portfolio Value."

   
Risks Associated with Leveraging Strategy

         As a result of the proceeds received by the Company and made to be
available to the Bank following the Private Offerings, the Bank implemented a
plan to leverage such proceeds through the purchase of U.S. Government agency
mortgage-backed securities, investment grade securities, investment grade
municipal bonds and investment grade residential mortgage (1-4 family)
securities and to fund such purchases through short- and long-term secured
borrowings, advances from the FHLB and from cash made available from the
proceeds. Such plan is consistent with the Bank's asset and liability management
policy and was approved by the Bank's Credit Policy and Investment Committee. In
connection with this strategy, the Bank will remain classified as a "well
capitalized" institution for regulatory capital purposes. If market rates of
interest fluctuate in such a manner that the Company is unable to earn a
positive spread as a result of its leverage strategy, Holdings' net interest
margin and net earnings will be adversely affected in future periods. Through
June 30, 1998, the Bank purchased approximately $325 million of such assets and
entered into $202 million of long-term borrowings.

Potential Adverse Credit Quality

         A significant source of risk for the Company arises from the
possibility that losses will be sustained because borrowers, guarantors and
related parties may fail to perform in accordance with the terms of their loan
agreements. The Company has adopted underwriting and credit monitoring
procedures and credit policies, including the establishment and review of the
allowance for loan losses, that management believes are appropriate to minimize
this risk by assessing the likelihood of nonperformance, tracking loan
performance and diversifying the Bank's credit portfolio. Such policies and
procedures, however, may not prevent unexpected losses that could materially
adversely affect the Company's results of operations. Maintenance of a high
credit quality of new commercial loans is also key in achieving its strategic
goals.

         The Bank's loan portfolio is predominantly secured by real estate.
Conditions in the real estate markets in which the collateral for the Bank's
mortgage loans are located strongly influence the level of the Bank's non-
performing loans and its results of operations. Real estate values are affected
by, among other things, changes in general or local economic conditions, changes
in governmental rules or policies, the availability of loans to potential
purchasers, and acts of nature. Declines in real estate markets have in the past
and may continue to negatively impact the value of the collateral securing the
loans and the Company's results of operations. See "Business--Lending
Activities--Loan Portfolio." As of June 30, 1998, the Bank had $9.1 million in
non-performing assets.

Risks Associated with Limited Documentation Lending

         The Bank specializes in a limited documentation mortgage loan product
for loans secured by single family residential properties. This product serves a
particular niche of borrowers willing to pay a premium, in the form of


                                        9

<PAGE>



higher interest rates, and larger down payments in exchange for more expedient
loan processing by virtue of providing less income or less income and less asset
information. These limited documentation mortgage loans, however, involve a
higher degree of risk as there is limited verified knowledge of the borrower's
level of income or ability to service the indebtedness which, in turn, may
result in a higher rate of default. As of June 30, 1998, $502.8 million, or
70.1% of the residential mortgages (1-4 family) were low documentation loans.
See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations--Financial Condition--Loan Portfolio."
    

No Assurances as to the Adequacy of Allowance for Loan Losses

         The Bank's allowance for loan losses is maintained at a level
considered adequate by management to absorb inherent losses in its loan
portfolio. The amount of inherent loan losses which could be ultimately realized
is susceptible to changes in economic, operating and other conditions, including
changes in interest rates, that could be beyond the Bank's control. Such losses
could exceed current estimates. Although management believes that the Bank's
allowance for loan losses is adequate, there can be no assurance that the
allowance will prove sufficient to cover actual loan losses should such losses
be realized. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations."

   
External Factors with Potential to Adversely Affect Asset Quality

         The economy in the Bank's primary market area and the real estate
market in particular have suffered from the effects of a recession in the first
half of this decade. Some of the effects of the recession were declines in
property values and decreased demand for goods and services. These conditions
may have had an adverse impact on the ability of certain borrowers to perform
under the original terms of their obligations to the Bank. The Bank's loan
portfolio is predominantly secured by real estate. The Bank's properties and
substantially all of the real and personal property securing loans in the Bank's
portfolio are located in California. The real estate securing loans has been in
the past and may in the future be adversely affected by market conditions in
California. In addition to market fluctuations, California is prone to
earthquakes, flooding and other natural disasters. The Bank faces the risk that
many of its borrowers may experience uninsured property damage, sustained
interruption of their businesses or loss of their jobs from earthquakes, floods
or other disasters. As a result, these borrowers may be unable to repay their
loans in accordance with their original terms and the collateral for such loans
may decline significantly in value. There can be no assurance that the allowance
for loan losses will be adequate to cover losses resulting from such external
factors.

Risks Related to Government Regulation and Monetary Policy

         The banking business is subject to extensive federal and state
supervision and regulation. Such regulations limit the manner in which the
Company and the Bank conduct their respective businesses, undertake new
investments and activities and obtain financing. These regulations are designed
primarily for the protection of the deposit insurance funds and consumers, and
not to benefit holders of the Company's securities. As a result of the
conversion of the Company to a bank holding company and the Bank to a
state-chartered bank, the scope and degree of regulatory oversight changed.
Among other things are statutory and regulatory limitations on the amount of
dividends which could be paid to the Company by the Bank which are different
from the restrictions which applied to the Bank under the OTS regulations. Bank
regulatory agencies also have authority to prohibit banks from engaging in
activities that, in their respective opinions, constitute unsafe or unsound
practices in conducting its business. It is possible, depending upon the
financial condition of the Bank and other factors, that the FDIC or the DFI
could assert that the payment of dividends or other payments by the Bank might,
under some circumstances, be such an unsafe or unsound practice.
    


                                       10

<PAGE>



         Financial institution regulation has been the subject of significant
legislation in recent years, and may be the subject of further significant
legislation in the future, none of which is in the control of the Company or the
Bank. Significant new laws or changes in, or repeals of, existing laws may cause
the Company's results of operations to differ materially. Further, federal
monetary policy, particularly as implemented through the Federal Reserve Board
significantly affects credit conditions for the Company, primarily through open
market operations in United States government securities, the discount rate for
bank borrowings and reserve requirements. A material change in any of these
conditions would have a material impact on the Bank, and therefore the Company's
results of operations.

Competition

         The banking and financial services industry in California generally,
and in the Bank's market areas specifically, is highly competitive. The
increasingly competitive environment results from changes in regulation, changes
in technology and product delivery systems, and the consolidation among
financial services providers. The Bank competes for loans, deposits and
customers for financial services with other commercial banks, savings and loan
associations, securities and brokerage companies, mortgage companies, insurance
companies, finance companies, money market funds, credit unions, and other
nonbank financial service providers. Many of these competitors are much larger
in total assets and capitalization, have greater access to capital markets and
offer a broader array of financial services than the Bank. To compete with the
other financial services providers, the Bank relies on local promotional
activities, personal relationships established by officers, directors and
employees with its customers, and specialized services tailored to meet its
customers' needs.

         The Bank competes for deposits from the ethnic Chinese markets with
other banks catering to the Asian community. The Bank believes that it has two
major competitors that are targeting the ethnic Chinese markets. Such
institutions have branch locations in many of the same neighborhoods as the
Bank, provide similar loan, savings and financial services, and market their
services in similar Asian publications and media in California.

   
Dependence on Economic Conditions and Geographic Concentration in Market Area

         The Bank's operations are located in Northern and Southern California
and are concentrated primarily in the San Francisco Bay area (including Oakland)
and the Sacramento/Stockton and Los Angeles metropolitan areas, with specific
emphasis on communities with a high concentration of ethnic Chinese individuals
and businesses. As a result of these geographic concentrations, the Bank's
results depend largely upon economic conditions in these areas. A deterioration
in economic conditions in the Bank's market could have a material adverse impact
on the quality of the Bank's loan portfolio and the demand for its products and
services, and accordingly, the Company's results of operations. See
"Business--Market Area."

Risk of Adverse Accounting Treatment of Private Offerings

         Based upon the representations of each offeree in the Private Offerings
("Offeree") that such Offeree was not acting in concert with any other Offeree,
it is the Company's understanding that following consummation of the Private
Offerings and the Redemption, generally accepted accounting principles do not
require the Company to revalue the assets and liabilities of the Company in the
Company's Consolidated Financial Statements to reflect consummation of the
Private Offerings and the Redemption. In the event that some or all of the
Offerees were deemed to be acting in concert, there is a substantial likelihood
that generally accepted accounting principles would require a step-up in
accounting basis (analogous to the purchase method of accounting for business
combinations) with respect to the Private Offerings and the Redemption. If a
change in accounting basis were required, the Company's assets and liabilities
would be reflected on the Company's consolidated financial statements based on
their estimated fair values at the consummation date and goodwill would be
recorded to the extent that the consideration paid to the Selling Shareholders
in the Redemption exceeds the aggregate net fair value of the Company's net
assets. In addition, if a step-up in accounting basis were required, it is
likely that generally accepted accounting principles, the Commission's
requirements and the Bank's primary regulator would likely require such
adjustments to be "pushed down" and reflected in the Bank's financial
statements. The requirement for push-down of accounting basis could have a
material adverse effect on the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to the
Company. In addition, the amortization of any goodwill recorded as a result


                                       11

<PAGE>



of such accounting treatment would significantly reduce the earnings of the Bank
in future periods and could adversely impact the ability of the Bank to pay
dividends to the Company. The Company received a report from its independent
accountants, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, as to the application of accounting
principles which concludes that consummation of the Private Offerings and
Redemption as described herein did not require the Company to revalue the assets
and liabilities of the Company in the Company's Consolidated Financial
Statements and, therefore, did not trigger the recognition of goodwill by the
Company or the Bank. The Company recorded no gains or losses in its financial
records as a result of the consummation of the Private Offerings and the
Redemption.

         It is uncertain whether, notwithstanding the Company's understanding of
generally accepted accounting principles and receipt of the report from
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP referenced above, the Bank's primary regulator would
require the push-down of accounting basis with respect to the Bank's financial
statements. The Company has not discussed with the Bank's primary regulator
whether it would require such treatment. If such regulator were to require the
push-down of accounting basis with respect to the Bank's financial statements,
such accounting treatment could have the effects described above. Accordingly,
in considering an investment in the Company, potential purchasers should take
into account the possibility that the push-down of accounting basis with respect
to the Bank's financial statements may be required.
    

Dependence on Key Management Personnel

   

         The Company's success depends substantially on certain members of its
senior management, in particular the following officers of the Bank: Tommy S.
Wu, President and Chief Executive Officer; Jonathan H. Downing, Senior Vice
President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer; Sylvia Loh, Senior Vice
President and Director of Commercial Banking; Louis E. Barbarelli, Senior Vice
President and Director of Systems and Operations; Cecilia Lai, Senior Vice
President and Director of Retail Banking; and William T. Goldrick, Senior Vice
President and Chief Credit Officer. The Company's business and financial
condition could be materially adversely affected by the loss of the services of
any such individuals. Ms. Loh joined the Bank as the head of commercial banking
in February 1996. The success of her department is vital to the success of the
shift in the Bank's business focus to commercial banking. The Company does not
maintain key man life insurance with respect to any of the foregoing
officers. See "Management of the Company and the Bank."
    

Ability of the Company to Execute its Business Strategy and Generate Earnings

   
         The Bank's ability to achieve its strategic goal and shift its business
focus to commercial banking largely depends on its ability to: fund a
significant amount of commercial real estate loans and commercial business
loans, including SBA loans; originate intermediate fixed-rate residential
mortgage loans (1-4 family); and significantly increase the Bank's commercial
deposit and demand accounts. During the year ended December 31, 1997, the Bank
originated $23.7 million of commercial real estate loans, $28.7 million of
commercial business loans and $3.3 million of SBA loans. During the six months
ended June 30, 1998, the Bank originated $35.3 million of commercial real estate
loans, $23.3 million of commercial business loans, and $2.5 million of SBA
loans. At June 30, 1998 the Bank had in its pipeline $98.4 million of
commercial real estate loans, $21.1 million of commercial business loans and
$9.4 million of SBA loans. Given the competitive environment for loan
originations, consumer demand for fixed-rate 30-year loans and the array of
alternative cash investments available to consumers, there are no assurances
that the Bank will be able to achieve its strategic business goals.
    

         The implementation of the Bank's strategic goals places demands on the
Bank's management personnel as well as its systems, other personnel control
systems, asset quality, earnings, policies and procedures. There can be no
assurance that the Bank will be able to make all adjustments necessary or to
employ and retain personnel with adequate training and experience to achieve its
strategic goals or to manage the Bank's growth and expansion. The failure to
achieve its strategic goals could have a material adverse effect on the
Company's results of operations, financial condition and prospects.


                                       12

<PAGE>



   
Year 2000 Compliance Risks

         The Year 2000 issue is a situation that may affect many electronic data
processing systems. In order to minimize the length of data fields, most
computer programs eliminated the first two digits in the year date field. This
problem could affect date-sensitive calculations that treat "00" as the year
1900, rather than 2000. Secondly, years that end in "00" are not leap years,
except for the anomaly in the year 2000. This anomaly could result in
miscalculations when processing critical date-sensitive information after
December 31, 1999.

         The Bank has adopted a plan to address Year 2000 data processing
issues. The plan includes the assessment of all internal systems, programs and
data processing applications as well as those provided to the Bank by
third-party vendors. The Bank recently converted its core banking system. The
new service provider is contractually obligated to the Bank to achieve full Year
2000 compliance in the core banking system. The Bank is working jointly with the
provider in testing the system's Year 2000 processing capabilities. The Bank
recently converted its core banking system to a system which is Year 2000
compliant.

         The Bank is in the process of installing accounting and loan processing
systems which are Year 2000 compliant and anticipates that such systems will be
installed by the end of 1998. The Company does not anticipate that the expenses
incurred in conjunction with the Year 2000 issues will have a material effect on
the results of operations of the Company. Management is currently evaluating the
Bank's third party vendors' efforts with respect to compliance with Year 2000
issues. No assurance can be made that such third party vendors' efforts will be
successful or that the Company's costs associated therewith will be as
estimated. However, the Company does not believe any Year 2000 issues will
materially affect the Company's products, services or competitive conditions. In
addition, the Company does not believe that the cost of addressing the Year 2000
issues is a material event or uncertainty that would cause reported financial
information not to be necessarily indicative of future operating results or
financial condition, and the costs or the consequences of incomplete or untimely
resolution of its Year 2000 issues does not represent a known material event or
uncertainty that is reasonably likely to affect its future financial results, or
cause its reported financial information not to be necessarily indicative of
future operating results or future financial condition. However, there can be no
assurance that the Year 2000 issue will not have a material adverse effect on
the Bank.

Risk of Adverse Tax Determination

         In 1997, the IRS concluded an examination of the income tax returns of
the Company for the tax years 1993 through 1995. The audit resulted in the
Company making cash payments and writing down the deferred tax assets of the
Company. Such cash payments and write-downs amounted to $500,000 in the
aggregate, which approximated the book allowances provided by the Company for
this eventuality. The IRS audit focused generally on the Company's Notes, which,
until canceled in the Redemption, were held by the Selling Shareholders (who
were then affiliates of the Company and the Bank) and, more specifically, on the
appropriateness of the Company's interest expense deductions during 1993, 1994
and 1995. Notwithstanding the conclusion of the IRS's audit and the resulting
cash payments and write-downs, no assurance can be made that the IRS will not
reexamine the Company's tax returns and further challenge the validity of the
Notes and the related interest expense deductions which could result in
additional income tax payments and/or write-downs. Although the settlement with
the IRS confirmed the treatment of the Notes as debt rather than equity, there
can be no assurance that the IRS will not reexamine the appropriateness of the
characterization of the Notes as debt with respect to the tax years subsequent
to 1995. The Notes were retired in April 1998 in conjunction with the
consummation of the Redemption. As of June 30, 1998, the Company's consolidated
financial statements reflect deferred tax assets of approximately $2.6 million
which represent interest expense deductions that the Company will take in its
1998 tax return. During the first quarter of 1998, the California Franchise Tax
Board ("FTB") notified the Company of its intention to review the consolidated
tax returns of the Company and the Bank for the four years ended December 31,
1996. As of July 31, 1998, the FTB had begun the review but had made no
disclosures to the Company regarding the scope of the examination nor time
frames in which they believed the examination would be completed. In the opinion
of management, any additional assessments that may result from such examination
will not have a material effect on the financial condition of the Company.

    


                                       13

<PAGE>



   
No Prior Public Market for the Common Stock

         Since the consummation of the Private Offerings, transactions in the
Common Stock have been limited, and there is no established market for the
Common Stock at this time. Although the Company has applied to have the Common
Stock quoted on the Nasdaq National Market upon satisfaction of the minimum
listing requirements, no assurance can be made when, if at all, the Company will
satisfy such listing requirements or if any such application will ultimately be
approved. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that an established and liquid
trading market for the Common Stock will develop or that it will continue if it
does develop. See "Dividends and Market for the Common Stock."
    

No Present Intention to Pay Dividends

   
         The Company does not anticipate initially paying dividends on the
Common Stock. It is the Company's present intention to retain earnings to
enhance capital and future growth.

Certain Provisions and Agreements Which May Discourage Takeover Attempts
    

         The Bank and the Company have entered into employment agreements with
Mr. Wu and change in control agreements with certain executive officers of the
Company and the Bank, which agreements provide for severance payments if their
respective employment is terminated in connection with a change in control of
the Company or the Bank. These provisions may have the effect of increasing the
cost of acquiring the Company, thereby discouraging future attempts to take over
the Company or the Bank. In addition, these agreements provide for certain
severance payments in the event of the executive officer's termination for any
reason other than resignation, cause, death or permanent disability. See
"Restrictions on Acquisition--Restrictions in the Company's Certificate of
Incorporation and Bylaws," "Management of the Company and the Bank--Employment
and Change in Control Agreements."

         Certain provisions of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and
Bylaws, particularly a provision limiting voting rights, as well as certain
federal regulations, assist the Company in maintaining its status as an
independent publicly owned corporation. These provisions provide for, among
other things, supermajority voting on certain matters, staggered boards of
directors, non-cumulative voting for directors, limits on the calling of special
meetings, limits on voting shares in excess of 10% of the outstanding shares,
and certain uniform price provisions for certain business combinations. These
provisions in the Company's governing instruments may discourage potential proxy
contests and other potential takeover attempts, particularly those which have
not been negotiated with the Board of Directors, and thus, generally may serve
to perpetuate current management. For a more detailed discussion of these
provisions, see "Restrictions on Acquisition."

          THE PRIVATE OFFERINGS AND THE REDEMPTION TRANSACTIONS

   
         The Redemption Agreement. Prior to the Private Offerings, on March 31,
1998, management of the Company entered into an Exchange and Redemption
Agreement (the "Redemption Agreement") to buy out the interests of the Selling
Shareholders, at that time the owners of all of the Common Stock of the Company,
in conjunction with the Private Offerings. Pursuant to the terms of the
Redemption Agreement, $20.6 million of the Notes, which were payable to the
Selling Shareholders, was exchanged for 329 shares of common stock (1,974,000
shares giving effect to the 6000:1 stock split on April 17, 1998). Subsequently,
the Company used approximately $120.0 million of the proceeds raised in the
Private Offerings to redeem all of the shares of common stock then owned by the
Selling Shareholders, which included the shares of common stock exchanged for
the Notes. The Company did not record any gains or losses in its financial
records as a result of the Private Offerings and the Redemption. As a result of
the Private Offerings and the Redemption, the Selling Shareholders are no longer
affiliated with the Company and the Bank. The Company then issued 9,333,333
shares of Common Stock to purchasers in the Private Offerings, some of whom are
Selling Holders.
    


                                       14

<PAGE>


   
         Pursuant to the Redemption Agreement, the Selling Stockholders have
made certain customary representations and warranties to the Company, relating
to the capital structure of the Company, the authority of the Selling
Shareholders, the due execution of the Redemption Agreement, the absence of
conflicts with or breaches of corporate governance documents or obligations of
the Selling Shareholders, the financial statements of the Company, the absence
of any material adverse liabilities, tax matters, litigation, fees and expenses,
the absence of other debt and the status as exempt private offerings of the
Private Offerings, which representations and warranties generally will survive
for one year after the date of the Redemption Agreement.

         The Purchase Agreement. On April 13, 1998, the Company entered into the
Purchase Agreement with the various purchasers of the Common Stock issued
pursuant to the Private Offerings, which provided, among other things, for the
purchase on such date of an aggregate of $140.0 million of Common Stock. A
closing was held on April 17, 1998 at which the Redemption and the Private
Offerings were consummated.
    

         In connection with the consummation of the transactions contemplated by
the Purchase Agreement and the Redemption Agreement, all of the persons then
serving as directors of the Company and the Bank resigned, and Sau-wing Lam,
Tommy S. Wu, Jonathan H. Downing, Robert Fell and Godwin Wong, all formerly
directors of the Company and/or the Bank, were elected as the directors of the
Company and the Bank. See "Management of the Company and the Bank."

         The obligations of the purchasers of the Common Stock issued pursuant
to the Purchase Agreement were subject to the satisfaction or waiver, prior to
the closing of the transaction, of various conditions, including, among other
things: (a) the continued accuracy of all representations and warranties made by
the Company in the Purchase Agreement and the performance in all material
respects of all covenants and agreements to be performed by the Company prior to
the closing of the transaction; (b) the execution by the Company and both of the
Selling Stockholders of the Redemption Agreement and the consummation of the
transaction contemplated thereby; and (c) the Company obtaining the requisite
stockholder approval of an amendment to its Certificate of Incorporation to
increase its authorized Common Stock to 25,000,000 shares, to revise the par
value per share of the Common Stock to $0.01 per share and to authorize
Preferred Stock of 10,000,000 shares and filing with the Secretary of State of
the State of Delaware the appropriate documentation in order to effect such
amendment.

         The Agency Agreement provided for the Company to pay Sandler O'Neill &
Partners, L.P. (the "Placement Agent") a fee equal to, in the aggregate, 7% of
the gross proceeds raised with respect to the placement of the Common Stock and
4% of the gross proceeds raised with respect to the placement of the Capital
Securities in the Private Offerings. In addition, the Company reimbursed the
Placement Agent for its actual out-of-pocket expenses pertaining to its
engagement, including legal fees and expenses and indemnified the Placement
Agent against certain liabilities arising out of its engagement, including
certain liabilities under the securities laws.

         In connection with the Private Offerings, the Company on April 13, 1998
also entered into the Registration Rights Agreement with the initial purchasers
of the Common Stock, pursuant to which, among other things, the Company agreed
to file within 120 days a shelf registration statement with the Commission
providing for the offer and sale of the Common Stock. The Registration Statement
of which this Prospectus forms a part has been filed in satisfaction of such
requirement. See "Registration Rights."

                                 USE OF PROCEEDS

         The Selling Holders will receive all of the proceeds from the Common
Stock sold pursuant to this Prospectus.


                                       15

<PAGE>

   
         Net proceeds from the Private Offerings were approximately $157.7
million after deducting the commission of the Placement Agent and estimated
offering and other expenses payable by the Company. The Company used $120.0
million on the net proceeds to repurchase all of the then outstanding common
stock, including those shares of Common Stock received by the Selling
Shareholders in exchange for the Notes, and is using the remainder of the net
proceeds for other general corporate purposes. All of the proceeds from the sale
of the Capital Securities were invested by the Trust in the Junior Subordinated
Debentures.

                      DIVIDENDS AND MARKET FOR COMMON STOCK

         The Board of Directors of the Company does not presently intend to
implement a policy of paying dividends on the Common Stock. Rather, the Company
expects to retain earnings to increase capital. The initiation of a cash
dividend policy will depend upon a number of factors, including investment
opportunities available to the Company or the Bank, capital requirements, the
Company's and the Bank's financial condition and results of operations, tax
considerations, statutory and regulatory limitations, and general economic
conditions. No assurances can be given that any dividends will be paid or that,
if paid, will not be reduced or eliminated in future periods. See "Supervision
and Regulation--Bank Holding Company and Bank Regulation."

         Dividends from the Company will depend principally on the ability of
the Bank to pay dividends to the Company. Under the California Financial Code,
the Bank is limited in the amount of distributions (including dividends) it may
make to its shareholder to an amount which equals the lesser of (a) the Bank's
retained earnings or (b) the Bank's net income for the last three fiscal years,
less the amount of any distributions made by the Bank to its shareholder during
such period. With prior regulatory approval, the Bank may make a distribution to
its shareholder in an amount not exceeding the greatest of (a) the Bank's
retained earnings, (b) its net income for the last fiscal year, or (c) its net
income for the current fiscal year. As of June 30, 1998, under applicable
regulations of the State of California, the total amount available for the
payment of dividends by the Bank to the Company was approximately $9.5 million.
See "Supervision and Regulation--Bank Holding Company and Bank Regulation."

         Notwithstanding the foregoing, the California Commissioner of the
Department of Financial Institutions may prohibit the Bank from paying any
dividends or making any other capital distribution, if the Commissioner finds
that the shareholder's equity of the Bank is inadequate or that such dividend or
other distribution would be unsafe or unsound for the Bank. Federal law also
prohibits any insured depository institution, such as the Bank, from making
capital distributions, including the payment of dividends, if, after making such
distribution, the institution would become "undercapitalized."

         Unlike the Bank, the Company is not subject to the aforementioned
regulatory restrictions on the payment of dividends to its stockholders;
although, as noted, the source of such dividends is dependent primarily upon
dividends from the Bank. The Company is subject, however, to the requirements of
Delaware law which generally limit dividends to an amount equal to the excess of
the net assets of the Company (the amount by which total assets exceed total
liabilities) over its statutory capital, or if there is no such excess, to its
net profits for the current and/or immediately preceding fiscal year. In
addition, the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco could oppose a distribution
by the Company if it determines that such a distribution would harm the
Company's ability to support its bank subsidiaries.

         Since consummation of the Private Offerings, transactions in the Common
Stock have been limited, and there is no established market for the Common Stock
at this time. The Company has applied to have the Common Stock quoted on the
NASDAQ and reserved the symbol "UCBH." The Company's application will be subject
to approval and compliance with certain conditions, including the presence of at
least three registered and active market makers. The Company will seek to
encourage and assist at least three market makers to make a market in the Common
Stock. Making a market involves maintaining bid and ask quotations and being
able, as principal, to effect transactions in reasonable quantities at those
quoted prices, subject to various securities laws and other regulatory
requirements. Sandler O'Neill & Partners, L.P., has advised the Company that it
intends to make a market in the Common Stock following approval of the listing
application, but it is under no obligation to do so. The development of a liquid
public market depends on the existence of willing buyers and sellers, the
presence of which is not within the control of the Company. Accordingly, the
number of active buyers and sellers of the Common Stock at any particular time
may be limited. Under such circumstances, investors in the Common Stock could
have difficulty disposing of their securities and should not view the Common
Stock as a short-term investment. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that an
active and liquid trading market for the Common Stock will develop or that, if
developed, it will continue, nor is there any assurance that persons purchasing
shares of Common Stock will be able to sell them at or above the purchase price
therefor.
    


                                       16


<PAGE>



   
                  RATIOS OF EARNINGS TO COMBINED FIXED CHARGES

         The following table sets forth the ratios of earnings to combined fixed
charges of the Company on a consolidated basis for the respective periods
indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   For the
                                              Six Months Ended
                                                  June 30,
                                                  --------
                                                                        For the Year Ended December 31,
                                                                --------------------------------------------------
                                                1998    1997     1997     1996    1996(1)    1995     1994    1993
                                               ------  ------   ------   ------  ---------  ------   ------  -----
<S>                                             <C>     <C>      <C>     <C>       <C>      <C>     <C>      <C>  
Ratios of Earnings to Combined Fixed
Charges:
     Excluding interest on deposits..........   3.98x   4.85x    6.59x   1.25x     2.90x    0.68x   1.30x    1.97x
     Including interest on deposits..........   1.22x   1.21x    1.24x   1.02x     1.14x    0.93x   1.09x    1.28x
</TABLE>

- -------------
(1)  Represents the respective fixed charge ratios excluding the SAIF
     recapitalization assessment.
    

         For purposes of computing the ratios of earnings to combined fixed
charges, earnings represent net income plus applicable income taxes and fixed
charges. Fixed charges, excluding interest on deposits, include gross interest
expense other than on deposits. Fixed charges, including gross interest on
deposits, include all interest expense.


                                       17

<PAGE>

                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

   
         The following consolidated statement of operations with respect to the
Company's operations for the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995 have
been derived from the audited Consolidated Financial Statements and notes
thereto of the Company appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus. This information
should be read in conjunction with such Consolidated Financial Statements and
the notes thereto. The following consolidated statements of operation with
respect to the Company's operations for the six months ended June 30, 1998 and
1997 have been derived from unaudited financial data, and, in the opinion of
management, reflect all adjustments, consisting of normal recurring adjustments,
which are necessary to present fairly the results for such interim periods. The
results of operations for the six months ended June 30, 1998 are not necessarily
indicative of the results of operations that may be expected for the year ending
December 31, 1998.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    For the Six Months
                                                                       Ended June 30,        For the Years Ended December 31,
                                                                       --------------        --------------------------------
                                                                      1998        1997        1997       1996         1995
                                                                      ----        ----        ----       ----         ----
                                                         (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                                 <C>         <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>     
Interest income:
    Interest on loans ...........................................   $ 47,954    $ 41,197    $ 86,141   $ 78,711    $ 72,742
    Interest on funds sold and securities purchased under
      agreements to resell ......................................        471       1,081       2,760      1,417         398
    Interest on investment and mortgage-backed securities .......      9,766       9,828      18,690     22,836      25,894
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

         Total interest income ..................................     58,191      52,106     107,591    102,964      99,034
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------
     Interest on deposits .......................................     31,254      28,999      61,513     59,273      56,038
     Interest on short-term borrowings ..........................         66         798         294        998       6,550
     Interest on guaranteed preferred beneficial interests
         in junior subordinated debentures ......................        570          --          --         --          --
     Interest on long-term borrowings ...........................      1,270          --         620      2,044       5,867
     Interest on long-term debt to affiliates ...................        599         893       1,825      1,640       1,741
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

         Total interest expense .................................     33,759      30,690      64,252     63,955      70,196
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

          Net interest income ...................................     24,432      21,416      43,339     39,009      28,838
Provision for loan losses .......................................      1,401         132       1,154      1,476       8,777
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------
          Net interest income after provision for loan losses ...     23,031      21,284      42,185     37,533      20,061
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

Noninterest income:
     Commercial banking fees ....................................        565         429         977        421          92
     Service charges on deposit accounts ........................        544         482         888        615         566
     Gain on sale of loans, securities and servicing rights .....        307        (530)        155      1,200       1,137
     Loan servicing income ......................................        292         526         601        680         272
     Miscellaneous income .......................................         24         258         473        481       1,700
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

         Total noninterest income ...............................      1,732       1,165       3,094      3,397       3,767
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

Noninterest expenses:
     Personnel ..................................................      8,247       7,169      14,087     14,875      12,000
     Occupancy ..................................................      2,447       2,306       4,811      4,754       4,355
     Data processing ............................................      1,180         979       2,059      1,859       1,696
     Furniture and equipment ....................................      1,170         852       1,902      1,814       1,357
     Deposit insurance ..........................................        457       1,142       1,798      3,519       3,051
     SAIF recapitalization assessment ...........................         --          --          --      7,716          --
     Communication ..............................................        201         172         400        383         317
     Professional fees and contracted services ..................        902         882       2,342      1,551       1,303
     Foreclosed assets expense ..................................         (3)        393         671        686       2,785
     Miscellaneous expense ......................................      2,693       2,050       4,220      4,256       3,278
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

         Total noninterest expense ..............................     17,294      15,945      32,190     41,413      30,142
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

Income (loss) before taxes ......................................      7,469       6,504      13,089       (483)     (6,314)
Income tax expense (benefit) ....................................      3,070       2,677       5,790       (177)     (3,406)
                                                                    --------    --------    --------   --------    --------

           Net income (loss) ....................................   $  4,399    $  3,827    $  7,299   $   (306)   $ (2,908)
                                                                    ========    ========    ========   ========    ========
    
</TABLE>
 (See notes to the consolidated financial statements appearing elsewhere herein)

                                       18

<PAGE>


                     MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
                  FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

   

         The following Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations contains forward-looking statements that
involve risks and uncertainties. The Company's actual results could differ
materially from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a
result of certain factors, including those set forth in the section entitled
"Risk Factors" and elsewhere in this Prospectus. The following discussion and
analysis is intended to provide details of the results of operations of the
Company for the sixt months ended June 30, 1998 and 1997 and for the years ended
December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995 and financial condition at June 30, 1998 and at
December 31, 1997 and 1996. The following discussion should be read in
conjunction with the information set forth in the Company's Consolidated
Financial Statements and notes thereto and other financial data included
elsewhere in this Prospectus.
    

Results of Operations

         General. Currently, the Company's primary source of income is net
interest income, which is the difference between interest income from
interest-earning assets and interest paid on interest-bearing liabilities such
as deposits and other borrowings used to fund those assets. The Company's net
interest income is affected by changes in the volume of interest-earning assets
and interest-bearing liabilities as well as by changes in yields earned on
interest-earning assets and rates paid on interest-bearing deposits and other
borrowed funds. The Company also generates noninterest income, including
commercial banking fees and other transactional fees and seeks to generate
additional fees in connection with the shift in its business focus to commercial
banking. The Company's noninterest expenses consist primarily of personnel,
occupancy, and furniture and equipment expenses and other operating expenses.
The Company's results of operations are affected by its provision for loan
losses and may also be significantly affected by other factors including general
economic and competitive conditions, changes in market interest rates,
governmental policies and actions of regulatory agencies.

   
         Net Income. For the six months ended June 30, 1998, net income was $4.4
million, an increase of $572,000, or 14.9% from the six months ended June 30,
1997. The increase in earnings during the six months ended June 30, 1998
resulted primarily from the increased net interest income which resulted from
the larger average balance sheet, the improved loan yield, and the increase in
noninterest income. The improvement in noninterest income resulted primarily
from the Bank recording no loss on the sale of securities and loans in the six
months ended June 30, 1998 compared with a loss of $530,000 in the same period
of the preceding year. Partially offsetting these improvements in net income was
the increased provision for loan losses which was made as a result of the growth
in the loan portfolio and the increase in personnel expenses primarily related
to the expansion of the commercial banking division and incentive accruals
recorded during the first half of 1998 and nonrecurring expenses related to the
computer system conversion. For the year ended December 31, 1997, net income was
$7.3 million, an increase of $7.6 million from net loss of $306,000 for the year
ended December 31, 1996. For the year ended December 31, 1995, the Company's
operations resulted in a loss of $2.9 million. The Company's annualized return
on average assets was 0.54% for the six months ended June 30, 1998, compared
with 0.51% for the six months ended June 30, 1997. Annualized return on average
assets was 0.47% for the year ended December 31, 1997, compared to (0.02%) and
(0.19%) for the years ended December 31, 1996 and 1995, respectively. The
Company's annualized return on average equity was 11.50% and 13.15% for the six
months ended June 30, 1998 and 1997, respectively and 12.33%, (0.48%) and
(4.89%) for the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.
    

                                       19

<PAGE>
   
         From 1995 to June 30, 1998, the Company experienced steady growth in
its net interest income. Notwithstanding this improvement in net interest
income, the Company's net income was adversely impacted by a $7.7 million SAIF
recapitalization assessment in 1996 and an $8.8 million provision for loan
losses during 1995. The $8.8 million provision for loan losses in 1995 was $4.1
million greater than the five year average provision for loan losses of $4.7
million and was recorded to address the continued depressed California economy
and real estate market and to significantly increase the Company's overall level
of allowance for loan losses to over 1.00% of gross loans. Without giving effect
to the SAIF recapitalization assessment, in 1996, the Company's net income would
have amounted to $4.3 million as compared to the $306,000 actual net loss.

         The increase in net income for the six months ended June 30, 1998 from
the six months ended June 30, 1997 was partially due to the increase in net
interest income which resulted from an increase in the average loans outstanding
and an increase in the average yield on loans resulting from the growth in the
commercial loan portfolio. The net income also increased during this period due
to the Bank not incurring any losses on the disposition of loans or securities
whereas the Bank realized a loss of $530,000 for the disposition of such assets
in the six months ended June 30, 1997 in conjunction with its COFI reduction
program and the write-down of impaired loans. Partially offsetting the increases
to net income resulting from the foregoing were increases in the provision for
loan losses and increases in noninterest expense.

         The provision for loan losses increased from $132,000 in the first six
months of 1997 to $1.4 million in the same period of 1998. The increased
provision in 1998 related to the increased growth in the loan portfolio during
the first half of 1998 and the increase in the commercial loan portfolio during
this period. As of June 30, 1998, the $13.2 million allowance for loan losses
represented 1.04% of gross loans. Noninterest expenses were $17.3 million for
the first six months of 1998, an increase of $1.4 million, or 8.5%, from the
corresponding period of the prior year. Personnel expenses increased to $8.2
million during the first six months of 1998 compared with $7.2 million for the
corresponding period of the previous year due to the addition of commercial
banking personnel during 1997 and incentive accruals recorded during the first
half of 1998. Included in the expenses for the first half of 1998 were $400,000
of expenses associated with the name change of the Bank to United Commercial
Bank and $200,000 of severance pay accruals for an outsourced audit function.
    

         The increase in net income for the year ended December 31, 1997 from
the year ended December 31, 1996 was due to an increase in net interest income
to $43.3 million from $39.0 million, as discussed below, and a reduction in
deposit insurance expense to $1.8 million from $11.2 million, which includes the
SAIF assessment discussed below. In 1996, the Company paid a $7.7 million
onetime SAIF recapitalization assessment levied by the FDIC on SAIF-insured
deposits to fully capitalize the SAIF. During 1997, the Company's deposit
insurance premium was reduced to 9.4 basis points of deposits as a result of the
Bank reaching the "well capitalized" core capital ratio of 5.0%. Effective
January 1, 1998, the deposit insurance premium was further reduced to 6.4 basis
points of deposits.

         The reduction in the net loss for the year ended December 31, 1996 from
the year ended December 31, 1995 was due to the increase in net interest income
to $39.0 million from $28.8 million, as discussed below, and a reduction in the
provision for loan losses. In 1995, management increased the allowance for loan
losses from 0.78% of gross loans to 1.34% of gross loans to address the
continued depressed California economy and real estate market and to
significantly increase the Company's overall allowance for loan losses to over
1.00% of gross loans. The total provision for loan losses of $1.5 million in
1996 compares with a provision of $8.8 million in 1995. As a result of the
increase in net interest income and the reduction in the provision for loan
losses, the net loss of the Company was $306,000 for the year ended December 31,
1996 compared to a loss of $2.9 million for the year ended December 31, 1995,
notwithstanding the $7.7 million SAIF recapitalization assessment recognized in
1996.

                                       20

<PAGE>

   
         Net Interest Income and Net Interest Margin. The net interest margin
improved to 3.13% for the six months ended June 30, 1998 as opposed to 2.93% for
the six months ended June 30, 1997. At June 30, 1998, the net interest margin
was 2.90%, reflecting the impact of the new assets acquired in conjunction
with the leverage strategy. While the leverage strategy reduces this ratio, the
strategy is accretive to net income and earnings per share. For the six months
ended June 30, 1998, net interest income was $24.4 million, an increase of $3.0
million, or 14.1%, from $21.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 1997.

         Net interest income increased in the first six months of 1998 primarily
as a result of (i) the increase in average loans outstanding to $1.23 billion
from $1.08 billion, (ii) the increase in the average yield on loans to 7.80% in
the half of 1998 from 7.66% for the same period in the preceding year, (iii) the
reduction in the average balance of lower yielding COFI securities to $280.9
million from $352.0 million and their replacement with higher yielding loans,
and (iv), the purchase of $321 million of securities in conjunction with the
leveraging strategy during the second quarter of 1998, with an average yield of
6.91%.
    
         The net interest margin improved to 2.89% for the year ended December
31, 1997, compared to 2.68% for the year ended December 31, 1996 and 1.96% for
the year ended December 31, 1995. For the year ended December 31, 1997, net
interest income was $43.3 million, an increase of $4.3 million, or 11.0% from
$39.0 million for the year ended December 31, 1996. Net interest income for the
year ended December 31, 1996 increased $10.2 million, or 35.3% from $28.8
million for the year ended December 31, 1995.

         Net interest income increased in 1997 primarily as a result of (i) the
increase in average loans outstanding to $1.12 billion from $1.04 billion, (ii)
the reduction in the average balance of lower yielding securities to $326.7
million from $390.4 million and their replacement with higher yielding loans,
(iii) the reduction of average borrowings to $16.6 million from $49.8 million
and their replacement with lower costing deposits, and (iv) a reduction in the
non-interest-earning assets to $45.7 million from $60.0 million partially due to
the sale or reclassification of non-performing assets.

         Net interest income increased to $39.0 million in 1996 from $28.8
million in 1995, or 35.3%, primarily as a result of (i) the increase in average
loans outstanding to $1.04 billion from $1.0 billion, (ii) an increase in the
average yield on loans to 7.60% from 7.25% as a result of upward repricing of
the Bank's COFI-based loan portfolio, (iii) the reduction of average borrowings
to $49.8 million from $194.4 million and their replacement with lower costing
deposits, and (iv) a decrease in the average rate paid on deposit accounts from
4.57% to 4.37%.




                                       21

<PAGE>

         The following tables present condensed average balance sheet
information for the Company, together with interest rates earned and paid on the
various sources and uses of funds for each of the periods indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   

                                             At                     For the Six Months Ended June 30,
                                           June 30,   -------------------------------------------------------------
                                            1998                   1998                            1997
                                         ----------   ------------------------------   ----------------------------
                                                                  Interest   Average              Interest  Average
                                                      Average    Income or    Yield/   Average   Income or   Yield/
                                         Yield/Cost   Balance     Expense     Cost     Balance    Expense     Cost
                                         ----------   -------    ---------   -------   -------   ---------  -------
                                                                     (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                          <C>     <C>          <C>        <C>     <C>          <C>        <C>
Interest-earning assets:
   Loans(1) .............................    7.82%   $1,228,933   $47,954     7.80%  $1,075,423   $41,197     7.66%
   Securities ...........................    6.31       312,287     9,766     6.25      345,272     9,828     5.69
   Other ................................      --        16,825       471     5.60       40,026     1,081     5.40
                                                     ----------   -------            ----------   -------         

Total interest-earning assets ...........    7.34     1,578,375    58,191     7.47    1,460,720    52,106     7.13
Noninterest-earning assets ..............      --        61,557        --       --       50,790        --       --
                                                     ----------   -------            ----------   -------         

Total assets ............................    7.16    $1,619,602    58,191     7.19   $1,511,510    52,106     6.89
                                             ----    ==========   -------    -----   ==========   -------    -----

Interest-bearing liabilities:
  Deposits:
    NOW and checking ....................    1.09       $79,691       433     1.09      $77,570       411     1.06
    Money market accounts ...............    3.31        21,398       286     2.67       21,953       260     2.36
    Passbook accounts ...................    2.26       211,834     2,391     2.26      214,892     2,472     2.30
    Time deposits .......................    5.11     1,108,121    28,144     5.08    1,048,346    25,856     4.93
                                                     ----------   -------            ----------   -------

Total deposits ..........................    4.41     1,421,045    31,254     4.40    1,362,761    28,999     4.26
                                                     ----------   -------            ----------   -------

Borrowings ..............................    5.64        47,022     1,336     5.68       29,077       798     5.49
Guaranteed preferred beneficial interests
  in junior subordinated debentures .....    9.38        12,160       570     9.38           --        --       --
Long-term debt to affiliates ............      --        11,970       599    10.01       17,868       893    10.00
                                                     ----------   -------            ----------   -------

Total interest-bearing liabilities ......    4.71     1,492,021    33,759     4.52    1,409,706    30,690     4.35
                                             ----    ----------   -------    -----   ----------   -------    -----

Noninterest-bearing deposits ............                37,180                          32,041
Other noninterest-bearing liabilities ...                13,725                          11,567
Stockholders' equity ....................                76,501                          58,196
                                                     ----------                      ----------

Total liabilities and stockholders'
  equity ................................            $1,619,602                      $1,511,510
                                                     ==========                      ==========

Net interest income/net interest rate
  spread(2) .............................    2.63%                $24,432     2.95%               $21,416     2.78%
                                             ====                 =======    =====                =======    =====

Net interest-earning assets/net interest
  margin(3) .............................    2.90%      $86,354               3.13%     $51,138               2.93%
                                             ====    ==========              =====   ==========              =====

Ratio of interest-earning assets to
  interest-bearing liabilities ...........   1.06x         1.06x                           1.04x
                                             ====          ====                            ====
    
</TABLE>

- -------------------
(1) Non-accrual loans are included in the table for computation purposes, but
    the foregone interest on such loans is excluded.
(2) Interest rate spread represents the difference between the average yield on
    interest-earning assets and the average cost of interest-bearing
    liabilities.
(3) Net interest margin represents net interest income divided by average
    interest-earning assets.

                                       22

<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


                                                                 For the Year Ended December 31,
                                               ----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                          1997                                     1996
                                               ------------------------------        --------------------------------

                                                           Interest   Average                     Interest    Average
                                               Average    Income or   Yield/         Average     Income or    Yield/
                                               Balance     Expense     Cost          Balance      Expense      Cost
                                               -------    ---------   -------        -------     ---------    -------
<S>                                          <C>          <C>          <C>         <C>            <C>          <C>
Interest-earning assets:
   Loans(1)...............................   $1,123,356   $ 86,141     7.67%       $1,036,025     $ 78,711      7.60%
   Securities.............................      326,728     18,690     5.72           390,381       22,836      5.85
   Other..................................       48,944      2,760     5.64            26,516        1,417      5.34
                                             ----------   --------                 ----------     --------

Total interest-earning assets.............    1,499,028    107,591     7.18         1,452,922      102,964      7.09
Noninterest-earning assets................       45,664         --                     60,014           --
                                             ----------   --------                 ----------     --------

Total assets..............................   $1,544,692    107,591     6.97        $1,512,936      102,964      6.81
                                             ==========   --------     ----        ==========     --------     -----

Interest-bearing liabilities:
  Deposits:
    NOW and checking......................      $78,737        875     1.11           $77,710          826      1.06
    Money market accounts.................       21,397        517     2.42            23,583          561      2.38
    Passbook accounts.....................      212,943      4,834     2.27           207,512        4,772      2.30
    Time deposits.........................    1,090,320     55,287     5.07         1,047,019       53,114      5.07
                                             ----------   --------                 ----------     --------

Total deposits............................    1,403,397     61,513     4.38         1,355,824       59,273      4.37
                                             ----------   --------                                --------

Borrowings................................       16,551        914     5.52            49,813        3,042      6.11
Long-term debt to affiliates..............       18,398      1,825     9.92            14,868        1,640     11.03
                                             ----------   --------                 ----------     --------

Total interest-bearing liabilities........    1,438,346     64,252     4.47         1,420,505       63,955      4.53
                                                          --------     ----                       --------     -----

Noninterest-bearing deposits..............       33,780                                23,981
Other noninterest-bearing liabilities.....       13,358                                13,638
Stockholders' equity......................       59,208                                54,812
                                             ----------                            ----------

Total liabilities and stockholders'
  equity..................................   $1,544,692                            $1,512,936
                                             ==========                            ==========


Net interest income/net interest rate
  spread(2)...............................                $ 43,339     2.71%                       $39,009      2.58%
                                                          ========     ====                       ========     =====


Net interest-earning assets/net interest
  margin(3)...............................   $   60,682                2.89%       $   32,417                   2.68%
                                             ==========                ====        ==========                  =====


Ratio of interest-earning assets to
  interest-bearing liabilities............         1.04x                                 1.02x
                                                  =====                                 =====
<CAPTION>

                                                For the Year Ended December 31,
                                               ----------------------------------
                                                             1995
                                               ----------------------------------

                                                              Interest    Average
                                               Average       Income or    Yield/
                                               Balance        Expense      Cost
                                               -------       ---------    -------
<S>                                          <C>              <C>         <C>
Interest-earning assets:
   Loans(1)...............................   $1,002,662       $72,742      7.25%
   Securities.............................      460,165        25,894      5.63
   Other..................................        6,864           398      5.80
                                             ----------       -------

Total interest-earning assets.............    1,469,691        99,034      6.74
Noninterest-earning assets................       56,164            --
                                             ----------       -------

Total assets..............................   $1,525,855        99,034      6.49
                                             ==========       -------     -----

Interest-bearing liabilities:
  Deposits:
    NOW and checking......................   $   75,285           781      1.04
    Money market accounts.................       27,732           654      2.36
    Passbook accounts.....................      215,604         4,797      2.22
    Time deposits.........................      908,783        49,806      5.48
                                             ----------       -------

Total deposits............................    1,227,404        56,038      4.57
                                                              -------

Borrowings................................      194,365        12,417      6.39
Long-term debt to affiliates..............       13,250         1,741     13.14
                                             ----------       -------

Total interest-bearing liabilities........    1,435,019        70,196      4.89
                                             ----------       -------     -----

Noninterest-bearing deposits..............       16,191
Other noninterest-bearing liabilities.....       15,358
Stockholders' equity......................       59,287
                                             ----------

Total liabilities and stockholders'
  equity..................................   $1,525,855
                                             ==========


Net interest income/net interest rate
  spread(2)...............................                    $28,838      1.85%
                                                              =======     =====


Net interest-earning assets/net interest
  margin(3)...............................   $   34,672                    1.96%
                                             ==========                   =====


Ratio of interest-earning assets to
  interest-bearing liabilities............         1.02x
                                                  =====
</TABLE>

- -------------------
(1) Non-accrual loans are included in the table for computation purposes, but
    the foregone interest on such loans is excluded.
(2) Interest rate spread represents the difference between the average yield on
    interest-earning assets and the average cost of interest-bearing
    liabilities.
(3) Net interest margin represents net interest income divided by average
    interest-earning assets.


                                       23

<PAGE>


         The following table represents the extent to which changes in interest
rates and changes in the volume of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing
liabilities have affected the Company's interest income and expense during the
periods indicated. Information is provided for each major component of interest-
earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities with respect to: (i) changes in
volume (changes in volume multiplied by prior rate); (ii) changes attributable
to rate (changes in rate multiplied by prior volume); and (iii) the net change.
The changes attributable to both volume and rate have been allocated
proportionately to the change due to volume and the change due to rate.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                              For the Six Months Ended                     For the Year Ended
                                                           June 30, 1998 Compared to the           December 31, 1997 Compared to the
                                                           Six Months Ended June 30, 1997             Year Ended December 31, 1996
                                                           ------------------------------          ---------------------------------
                                                               Increase                                   Increase
                                                              (Decrease)                                 (Decrease)
                                                                Due to                                     Due to
                                                           -----------------                        -----------------
                                                           Volume      Rate       Net                Volume     Rate       Net
                                                           ------     ------     ------             -------    ------     ------
                                                                                 (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                        <C>        <C>        <C>                <C>        <C>        <C>
Interest income:
   Loans................................................   $5,977     $  780     $6,757              $6,690    $  740     $7,430
   Securities...........................................    1,901     (1,963)       (62)             (3,651)     (495)    (4,146)
   Other................................................     (651)        41       (610)              1,261        82      1,343
                                                           ------     ------     ------             -------    ------     ------

    Total interest income on interest-earning assets....    7,228     (1,143)     6,086               4,300       327      4,627
                                                           ------     ------     ------             -------    ------     ------

Interest expense:
   Deposits
      NOW and checking accounts.........................       11         11         23                  11        38         49
      Money market accounts.............................       (6)        32         26                 (53)        9        (44)
      Passbook accounts.................................      (35)       (46)       (81)                122       (60)        62
      Time deposits.....................................    1,503        784      2,288               2,196       (23)     2,173
   Borrowings...........................................      509         29        538              (1,861)     (267)    (2,128)
   Guaranteed preferred beneficial interests in junior
       subordinated debentures..........................      570         --        570                  --        --         --
   Long-term debt to affiliates.........................     (295)         1       (294)                264       (79)       185
                                                           ------     ------     ------             -------    ------     ------

Total interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities..    2,258        813      3,070                 679       382        297
                                                           ------     ------     ------             -------    ------     ------

Increase in net interest income.........................   $4,970    $(1,955)    $3,016              $3,621    $  709     $4,330
                                                           ======     =======    ======             =======    ======     ======
    
<CAPTION>

                                                                 For the Year Ended
                                                         December 31, 1996 Compared to the
                                                            Year Ended December 31, 1995
                                                         ---------------------------------
                                                               Increase
                                                              (Decrease)
                                                                Due to
                                                           -----------------
                                                           Volume      Rate       Net
                                                           ------     ------    -------
                                                               (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                        <C>        <C>        <C>
Interest income:
   Loans................................................   $2,468     $3,501     $5,969
   Securities...........................................   (4,137)     1,079     (3,058)
   Other................................................    1,049        (30)     1,019
                                                           ------     ------    -------

    Total interest income on interest-earning assets....     (620)     4,550      3,930
                                                           ------     ------    -------


<PAGE>


Interest expense:
   Deposits
      NOW and checking accounts.........................       26         19         45
      Money market accounts.............................      (99)         6        (93)
      Passbook accounts.................................     (249)       224        (25)
      Time deposits.....................................    6,473     (3,165)     3,308
   Borrowings...........................................   (8,850)      (525)    (9,375)
   Long-term debt to affiliates.........................      126       (227)      (101)
                                                           ------     ------    -------

Total interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities..   (2,573)    (3,668)    (6,241)
                                                           ------     ------    -------

Increase in net interest income.........................   $1,953     $8,218    $10,171
                                                           ======     ======    =======
</TABLE>

                                       24

<PAGE>

         Provision For Loan Losses. The provision for loan losses reflects
management's judgment of the current period cost associated with credit risk
inherent in the Company's loan portfolio. Specifically, the provision for loan
losses represents the amount charged against current period earnings to achieve
an allowance for loan losses that in management's judgment is adequate to absorb
losses inherent in the Company's loan portfolio.

   
         For the six months ended June 30, 1998, the provision for loan losses
was $1.4 million, an increase of $1.3 million from the $132,000 provision for
the six months ended June 30, 1997. The allowance for loan losses as of June 30,
1998, as a percentage of total gross loans and as a percentage of non-performing
loans, was 1.04% and 145.8%, respectively, compared to 1.05% and 124.4%,
respectively at June 30, 1997. The Bank experienced a significant improvement in
asset quality during 1997 as improvements in the California economy occurred.
For example, the Bank experienced a 50% reduction in nonaccrual loans in 1997.
As management monitors the Bank's loan portfolio on a continuous basis, the
provisions for loan losses in the 1997 periods reflected this portfolio
improvement as it occurred and was identified. In 1998, provisions for loan
losses were increased to keep pace with the growth in the Bank's loan portfolio,
and in particular, growth in commercial loan products. The Bank's allowance
methodology provides higher loss factors for commercial loan products than for
residential mortgage (1 to 4 family) loans.
    

         For the year ended December 31, 1997, the provision for loan losses was
$1.2 million, a decrease of $303,000, or 20.0% from the $1.5 million provision
for the year ended December 31, 1996. The allowance for loan losses at December
31, 1997, as a percentage of total gross loans and as a percentage of
non-performing loans was 1.00% and 123.2%, respectively, compared to 1.10% and
60.0%, respectively, at December 31, 1996. The provision for loan losses for the
year ended December 31, 1996, was $1.5 million, which represents a decrease of
$7.3 million, or 83.2% from the $8.8 million provision for loan losses for the
year ended December 31, 1995. In 1995, management increased the allowance for
loan losses to address the continued depressed California economy and real
estate market and to significantly increase the Company's overall level of
allowance for loan losses to over 1.00% of gross loans.

         Noninterest Income. The following table sets forth the components of
noninterest income for the periods indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                             For the Six Months
                                               Ended June 30,            For the Years Ended December 31,
                                            --------------------        ----------------------------------
                                             1998          1997          1997          1996          1995
                                            ------        ------        ------        ------        ------
                                                             (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                         <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Service charges on deposit accounts....     $  544        $  482        $  888        $  615        $  566
Commercial banking fees................        565           429           977           421            92
Gain on sale of servicing rights.......        175           214         1,165           672           755
Gain (loss) on loan sales..............        132          (355)         (204)          528           382
Loss on sale of securities.............         --          (389)         (806)         (335)           --
Gain on branch sale....................         --            --            --            --           656
Loan servicing income..................        292           526           601           680           272
Miscellaneous income...................         24           258           473           816         1,044
                                            ------        ------        ------        ------        ------

Total noninterest income...............     $1,732        $1,165        $3,094        $3,397        $3,767
                                            ======        ======        ======        ======        ======
    
</TABLE>

   
         For the six months ended June 30, 1998, noninterest income was $1.7
million, an increase of $567,000, or 48.7% from $1.2 million for the same period
of the preceding year. For the year ended December 31, 1997, noninterest income
was $3.1 million, a decrease of $303,000, or 8.9% from the year ended December
31, 1996. Noninterest income in 1996 of $3.4 million decreased $370,000, or 9.8%
from the $3.8 million recognized during the year ended December 31, 1995.

         The increase in noninterest income for the first six months of 1998
primarily reflects the Bank not having incurred any losses on the sale of
COFI-based securities during the first half of 1998, compared with having
incurred $530,000 of such losses in the corresponding period of 1997.
    

                                       25

<PAGE>

         The decrease in noninterest income for the year ended December 31,
1997, reflects the $806,000 loss incurred in connection with the sale of
COFI-based securities pursuant to the Company's business strategy to reduce its
assets tied to COFI. The $1.2 million gain on sale of servicing rights is a
non-recurring gain recognized as a result of the disposition of such servicing
rights in conjunction with the Bank's decision to close its mortgage banking
division. Additionally, the $601,000 of loan servicing income is substantially
non-recurring since substantially all of the related servicing portfolio was
sold during 1997. Commercial banking fees increased to $977,000 in 1997, or
132.1% from the $421,000 in 1996 as a result of the Company's business focus
shift to commercial banking.

         Noninterest income for the year ended December 31, 1996, of $3.4
million is $370,000, or 9.8% less than the $3.8 million of noninterest income
for the year ended December 31, 1995. The noninterest income for the year ended
December 31, 1996, included $335,000 of losses incurred in conjunction with the
disposal of COFI-based securities. Included in noninterest income for the year
ended December 31, 1995, was a gain of $656,000 recognized in connection with
the sale of a retail branch.

         Noninterest Expense. The following table sets forth the components of
noninterest expense for the periods indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                   For the Six Months
                                                     Ended June 30,                  For the Years Ended December 31,
                                                ------------------------         ---------------------------------------
                                                  1998            1997            1997            1996            1995
                                                -------          -------         -------         -------         -------
                                                                           (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                             <C>              <C>             <C>             <C>             <C>
Personnel....................................    $8,247          $ 7,169         $14,087         $14,875         $12,000
Occupancy....................................     2,447            2,306           4,811           4,754           4,355
Data processing..............................     1,180              852           2,059           1,859           1,696
Furniture and equipment......................     1,170              979           1,902           1,814           1,357
Deposit insurance............................       457            1,142           1,798           3,519           3,051
SAIF recapitalization assessment.............        --               --              --           7,716              --
Communication................................       201              172             400             383             317
Professional fees and contracted services....       902              882           2,242           1,551           1,303
Foreclosed assets expense....................        (3)             393             671             686           2,785
Miscellaneous expense........................     2,693            2,050           4,220           4,256           3,278
                                                -------          -------         -------         -------         -------

Total noninterest expense....................   $17,294          $15,945         $32,190         $41,413         $30,142
                                                =======          =======         =======         =======         =======

Efficiency ratio.............................     66.10%           70.61%          69.33%          97.66%          92.45%
Efficiency ratio excluding SAIF
recapitalization assessment..................       N/A              N/A             N/A           79.46             N/A
Noninterest expenses to average assets(1)....      2.14%            2.11%           2.08            2.74            1.98
    
</TABLE>

- -------------------
   
(1) Annualized for the six months ended June 30, 1998 and 1997.

         Noninterest expense increased by $1.4 million, or 8.5%, to $17.3
million for the six months ended June 30, 1998 from $15.9 million for the six
months ended June 30, 1997, primarily as a result of increases in the Commercial
Banking Division staffing level, the recordation of incentive compensation
accruals, and the expenses associated with the computer conversion and the name
change of the Bank. Personnel expenses of $8.2 million for the first half of
1998 are $1.0 million, or 15% higher than the $7.2 million of personnel expenses
for the first half of 1997. This increase resulted primarily from the additional
staff which was hired to execute the commercial banking business plan and
incentive compensation accruals.

         During the first half of 1998, the Bank successfully completed a core
computer conversion to a system which is guaranteed to be year 2000 compliant.
Total nonrecurring conversion expenses for the six months ended June 30, 1998
were $333,000.
    

         Noninterest expense decreased to $32.2 million, or 22.3%, for the year
ended December 31, 1997 from $41.4 million for the year ended December 31, 1996,
primarily as a result of the $7.7 million SAIF recapitalization assessment
recognized in 1996. Deposit insurance premiums of $1.8 million for the year
ended December 31, 1997 compares with

                                       26

<PAGE>



$3.5 million for the year ended December 31, 1996, a decrease of 48.9% due to
the Bank reaching the "well capitalized" level. As a result of reaching this
capital level, the deposit insurance premium was reduced from 16.4 basis points
to 9.4 basis points on July 1, 1997. The average deposit insurance premium for
1997 was 12.9 basis points. The deposit insurance premium was further reduced to
6.4 basis points effective January 1, 1998. During 1997, the Bank began a core
computer conversion to a system which provides the necessary support for the
Bank's new commercial banking activities. Computer conversion related expenses
were $390,000 for the year ended December 31, 1997. New equipment purchases for
this conversion totaled $1.2 million which will be amortized over a four year
term commencing in 1998. As a result of the foregoing and the improved net
interest margin, the efficiency ratio decreased to 69.3% in 1997 from 97.7% in
1996.

         Noninterest expense increased to $41.4 million for the year ended
December 31, 1996 from $30.1 million for the year ended December 31, 1995 as a
result of (i) the $7.7 million SAIF recapitalization assessment, (ii) a $2.9
million increase in personnel expenses which was primarily the result of the
establishment of the commercial banking division and three new retail branches,
(iii) an increase of $457,000 in furniture and equipment expense and $399,000 in
occupancy expenses, both primarily in conjunction with the establishment of
three new retail branches in 1996, and (iv) a $1.0 million increase of
miscellaneous expense primarily due to additional printing and advertising
expenses relating to the establishment of the commercial banking division and
the establishment of merchant card services. The increase in the foregoing
categories of noninterest expense during 1996 was partially offset by a $2.1
million decline in foreclosed assets expense due, in part, to the reduction in
the Company's non-performing assets.

   
         Provision for Income Taxes. The provision for income taxes of $3.1
million and $2.7 million on the income before taxes of $7.5 million and $6.5
million for the six months ended June 30, 1998 and 1997, respectively,
represents an effective tax rate of 41.1%.
    

         For the year ended December 31, 1997, the provision for income taxes of
$5.8 million on the income before taxes of $13.1 million represents an effective
tax rate of 44.2%. For the year ended December 31, 1996, the Company had a tax
benefit of $177,000 on the loss before taxes of $483,000. For the year ended
December 31, 1995, the Company's tax benefit was $3.4 million on the loss before
taxes of $6.3 million.

         In 1997, the IRS concluded an examination of the income tax returns of
the Company for the years 1993 through 1995. The audit resulted in a cash
payment of $500,000, and the partial reversal of previously deferred tax assets
which approximated the allowances provided by the Company for this eventuality.

Financial Condition

   
         At June 30, 1998, the Company had total assets of $1.91 billion, an
increase of $348.7 million, or 22.2%, compared with $1.56 billion at December
31, 1997. At June 30, 1998, the Company had investment securities of $575.3
million, an increase of $305.2 million, or 113.0%, from December 31, 1997. At
June 30, 1998, the Company had net loans of $1.26 billion, an increase of $56.8
million, or 4.73%, from $1.20 billion at December 31, 1997. Total deposits of
$1.47 billion at June 30, 1998 were consistent with the balances at December 31,
1997. Borrowings at June 30, 1998 were $298 million whereas the Company had no
borrowings at December 31, 1997. At June 30, 1998, the Company had guaranteed
preferred beneficial interests in junior subordinated debentures of $30 million,
whereas none were outstanding at December 31, 1997. At June 30, 1998, the
Company had equity of $98.1 million, an increase of $35.6 million, or 56.8%,
from $62.6 million at December 31, 1997.
    

         At December 31, 1997, the Company had total assets of $1.56 billion and
total deposits of $1.47 billion. Total assets increased from $1.47 billion at
December 31, 1996, and total deposits increased from $1.39 billion at December
31, 1996. At December 31, 1997, the Company had net loans of $1.2 billion, a
14.3% increase from net loans of $1.05 billion at December 31, 1996. At December
31, 1997, the Company had investment securities totaling $270.1 million compared
to $343.7 million at December 31, 1996. At December 31, 1997, the Company had no
borrowings while the stockholders' equity increased to $62.6 million at December
31, 1997 from $54.3 million at December 31, 1996.

   
         Loan Portfolio. In connection with the Bank's balance sheet
restructuring, the Bank closed its mortgage banking division and ceased the
origination of nonconforming mortgages for sale in the secondary market, but
continued to originate conforming residential mortgages (1-4 family) primarily
for portfolio retention. Residential mortgages (1-4 family) originated for sale
in the six months ended June 30, 1998 aggregated $9.3 million as compared to
$8.0 million, $22.4 million, $83.4 million and $87.7 million in the six months
ended June 30, 1997 and the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995,
respectively. In addition, with the creation of its commercial banking division
in 1996, new emphasis was placed on the origination of commercial real estate
loans and commercial business loans. Total new commitments for commercial loans
originated in the six months ended June 30, 1998 were $25.8 million as compared
to $15.6 million, $31.9 million and $9.9 million for the six months ended June
30, 1997 and the years ended December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
    

                                       27

<PAGE>

         The following table shows the composition of the Bank's loan portfolio
by amount and percentage of total gross loans in each major loan category at the
dates indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                                                          At December 31,
                                                 At June 30,              -----------------------------------------------
                                                    1998                         1997                          1996      
                                             ------------------           ------------------           ------------------
                                             Amount         %             Amount         %             Amount         %  
                                             ------      ------           ------      ------           ------      ------
                                                                        (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                        <C>           <C>            <C>           <C>            <C>           <C>
Consumer
     Residential mortgage (1-4
       family)(1)....................      $  712,357     56.03%        $  691,167     56.98%        $  541,156     50.79%
     Home equity.....................          15,851      1.25             16,743      1.38             10,673      1.00
     Other...........................           2,321      0.18              2,732      0.23              2,642      0.25
                                           ----------    ------         ----------    ------         ----------    ------

          Total consumer.............         730,529     57.46            710,642     58.59            554,471     52.04
                                           ----------    ------         ----------    ------         ----------    ------

Commercial
     Secured by real estate - multi-
        family.......................         334,228     26.29            339,257     27.97            361,591     33.93 
     Secured by real estate -
        nonresidential(2) ...........         142,740     11.23            115,366      9.51            123,003     11.54
     Construction....................          35,810      2.82             26,603      2.19             19,892      1.87
     Commercial business.............          28,024      2.20             21,146      1.74              6,595      0.62
                                           ----------    ------         ----------    ------         ----------    ------

          Total commercial...........         540,802     42.54            502,372     41.41            511,081     47.96
                                           ----------    ------         ----------    ------         ----------    ------

Total gross loans....................       1,271,331    100.00%         1,213,014    100.00%         1,065,552    100.00%
                                                         ======                       ======                       ======

Net deferred loan origination
   costs.............................             820                        1,223                          816
Allowance for loan losses............         (13,207)                     (12,142)                     (11,682)
                                           ----------                   ----------                   ----------

Net loans............................      $1,258,944                   $1,202,095                   $1,054,686
                                           ==========                   ==========                   ==========
<CAPTION>
                                                                            At December 31,
                                             ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                    1995                          1994                        1993
                                             ------------------            -----------------            -----------------
                                             Amount         %              Amount        %              Amount        %
                                             ------      ------            ------     ------            ------     ------
                                                                        (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                        <C>           <C>              <C>         <C>              <C>         <C>
Consumer
     Residential mortgage (1-4
       family)(1)....................      $  507,121     49.45%          $432,045     44.33%          $380,570     42.85%
     Home equity.....................           1,193      0.12                 --        --                 --        --
     Other...........................           2,981      0.29              1,474      0.15              1,929      0.22
                                           ----------    ------           --------    ------           --------    ------

          Total consumer.............         511,295     49.86            433,519     44.48            382,499     43.07
                                           ----------    ------           --------    ------           --------    ------

Commercial
     Secured by real estate - multi-
        family.......................         376,398     36.70            391,509     40.17            329,401     37.09
     Secured by real estate -
        nonresidential(2) ...........         131,259     12.80            141,995     14.57            151,061     17.01
     Construction....................           6,612      0.64              7,597      0.78             25,115      2.83
     Commercial business.............              --        --                 --        --                 --        --
                                           ----------    ------           --------    ------           --------    ------

          Total commercial...........         514,269     50.14            541,101     55.52            505,577     56.93
                                           ----------    ------           --------    ------           --------    ------

Total gross loans....................       1,025,564    100.00%           974,620    100.00%           888,076    100.00%
                                                         ======                       ======                       ======

Net deferred loan origination
   costs.............................              44                       (1,402)                      (2,075)
Allowance for loan losses............         (13,699)                      (7,550)                      (8,000)
                                           ----------                     --------                     --------

Net loans............................      $1,011,909                     $965,668                     $878,001
                                           ==========                     ========                     ========
    
</TABLE>

- ------------
   
(1) Includes $502.8 million of limited documentation loans at June 30, 1998.
    See "Business--Lending Activities--Residential Mortgages (1-4 family).
(2) Includes $72.3 million, $87.5 million, $123.0 million,$131.3 million,
    $142.0 million, and $151.0 million of primarily COFI-based loans at June 30,
    1998 and at December 31, 1997, 1996, 1995,1994 and 1993, respectively,
    originated by the Bank during 1988 through 1992.
    

                                       28

<PAGE>

         The following table shows the Bank's loan originations during the
periods indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   

                                                  For the Six Months
                                                    Ended June 30,             For the Years Ended December 31,
                                                  --------------------        ---------------------------------
                                                   1998          1997          1997          1996          1995
                                                  ------        ------        ------        ------        -----
                                                                   (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                              <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Consumer
     Residential mortgage (1-4 family)
         For sale:
               GNMA............................  $     --      $    759      $    759      $ 33,066      $ 33,875
               FHLMC and FNMA..................     9,327         8,033        21,675        50,319        53,819
         For portfolio:
               Fully documented loans..........     8,456         4,700         7,867        10,675         8,932
               Limited documentation loans.....   117,714        77,930       244,523       131,548       114,251
    Home equity loans..........................     2,819         8,748        13,552        24,703         4,748
    Other......................................     1,714            --            --            --            --
                                                 --------      --------      --------      --------      --------

               Total consumer loans............   140,030       100,170       288,376       250,311       215,625
                                                 --------      --------      --------      --------      --------

Commercial
    Secured by real estate - multi-family......    15,580         4,189         7,461         7,318           842
    Secured by real estate - non-residential...    35,266        10,606        23,743         2,655           864
    Construction (1)...........................    41,693        27,217        59,569        42,166        15,737
    Commercial business........................    25,834        15,615        31,933         9,901            --
                                                 --------      --------      --------      --------      --------

               Total commercial loans..........   118,373        57,627       122,706        62,040        17,443
                                                 --------      --------      --------      --------      --------

               Total loan originations.........  $258,403      $157,797      $411,082      $312,351      $233,068
                                                 ========      ========      ========      ========      ========
    
</TABLE>

- -------------
(1)   Includes loans in process.

   
         Included in the Bank's residential mortgages (1-4 family) as of June
30, 1998 and December 31, 1997, respectively, were $502.8 million and $450.5
million, or 70.6% and 65.2% of limited documentation loans. Beginning in 1993,
the Bank has specialized in this loan product. Because of the less than full
documentation required for such loans, the Bank has emphasized relatively small
average loan size and low average loan-to-value ratios for these loans, as
evidenced by an average loan balance of $166,000 and average loan-to-value
ratios of 59% as of June 30, 1998.

         Since it began originating limited documentation loans, the Bank has
experienced no net charge-offs with respect to such loans. At June 30, 1998, the
Bank had two loans more than three payments delinquent with an aggregate
principal balance of $199,000. Moreover, during the third quarter of 1997, the
Bank sold $17.2 million of the limited documentation loans to test the market
reception for this product. The Bank received a price in excess of par value on
the sale of such loans. Notwithstanding the historical performance of this type
of loan, there can be no assurance that such performance will continue.

         Total gross loans increased $57.9 million, or 4.77%, to $1.27 billion
at June 30, 1998 from $1.21 billion at December 31, 1997 and 13.9%, from $1.07
billion at December 31, 1996, which was a 3.9% increase from $1.03 billion at
December 31, 1995. Increases in gross loans were the result of increases in
residential (1-4 family) loan production for portfolio retention and commercial
business loan generation resulting from the creation of the Bank's commercial
banking division in 1996.
    

                                       29

<PAGE>
   

         The following table sets forth the Bank's loan originations, purchases,
sales and principal repayments and changes in deferred fees and allowance for
loan losses for the periods indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                 For the Six Months Ended
                                                         June 30,                          For the Year Ended December 31,
                                                ---------------------------         --------------------------------------------
                                                   1998             1997               1997              1996            1995
                                                ----------       ----------         ----------        ----------      ----------
                                                                                 (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                             <C>              <C>                <C>               <C>             <C>
Net loans:
Balance at beginning of period..............    $1,202,095       $1,054,686         $1,054,686        $1,011,909      $  965,668
                                                ----------       ----------         ----------        ----------      ----------
    Originations............................       258,403          157,797            411,082           312,351         233,068
    Purchases...............................           217              361             44,416             7,642          16,677
    Sales...................................       (11,961)            (940)           (44,667)             (478)         (8,412)
    Principal repayments....................      (187,950)        (123,379)          (259,109)         (275,084)       (185,016)
    Increase (decrease) in premiums, 
      discounts and deferred fees...........          (403)            (156)               407               772           1,446
    Net (increase) decrease in allowance for
      loan losses...........................        (1,065)             204               (460)            2,017          (6,149)
    Transfers to real estate owned..........          (392)          (3,363)            (4,260)           (4,443)         (5,373)
                                                ----------       ----------         ----------        ----------      ----------
Balance at end of period....................    $1,258,944       $1,085,210         $1,202,095        $1,054,686      $1,011,909
                                                ==========       ==========         ==========        ==========      ==========
    
</TABLE>

   
         In 1996, management made a strategic decision to reduce its COFI-based
assets and in the fourth quarter of 1996 ceased COFI-based lending. In addition,
the Bank began to reduce its COFI-based loan portfolio through amortization and
sales and replace it with current-index products including adjustable-rate
mortgage loans and loans with an initial rate of interest for a fixed term
(generally 3 to 5 years), the interest rates on which adjust annually thereafter
("intermediate fixed-rate loans"). As a result of this initiative, the Bank's
COFI-based loans declined to $505.9 million at June 30, 1998 from $554.4
million, $641.9 million, and $670.7 million at December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995,
respectively.

         At June 30, 1998, total gross loans included $307.4 million of
intermediate fixed-rate loans compared with $291.5 million at December 31, 1997,
an increase of $15.9 million or 5.5% which was the result of the Bank continuing
to emphasize the origination of intermediate fixed-rate mortgages (1-4 family).
Fixed-rate loans at June 30, 1998 were $277.4 million compared with $241.5
million at December 31, 1997, an increase of 15.0% which was the result of the
origination of primarily fifteen year mortgages.
    

                                       30

<PAGE>

         As of December 31, 1997, total gross loans included $291.5 million of
intermediate fixed-rate loans compared with $224.3 million as of December 31,
1996, an increase of 30.0% which was the result of the Bank emphasizing the
origination of intermediate fixed-rate residential mortgages (1-4 family) during
1997. Fixed-rate loans as of December 31, 1997 were $241.5 million compared with
$176.8 million as of December 31, 1996, an increase of 36.6% which was the
result of the origination of fifteen and thirty year fixed-rate loans during
1997. To better manage its interest rate risk, the Bank has ceased the
origination of thirty year fixed-rate loans for portfolio retention, except on a
customer accommodation basis.

         As of December 31, 1996, total gross loans included $224.3 million of
intermediate fixed-rate loans, compared with $213.4 million as of December 31,
1995, an increase of 5.1%. As of December 31, 1996, total fixed-rate loans were
$176.8 million as compared to $143.9 million as of December 31, 1995. As of
December 31, 1996, the ARM loan portfolio was $664.4 million as compared with
$668.3 million as of December 31, 1995, a decrease of 0.6%.

         The following table sets forth the contractual loan maturity of the
Bank's loan portfolio at June 30, 1998. ARM loans are shown in the periods in
which they reprise rather than when they become due. The table does not include
the effect of future principal prepayments. The rate of loan prepayment varies
from time-to-time, depending upon various factors including market interest
rates.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                                                 At June 30, 1998
                                               ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                 After Ten
                                                            After         After        After       Years
                                                          One Year     Three Years  Five Years    Through     After
                                                Within     Through       Through      Through     Twenty     Twenty
                                               One Year  Three Years   Five Years    Ten Years     Years      Years        Total
                                               --------  -----------   -----------  ----------   ---------   -------       -----
                                                                              (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                            <C>         <C>           <C>         <C>          <C>        <C>        <C>
Consumer:
     Residential mortgage (1-4 family).......  $214,806    $ 84,690      $184,664    $ 9,214      $174,188   $44,795    $  712,357
     Home equity.............................    15,851          --            --         --            --        --        15,851
     Other...................................     2,321          --            --         --            --        --         2,321
                                               --------    --------      --------    -------      --------   -------    ----------
          Total consumer.....................   232,978      84,690       184,664      9,214       174,188    44,795       730,529

Commercial:
     Secured by real estate - multi-family...   281,961      15,992        13,204     15,969         7,102        --       334,228
     Secured by real estate -
        nonresidential.......................   112,457          30        21,106      2,249         6,898        --       142,740
     Construction............................    35,810          --            --         --            --        --        35,810
     Commercial business.....................    27,451         492            --         --            --        81        28,024
                                               --------    --------      --------    -------      --------   -------    ----------
          Total commercial...................   457,679      16,514        34,310     18,218        14,000        81       540,802
          Total loans........................  $690,657    $101,204      $218,974    $27,432      $188,188   $44,876     1,271,331
                                               ========    ========      ========    =======      ========   =======    ----------
Net deferred loan origination costs..........                                                                                  820
Allowance for loan losses....................                                                                              (13,207)
                                                                                                                        ----------
Net loans....................................                                                                           $1,258,944
                                                                                                                        ==========
    
</TABLE>

                                       31

<PAGE>

   
         The following table sets forth at June 30, 1998 the dollar amount of
loans and mortgage-backed securities contractually due or repricing after June
30, 1999 and whether such loans and securities have fixed or adjustable interest
rates.
    

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                              Due or Repricing After June 30, 1999
                                                             ---------------------------------------
                                                               Fixed       Adjustable       Total
                                                             --------      ----------     ----------
                                                                     (Dollars in Thousands)
         <S>                                                 <C>            <C>           <C>
          Consumer:
               Residential mortgage (1-4 family)             $220,680       $276,870        $497,550
               Home equity...............................          --             --              --
               Other.....................................          --             --              --
                                                             --------       --------      ----------

                    Total consumer.......................     220,680        276,870         497,550

          Commercial:
               Secured by real estate - multi-family.....      38,443         13,824          52,267
               Secured by real estate - nonresidential...      13,536         16,747          30,283
               Construction..............................          --             --              --
               Commercial business.......................         574             --             574
                                                             --------       --------      ----------
                    Total commercial.....................      52,553         30,571          83,124
                     Total loans.........................     273,233        307,441         580,674
                                                             --------       --------      ----------

          Mortgage-backed securities.....................     220,574        256,122         476,696
                                                             --------       --------      ----------


          Total loans and mortgage-backed
             securities..................................    $493,807       $563,563      $1,057,370
                                                             ========       ========      ==========
    
</TABLE>

         Non-Performing Assets and OREO. Management generally places loans on
non-accrual status when they become 90 days past due, unless they are both well
secured and in the process of collection. When a loan is placed on non-accrual
status, any interest previously accrued but not collected is reversed from
income. Loans are charged off when management determines that collection has
become unlikely. Other real estate owned ("OREO") consists of real property
acquired through foreclosure on the collateral underlying defaulted loans.

                                       32

<PAGE>

         The following table sets forth information regarding non-performing
assets at the dates indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                                                          At December 31
                                                At June 30,   -------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                   1998          1997          1996          1995           1994          1993
                                                -----------   ----------    ----------    ----------      --------     ----------
                                                                               (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                             <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>             <C>          <C>
Non-accrual loans
Consumer:
    Residential mortgage (1 to 4 family).....   $    5,610    $    6,131    $    7,085    $    9,366      $  6,379     $    9,656
    Home equity..............................           --            15            --            --            --             --
    Other....................................           --            --            --            --            --             --
                                                ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------      --------     ----------
         Total consumer......................        5,610         6,146         7,085         9,366         6,379          9,656
                                                ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------      --------     ----------

Commercial:
    Secured by real estate-multifamily.......          165           904         3,496         5,673           801          1,049
    Secured by real estate-nonresidential....        3,281         2,804         8,896         5,445         4,144          2,829
    Construction.............................           --            --            --            --            --          1,057
    Commercial business......................           --            --            --           --             --             --
                                                ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------      --------     ----------
        Total commercial.....................        3,446         3,708        12,392        11,118         4,945          4,935
                                                ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------      --------     ----------

Total non-accrual loans......................        9,056         9,854        19,477        20,484        11,324         14,591
Other real estate owned (OREO)...............          240           412         1,619         1,803         5,023         14,415
                                                ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------      --------     ----------
Total non-performing assets..................   $    9,296    $   10,267    $   21,096    $   22,287      $ 16,347     $   29,006
                                                ==========    ==========    ==========    ==========      ========     ==========
Non-performing assets to total assets........         0.49%         0.66%         1.43%         1.46%         1.07%          1.99%
Non-accrual loans to total loans.............         0.71          0.81          1.83          2.00          1.16           1.64
Non-performing assets to total loans and
     OREO....................................         0.73          0.85          1.98          2.17          1.67           3.21
Total gross loans............................   $1,271,331    $1,213,015    $1,065,552    $1,025,564      $974,620     $  888,076
                                                ==========    ==========    ==========    ==========      ========     ==========
Gross income not recognized on
   nonaccrual loans..........................   $      106    $       64    $      172    $      487      $    224            n/a
Accruing loans contractually past due
   90 days or more...........................           --            --            --            --            --             --
Loans classified as troubled debt
   restructurings but not included above.....           --            --            --            --            --             --

    
</TABLE>

   
         The Bank records OREO at the lower of carrying value or fair value less
estimated costs to sell. Estimated losses that result from the ongoing periodic
valuation of these properties are charged to earnings with a provision for
losses on foreclosed property in the period in which they are identified. During
the six months ended June 30, 1998, the Bank reduced total non-performing assets
to $9.3 million from $10.3 million at December 31, 1997, a decrease of $1.0
million or 9.7%. During 1997, the Bank reduced total non-performing assets to
$10.3 million as of December 31, 1997 from $21.1 million as of December 31,
1996, a reduction of $10.8 million or 51.3%. The reduction was the result of the
sale of non-performing loans and the reclassification of other loans which
became current and were reclassified to performing status. During the six months
ended June 30, 1998, the Bank reduced OREO from $412,000 to $240,000, or 41.7%,
as a result of the sale of assets. During the year ended December 31, 1997, OREO
decreased from $1.6 million to $412,000, or 74.5% as a result of the disposition
of the assets. At June 30, 1998, OREO consisted of four properties acquired
through foreclosure with a carrying value of $240,000.
    

         The policy of the Bank is to review each loan in the portfolio to
identify problem credits. There are four classifications for problem loans
"special mention," "substandard," "doubtful" and "loss." Special mention loans
do not yet warrant adverse classification, but possess credit deficiencies or
potential weaknesses requiring the Bank's attention. Substandard loans have one
or more well-defined weaknesses and are characterized by the distinct
possibility that the Bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not
corrected. Doubtful loans have the weaknesses of substandard loans with the
additional characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in
full on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions and values
questionable, and there is a high possibility of loss. A loan classified "loss"
is considered uncollectible and its continuance as an asset is not warranted.

                                       33

<PAGE>

         The following table sets forth criticized loans at the dates indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                               At June 30,                              At December 31,
                                          --------------------      ------------------------------------------------------
                                            1998         1997         1997        1996        1995       1994       1993
                                          -------      -------      -------     -------     -------    -------     -------
                                                                              (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                       <C>          <C>          <C>         <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>
Special mention loans..................    $7,718      $16,211      $ 7,182     $15,902     $ 3,066    $15,226     $11,547
Substandard and doubtful loans.........    12,999       14,362       16,822      19,235      28,462     20,248      25,044
                                          -------      -------      -------     -------     -------    -------     -------

   Total criticized loans..............   $20,717      $30,573      $24,004     $35,137     $31,528    $35,474     $36,591
                                          =======      =======      =======     =======     =======    =======     =======

Total allowance for loan losses........   $13,207      $11,478      $12,142     $11,682     $13,699    $ 7,550     $ 8,000
                                          =======      =======      =======     =======     =======    =======     =======

Special mention loans to total loans...      0.61%        1.48%        0.59%       1.49%       0.30%      1.56%       1.30%
Substandard and doubtful loans to total
   loans...............................      1.02         1.31         1.39        1.80        2.78       2.08        2.83
Criticized loans to total loans........      1.63         2.79         1.98        3.30        3.07       3.65        4.13
Allowance for loan losses to
substandard and doubtful loans.........    101.60        79.92        72.18       60.73       48.13      37.29       31.94
Allowance for loan losses to criticized
   loans...............................     63.75        37.54        50.58       33.25       43.45      21.28       21.86

    
</TABLE>

   
         With the exception of the criticized loans described above, management
is not aware of any other loans as of June 30, 1998 where the known credit
problems of the borrower would cause management to doubt such borrower's ability
to comply with their present loan repayment terms or that would result in such
loans being included in the non-performing asset table above at some future
date. During the first six months of 1998, the Bank employed an outside loan
review firm to review the classification of its commercial loan portfolio. There
were no material changes in the classifications as a result of such review.
    

         Management cannot predict the extent to which economic conditions in
the Bank's market area may worsen or the full impact such conditions may have on
the Bank's loan portfolio. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that other
loans will not become 90 days or more past due, be placed on non-accrual status
or become impaired or restructured loans or OREO in the future.

                                       34

<PAGE>

         The following table sets forth delinquencies in the Bank's loan
portfolio at the dates indicated:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                    At June 30, 1998                               At December 31, 1997       
                                            -------------------------------------   ---------------------------------------------
                                               60-89 Days       90 Days or More          60-89 Days              90 Days or More 
                                            -----------------  ------------------   ---------------------       -----------------
                                                    Principal           Principal               Principal               Principal
                                            Number   Balance   Number    Balance    Number       Balance        Number   Balance 
                                            ------  ---------  ------   ---------   ------      ---------       ------  ---------
                                                                            (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                           <C>      <C>       <C>     <C>          <C>         <C>             <C>     <C>
Consumer:
Residential mortgages (1-4 family).......      3       $523      16      $2,671        6          $717            16      $3,547
Home equity..............................     --         --      --          --        2            49             1          15
Other....................................     11         18      11          20       27            35            22          44
                                              --       ----      --      ------       --          ----            --      ------

     Total consumer......................     14        541      27       2,691       35           801            39       3,606
                                              --       ----      --      ------       --          ----            --      ------

Commercial:
Secured by real estate - multi-family....     --         --      --          --       --            --            --          --
Secured by real estate - nonresidential..     --         --       1         740       --            --             2       2,418
Construction.............................     --         --      --          --       --            --            --          --
Commercial business......................     --         --      --          --       --            --            --          --

     Total commercial....................     --         --       1         740       --            --             2       2,418
                                              --       ----      --      ------       --          ----            --      ------

Total....................................     14       $541      28      $3,431       35          $801            41      $6,024
                                              ==       ====      ==      ======       ==          ====            ==      ======
<CAPTION>
                                                    At December 31, 1996                           At December 31, 1995       
                                            -------------------------------------   ---------------------------------------------
                                               60-89 Days       90 Days or More          60-89 Days              90 Days or More 
                                            -----------------  ------------------   ---------------------       -----------------
                                                    Principal           Principal               Principal               Principal
                                            Number   Balance   Number    Balance    Number       Balance        Number   Balance
                                            ------  ---------  ------   ---------   ------      ---------       ------  ---------
                                                                            (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                           <C>    <C>         <C>    <C>           <C>         <C>             <C>    <C>
Consumer:
Residential mortgages (1-4 family)             9     $1,054      22     $ 4,179        8          $310            32     $ 6,055
Home equity.......................            --         --      --          --       --            --            --          --
Other.............................            19         29      12          14        9            34            12           8
                                              --     ------      --     -------       --          ----            --     -------

     Total consumer...............            28      1,083      34       4,193       17           344            44       6,063
                                              --     ------      --     -------       --          ----            --     -------

Commercial:
Secured by real estate - multi-family         --         --       1         940       --            --             2       1,872
Secured by real estate - nonresidential       --         --       6       6,054       --            --             6       3,750
Construction......................            --         --      --          --       --            --            --          --
Commercial business...............            --         --      --          --       --            --            --          --

     Total commercial.............            --         --       7       6,994       --            --             8       5,622
                                              --     ------      --     -------       --          ----            --     -------

Total.............................            28     $1,083      41     $11,187       17          $344            52     $11,683
                                              ==     ======      ==     =======       ==          ====            ==     =======
    
</TABLE>

                                       35

<PAGE>

   
         During the six months ended June 30, 1998, delinquent residential
mortgages (1-4 family) decreased to $3.2 million or 0.45% of gross residential
mortgages (1-4 family) from $4.3 million or 0.62% of gross residential mortgages
(1-4 family) at December 31, 1997. During the year ended December 31, 1997,
delinquent residential mortgages (1-4 family) decreased from $5.2 million, or
0.97% of gross residential mortgages (1-4 family) at December 31, 1996. This
compares with a decrease from $6.4 million as of December 31, 1995, or 1.26% of
gross residential mortgages (1-4 family). Management attributes the reduction in
delinquent loans to a general improvement in the California economy and to the
greater focus by management on the reduction of delinquent loans.

         Delinquent mortgage loans secured by nonresidential real estate
decreased to $740,000 at June 30, 1998 from $2.4 million at December 31, 1997 as
a result of the assumption of one of the delinquent nonresidential loans by a
third party. Delinquent mortgage loans secured by nonresidential real estate
decreased to $2.4 million as of December 31, 1997 from $6.1 million as of
December 31, 1996, or by 60.7% as a result of the sale of one delinquent loan
during the period. At June 30, 1998, there were no delinquent mortgage loans
secured by multi-family real estate.
    

         Allowance For Loan Losses. The Bank has established a formalized
process for determining an adequate allowance for loan losses. This process
results in an allowance that consists of two components, allocated and
unallocated. The allocated component includes allowance estimates that result
from analyzing certain individual loans (including impaired loans), and includes
the results of analyzing loans on a pool basis. For loans that are analyzed
individually, third party information such as appraisals may be used to
supplement management's analysis. For loans that are analyzed on a pool basis,
such as residential mortgage loans (1-4 family), management's analysis consists
of reviewing delinquency trends, charge-off experience, economic conditions,
current composition of the loan portfolio, regional collateral value trends, and
other factors. The unallocated component of the allowance for loan losses is
intended to compensate for the subjective nature of estimating an adequate
allowance for loan losses, economic uncertainties, and other factors. In
addition to the assessment performed by management, the Bank's loan portfolio is
subject to an internal asset review function and is examined by its regulators.
The results of these examinations are incorporated into management's assessment
of the allowance for loan losses.

         The allowance for loan losses is increased by provisions for loan
losses and reduced by charge-offs, net of recoveries. Loans are charged off to
the extent they are classified as loss either internally or by the Bank's
regulators. For any loan that is past due for more than 90 days, management will
generally charge off the amount by which the recorded loan amount exceeds the
value of the underlying collateral, unless the loan is both well-secured and in
the process of collection. Recoveries of amounts that have previously been
charged off are generally recorded only to the extent that cash is received.

         While management uses available evidence in assessing the adequacy of
the allowance for loan losses, future additions to the allowance for loan losses
will be subject to continuing evaluations of the inherent risk in the portfolio.
If the economy declines or asset quality deteriorates, additional provisions for
loan losses could be required. Additionally, the Bank's regulators review the
adequacy of the allowance for loan losses as part of their examination process
and may require the Bank to record additional provisions for loan losses based
on their judgment or information available to them at the time of their
examinations. Management believes that the allowance for loan losses is adequate
to provide for estimated losses inherent in the Bank's loan portfolio.

                                       36


<PAGE>



         The following table sets forth information concerning the Bank's
allowance for loan losses for the dates indicated:
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     For the Six Months
                                                                        Ended June 30,       
                                                                   -----------------------   
                                                                    1998              1997   
                                                                   ------            ------  
                                                                    (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                                <C>               <C>
Allowance for loan losses:
Balance beginning of period.............................           $12,142           $11,682
                                                                   -------           -------
Provision for loan losses...............................             1,401               132
Charge-offs:
     Consumer:
          Residential mortgage (1-4 family).............                86               473
          Other.........................................                90                98
                                                                   -------           -------
               Total consumer...........................               176               571
                                                                   -------           -------

     Commercial:
          Secured by real estate - multi-family.........                --                13
          Secured by real estate - nonresidential.......               170               246
          Construction..................................                --                --
          Commercial business...........................                --                --
                                                                   -------           -------
               Total commercial.........................               170               259
                                                                   -------           -------

Total charge-offs.......................................               346               830
                                                                   -------           -------

Recoveries:
         Consumer:
             Residential mortgage (1-4 family)..........                --                37
             Other......................................                10                15
                                                                   -------           -------
                 Total consumer.........................                10                52
                                                                   -------           -------

         Commercial:
              Secured by real estate-multi-family.......                --               163
              Secured by real estate-nonresidential.....                --               279
              Construction..............................                --                --
              Commercial business.......................                --                --
                                                                   -------           -------
                   Total commercial.....................                --               442
                                                                   -------           -------

              Total recoveries..........................                10               494
                                                                   -------           -------

Balance at end of period................................           $13,207           $11,478
                                                                   =======           =======

Allowance for loan losses to ending loans...............              1.04%             1.05%
Net charge-offs to average loans outstanding(1).........              0.05              0.06 
</TABLE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   For the Years Ended December 31,
                                                                                  -------------------------------- 
                                                                      1997           1996          1995         1994          1993
                                                                      ----           ----          ----         ----          -----
                                                                                         (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                                 <C>              <C>          <C>            <C>         <C>
Allowance for loan losses:
Balance beginning of period............................             $11,682          $13,699      $ 7,550       $8,000       $6,979
                                                                    -------          -------      -------       ------       ------
Provision for loan losses...............................              1,154            1,476        8,777        3,206        8,898
Charge-offs:                                                                                              
     Consumer:                                                                                                               
          Residential mortgage (1-4 family).............                616              949        1,000        3,337        6,867
          Other.........................................                194              227           29           51           71
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
               Total consumer...........................                810            1,176        1,029        3,388        6,938
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
                                                                                                                             
     Commercial:                                                                                                             
          Secured by real estate - multi-family.........                 13              783          737           76          208
          Secured by real estate - nonresidential.......                246            2,604          930          508        1,339
          Construction..................................                 --               --           --           --           80
          Commercial business...........................                 --               --           --           --         --  
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
               Total commercial.........................                259            3,387        1,667          585        1,627
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
                                                                                                                             
Total charge-offs.......................................              1,069            4,563        2,696        3,972        8,565
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
                                                                                                                             
Recoveries:                                                                                                                  
         Consumer:                                                                                                           
             Residential mortgage (1-4 family)..........                 52               --           60          190          122
             Other......................................                 34               33            7           10           18
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
                 Total consumer.........................                 86               33           67          200          140
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
                                                                                                                             
         Commercial:                                                                                                         
              Secured by real estate-multi-family.......                 10              367           --           --           --
              Secured by real estate-nonresidential.....                279              670           --          115          252
              Construction..............................                 --               --           --           --          233
              Commercial business.......................                 --               --            1            1           63
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
                   Total commercial.....................                289            1,037            1          117          548
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
                                                                                                                             
              Total recoveries..........................                375            1,070           68          316          688
                                                                   --------          -------      -------       ------       ------
                                                                                                                             
Balance at end of period................................            $12,142          $11,682      $13,699       $7,550       $8,000
                                                                    =======          =======      =======       ======       ======
                                                                                                                               
Allowance for loan losses to ending loans...............               1.00%            1.10%        1.34%        0.78%        0.90%
Net charge-offs to average loans outstanding(1).........               0.06             0.34         0.26         0.37         0.85
</TABLE>

__________
1) Annualized for the six months ended June 30, 1998 and 1997.

    


                                       37

<PAGE>


   
         During the six months ended June 30, 1998, the allowance for loan
losses increased to $13.2 million from $12.1 million at December 31, 1997, or by
8.8%, due to the Bank providing additional loss provisions of $1.4 million and
recording net charge-offs of $336,000. During the year ended December 31, 1997,
the allowance for loan losses increased to $12.1 million from $11.7 million as
of December 31, 1996, or by 3.4%, due to the Bank providing additional loan loss
provisions of $1.2 million and recording net charge-offs of $694,000 during the
year as California real estate values rebounded. During the year ended December
31, 1996, the allowance for loan losses decreased to $11.7 million from $13.7
million as of December 31, 1995, or by 14.6%, as a result of net charge-offs of
$3.5 million during the year which was partially offset by an additional
provision of $1.5 million. The $8.8 million provision for loan losses for the
year ended December 31, 1995, reflected management's decision to increase the
allowance for loan losses to address the continued depressed California economy
and real estate market and to significantly increase the Company's overall level
of loan loss allowance to over 1.00% of gross loans.

    


                                       38

<PAGE>



         The following table provides a summary of the allocation of the
allowance for loan losses for individual loan categories at the dates indicated.
The allocations presented should not be interpreted as an indication that
charge- offs will be incurred in these amounts or proportions, or that the
portion of the allowance allocated to each loan category represents the total
amount available for losses that may occur within that loan category. The entire
amount of the allowance for loan losses is available to absorb loan losses,
irrespective of the loan category to which any potential charge-off might
relate.

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   At June 30,                           At December 31,
                                                ----------------    ------------------------------------------------------------
                                                      1998                 1997                 1996                  1995      
                                                ----------------    ----------------    ------------------     -----------------
                                                Amount     %(1)      Amount    %(1)      Amount      %(1)       Amount      %(1) 
                                                ------    ------    -------   ------    --------    ------     -------     ----- 
                                                                           (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                           <C>          <C>       <C>       <C>      <C>          <C>       <C>          <C>
Allocated:
Consumer:
     Residential mortgage (1-4 family)        $ 1,963      56.03%   $ 1,982    56.98%   $ 1,697      50.79%    $ 2,691      49.45%
     Home equity......................            239       1.25        255     1.38        222       1.00          13       0.12 
     Other............................            185       0.18        238     0.23         82       0.25          76       0.29 
                                              -------     ------    -------   ------    -------     ------     -------     ------ 

          Total consumer..............          2,387      57.46      2,475    58.58      2,001      52.04       2,780      49.86 
                                              -------     ------    -------   ------    -------     ------     -------     ------ 

Commercial:
     Secured by real estate - multi-family      2,391      26.29      2,130    27.97      2,533      33.93       2,384      36.70 
     Secured by real estate - nonresidential    2,045      11.23      1,919     9.51      2,811      11.54       3,323      12.80 
     Construction loans...............            658       2.82        508     2.19        252       1.87          98       0.64 
     Commercial business..............            624       2.20        572     1.74        117       0.62          --         -- 
                                              -------     ------    -------   ------    -------    -------     -------     -----

          Total commercial............          5,718      42.54      5,129    41.42      5,713      47.96       5,805      50.14 
Other.................................             79         --         83       --        141         --         275         -- 
                                              -------     ------    -------   ------    -------     ------     -------     ------

Total allocated.......................          8,184     100.00%     7,687   100.00%     7,855     100.00%      8,860     100.00%
Unallocated...........................          5,023         --      4,455       --      3,827         --       4,839      --    
                                              -------     ------    -------   ------    -------   --------     -------     ------

          Total allowance for loan losses     $13,207     100.00%   $12,142   100.00%   $11,682     100.00%    $13,699     100.00%
                                              =======     ======    =======   ======    =======     ======     =======      ====== 
</TABLE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          At December 31,
                                               -------------------------------------
                                                     1994                  1993
                                                    ------                ----- 
                                               Amount      %(1)      Amount     %(1)
                                               ------      ----      ------     ----
                                                      (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                            <C>         <C>       <C>       <C>
Allocated:                                                                           
Consumer:                                                                            
     Residential mortgage (1-4 family)         $1,512      44.33%    $1,907    42.85%
     Home equity......................             --         --         --       -- 
     Other............................             11       0.15         16     0.22 
                                               ------     ------     ------    ----- 
                                                                                     
          Total consumer..............          1,523      44.48      1,923    43.07 
                                               ------     ------     ------   ------ 
                                                                                     
Commercial:                                                                          
     Secured by real estate - multi-family      2,307      40.17      2,055    37.09 
     Secured by real estate - nonresidential    2,693      14.57      2,753    17.01 
     Construction loans...............            259       0.78        447     2.83 
     Commercial business..............             --         --         --       -- 
                                               ------     ------     ------   ------ 
                                                                                     
          Total commercial............          5,259      55.52      5,255    56.93 
Other.................................            162         --        501       -- 
                                               ------     ------     ------   ------ 
                                                                                     
Total allocated.......................          6,944     100.00%     7,679   100.00%
Unallocated...........................            606         --        321       -- 
                                               ------     ------     ------   ------ 
                                                                                     
          Total allowance for loan losses      $7,550     100.00%    $8,000   100.00%
                                               ======     ======     ======   ====== 
</TABLE>
    

____________
(1) Represents percentage of gross loans outstanding in specified category to
    total gross loans.




                                       39

<PAGE>


   
         Securities. The Bank has historically maintained a securities portfolio
comprised primarily of COFI-based FHLMC and FNMA securities which reprice on a
monthly basis. As a result of the proceeds the Company received and made
available to the Bank from the Private Offerings, the Bank purchased U.S.
Government agency mortgage-backed securities, investment grade securities,
investment grade municipal bonds, and investment grade residential 1-4 family
mortgage-backed securities. The following table sets forth the Bank's securities
portfolio on the date indicated.


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                            At December 31,
                                                                   -----------------------------------------------------------------
                                             At June 30, 1998             1997                   1996                   1995
                                            ------------------     ------------------    -------------------    -------------------
                                            Amortized   Market     Amortized   Market    Amortized    Market    Amortized    Market
                                              Cost      Value        Cost      Value       Cost       Value       Cost       Value
                                            ---------  -------     --------   -------    ---------   -------    ---------   --------
                                                                           (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                         <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>
Investment securities held to maturity:
   FHLB Note............................    $     --   $     --    $  2,000   $  1,998    $  8,670   $  8,629    $ 12,960   $ 12,873
   FHLB Note............................          --         --       2,000      2,000       2,000      2,000       2,000      2,000
   SLMA Step-Up.........................          --         --          --         --          --         --      25,000     25,000
   Other................................          --         --          --         --       5,000      4,988       7,000      6,979
                                            ---------  --------    --------   --------    --------   --------    --------   --------
      Total.............................    $     --   $     --    $  4,000   $  3,998    $ 15,670   $ 15,617    $ 46,960   $ 46,852
                                            =========  ========    ========   ========    ========   ========    ========   ========

Investment securities available for sale:
   SLMA step-up.........................    $     --   $           $     --   $     --    $     --   $     --    $ 10,000   $ 10,000
   Municipals...........................      23,845     23,944          --         --          --         --          --         --
   Trust preferred securities...........      73,935     74,670          --         --          --         --          --         --
                                            --------   --------    --------   --------    --------   --------    --------   --------
      Total.............................    $ 97,780   $ 98,614    $     --   $     --    $     --   $     --    $ 10,000   $ 10,000
                                            ========   ========    ========   ========    ========   ========    ========   ========

Mortgage-backed securities held to
  maturity:
   FHLMC................................    $ 45,935   $ 44,378    $ 48,536   $ 46,618    $ 61,629   $ 59,014    $ 70,282   $ 68,503
   FNMA.................................     113,859    110,318     117,184    112,788     124,710    119,221     135,432    131,462
   Other................................      13,960     13,561      16,075     15,566      22,216     21,248      27,817     26,574
                                            --------   --------    --------   --------    --------   --------    --------   --------
      Total.............................    $173,754   $168,257    $181,795   $174,972    $208,555   $199,483    $233,531   $226,539
                                            ========   ========    ========   ========    ========   ========    ========   ========

Mortgage-backed securities available for 
  sale:
   FNMA.................................    $ 84,602   $ 82,368   $  87,237   $ 84,308    $123,982   $119,514    $141,616   $138,514
   GNMA.................................     120,202    120,774          --         --          --         --          --         --
   Other................................      99,682     99,800          --         --          --         --          --         --
                                            --------   --------   ---------   --------    --------   --------    --------   --------
      Total.............................    $304,486   $302,942   $  87,237   $ 84,308    $123,982   $119,514    $141,616   $138,514
                                            ========   ========   =========   ========    ========   ========    ========   ========
</TABLE>


         As of June 30, 1998, the aggregate amortized cost of the securities was
$576.0 million and the market value was $569.8 million. Of the total $6.2
million unrealized loss on these securities, $710,000 relates to securities
which are held as available-for-sale. Such unrealized losses, net of the related
tax benefit of $291,000, is reflected as a reduction of stockholders' equity.
The $5.5 million unrealized loss relating to the $173.8 million of securities
held to maturity has not been recognized in the financial statements.
    


                                       40

<PAGE>

   

         The following table sets forth the carrying value, weighted average
yields and contractual maturities of the Company's securities as of June 30,
1998.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      At June 30, 1998
                                   -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                              After One Year           After Five Years
                                                                 Through                  Through
                                      Within One Year           Five Years                Ten Years             After Ten Years     
                                  --------------------    ---------------------     --------------------     ---------------------  
                                   Book       Weighted      Book       Weighted       Book      Weighted       Book       Weighted  
                                 Carrying     Average     Carrying     Average      Carrying    Average      Carrying     Average   
                                  Value        Yield        Value        Yield        Value       Yield        Value        Yield   
                                 -------      -------     --------     --------     --------    --------     --------     --------  
                                                                              (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                            <C>               <C>      <C>             <C>      <C>             <C>       <C>            <C>     
Investment securities available 
  for sale:
      Municipals........        $    --           --%     $   --          --%      $   --          --%       $23,944        5.01%   
      Trust preferred
        securities......             --           --          --          --           --          --         74,670        7.56    
                                -------                   ------                   ------                    -------                
           Total........             --           --          --          --           --          --         98,614        6.94    
                                -------                   ------                                             -------                

Mortgage-backed
    securities available for
    sale:
       FNMA.............             --           --          --          --           --          --         82,368        5.92    
       GNMA.............             --           --          --          --           --          --        120,774        6.71    
       Other............             --           --          --          --           --          --         99,800        6.51    
                                -------                   ------                   ------                    -------                
           Total........             --           --          --          --           --          --        302,942        6.43    
                                -------                   ------                   ------                    -------                

Mortgage-backed
     securities held to
      maturity:
       FHLMC............             --           --          --          --           --          --         45,935        5.86    
       FNMA.............             --           --          --          --        2,343        5.75        111,516        5.69    
       Other mortgage-
           backed securities         --           --          --          --           --          --         13,960        6.43    
                                -------                   ------                   ------                    -------                

           Total........             --           --          --          --        2,343        5.75        171,411        5.80    
                                -------                   ------                    -----                    -------                
           Total securities     $    --           --      $   --          --       $2,343        5.75       $572,967        6.33    
                                =======                   ======                   ======                   ========                

</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                      At June 30, 1998    
                                   ---------------------- 
                                            Total         
                                   ---------------------- 
                                     Book        Weighted 
                                   Carrying      Average  
                                     Value        Yield   
                                   --------       -----   
<S>                                <C>             <C>
Investment securities available                           
  for sale:                                               
      Municipals........            $23,944        5.01%  
      Trust preferred                                     
        securities......             74,670        7.56   
                                    -------               
           Total........             98,614        6.94   
                                    ------                
                                                          
Mortgage-backed                                           
    securities available for                              
    sale:                                                 
       FNMA.............             82,368        5.92   
       GNMA.............            120,774        6.71   
       Other............             99,800        6.51   
                                    ------                
           Total........            302,942        6.43   
                                    -------               
                                                          
Mortgage-backed                                           
     securities held to                                   
      maturity:                                           
       FHLMC............             45,935        5.86   
       FNMA.............            113,859        5.69   
       Other mortgage-                                    
           backed securities         13,960        6.43   
                                    ------                
                                                          
           Total........            173,754        5.79   
                                    -------               
           Total securities        $575,310        6.33   
                                   ========               


</TABLE>




         Deposits. Deposits are the Bank's primary source of funding. At June
30, 1998, the Bank had a deposit mix of 75.0% in time deposits, 1.6% in money
market accounts, 14.7% in passbook accounts and 8.7% in NOW and checking
accounts. This compares with a deposit mix of 75.2%, 1.6%, 15.5% and 7.6% at
December 31, 1997, respectively.

         The Bank obtains deposits primarily from the communities it serves. No
material portion of its deposits have been obtained from or are dependent on any
one person or industry. At June 30, 1998, less than 2% of the Bank's deposits
were held by customers located outside the United States. In addition, as of
such date, the 100 depositors with the largest aggregate average deposit
balances comprised less than 10% of the Bank's total deposits. The Bank's
business is not seasonal in nature. The Bank accepts deposits in excess of
$100,000 from customers. Included in time deposits as of June 30, 1998, is
$280.1 million, or 19.0% of total deposits, of deposits of $100,000 or greater.
At June 30, the Bank had no brokered deposits.


    

                                       41

<PAGE>



         The following table sets forth the balances and rates paid for the
major categories of deposits at the dates indicated:

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                       At June 30,                                       At December 31,
                                       -----------                                       ---------------
                                           1998                     1997                   1996                      1995
                                      ----------------      -------------------     --------------------        -------------------
                                              Interest                 Interest                  Interest                  Interest
                                     Amount     Rate         Amount      Rate        Amount       Rate           Amount     Rate
                                     ------    ------       -------     ------      --------     ------         -------    -----
                                                                      (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                               <C>           <C>       <C>            <C>      <C>            <C>        <C>             <C>  
NOW and checking accounts....     $  128,079    0.70%     $  111,984     0.80%    $  106,491     0.79%      $   99,912      0.80%
Money market accounts........         23,856    3.31          20,986     2.48         22,111     2.39           25,425      2.39
Passbook accounts............        217,138    2.26         212,013     2.11        216,471     2.20          205,017      2.21
Time deposits...............       1,105,197    5.11       1,124,004     5.20      1,048,052     4.95          981,250      5.50
                                  ----------               ---------              ----------                ---------

Total........................     $1,472,270    4.28      $1,468,987     4.38     $1,393,125     4.17       $1,311,604      4.57
                                  ==========              ==========              ==========                =========
</TABLE>

         The average cost of deposits during the six months ended June 30, 1998
was 4.40% as compared to 4.26% for the same period in the previous year. The
average cost of deposits was 4.38%, 4.37% and 4.57% during the years ended
December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively. At June 30, 1998, the Bank's
average rate paid on deposits was 60 basis points lower than the COFI index.

         The following table presents, by various categories, the amount of time
deposit accounts as of June 30, 1998 and the time to maturity of the time
deposit accounts outstanding at June 30, 1998.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   Period to Maturity from June 30,
                                 -----------------------------------------------------------------
                                                     One Through
Certificate accounts             Within One Year     Three Years    Thereafter    At June 30, 1998
                                 ---------------     -----------    ----------    ----------------
                                         (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                <C>                  <C>            <C>            <C>       
3.99% or less...............       $   44,406           $    --        $  --          $   44,406
4.00% to 4.99%..............          259,509                --           --             259,509
5.00% to 5.99%..............          763,915            19,438          810             784,163
6.00% to 6.99%..............           16,868                 1          100              16,969
7.00% to 7.99%..............               --                --           --                  --
Over 8.00%..................              145                --            5                 149
                                   ----------           -------        -----          ----------
                                   $1,084,843           $19,439        $ 916          $1,105,197
                                   ==========           =======        =====          ==========
</TABLE>


         At June 30, 1998, the Bank had $280.1 million in certificate accounts
in amounts of $100,000 or more maturing as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         Amount
                                                                 ----------------------
         Maturity period                                         (Dollars in Thousands)
         ---------------                                                               
         <S>                                                            <C>     
         Three months or less.............................              $106,622
         Over 3 through 6 months..........................                50,564
         Over 6 through 12 months.........................               118,082
         Over 12 months...................................                 4,812
                                                                       ---------
                   Total..................................              $280,080
                                                                        ========
</TABLE>


    


                                       42

<PAGE>



         Other Borrowings. The following table sets forth certain information
regarding the short-term borrowings of the Bank at or for the dates indicated.

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 At or for the Six Months
                                                                       Ended June 30,          At or for the Year Ended December 31,
                                                                 ------------------------      ------------------------------------
                                                                   1998         1997              1997           1996          1995
                                                                   ----         ----              ----           ----          ----
                                                                                      (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                               <C>           <C>             <C>            <C>         <C> 
FHLB of San Francisco advances:
     Average balance outstanding........................          $ 46,927      $18,335        $11,176         $33,973     $ 29,278
     Maximum amount outstanding at any month-end period.           298,000       20,000         24,000          53,935      128,600
     Balance outstanding at end of period...............           298,000           --             --              --      128,600
     Weighted average interest rate during the period...              5.68%        5.53%          5.55%           6.02%        6.58%
     Weighted average interest rate at end of period....              5.64           --             --              --         5.90
     Weighted average remaining term to maturity at end of
       period (in years)..............................                   7           --             --              --           --
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase:
     Average balance outstanding........................          $     95      $10,743         $5,375         $15,819     $165,040
     Maximum amount outstanding at any month-end during
       the period......................................                 --        9,750             --          74,400      246,500
     Balance outstanding at end of period...............                --           --             --              --           --
     Weighted average interest rate during the period...              5.79%        5.42%          5.47%           6.31%        6.36%
     Weighted average interest rate at end of period....                --           --             --              --           --
     Weighted average remaining term to maturity at end of
       period (in years).................................               --           --             --              --           --
</TABLE>


         The Bank maintains a secured credit facility with the FHLB of San
Francisco against which advances may be made. The terms of this credit facility
require the Bank to maintain in safekeeping with the FHLB of San Francisco
eligible collateral of at least 100% of outstanding advances. At June 30, 1998,
the Bank had $298 million of advances outstanding. At December 31, 1997 and
1996, there were no advances outstanding. At June 30, 1998, credit availability
under this facility was approximately $64 million. Although the Bank eliminated
its outside borrowings in 1996, the Bank has utilized borrowings as a funding
source in conjunction with its strategy of leveraging the proceeds from the
Private Offerings, consistent with its asset and liability objectives and the
maintenance of its status as a "well capitalized" institution for regulatory
capital purposes. As of June 30, 1998, the Bank had borrowed $298 million from
the FHLB in conjunction with the leverage strategy, of which $202 million were
long-term and $96 million were overnight borrowings. Included in the long-term
advances of $202 million were $17 million which were fixed-rate for ten years
and $185 million which were for ten years but contained provisions that the FHLB
could, at their option, terminate the advances at quarterly intervals at
specified periods ranging from three to five years beyond the advance dates.
    

         Liquidity. Maintenance of adequate liquidity requires that sufficient
resources be available at all times to meet the cash flow requirements of the
Company. Liquidity in a financial institution is required primarily to provide
for deposit withdrawals and the credit needs of its customers and to take
advantage of investment opportunities as they arise. A financial institution may
achieve desired liquidity from both assets and liabilities. Cash and deposits
held in other banks, federal funds sold, other short term investments, maturing
loans and investments, payments of principal and interest on loans and
investments and potential loan sales are sources of asset liquidity. Deposit
growth and access to credit lines established with correspondent banks and
market sources of funds are sources of liquidity.

   
         At June 30, 1998, the Bank had outstanding commitments (including
unused lines of credit) to originate and/or purchase mortgage and non-mortgage
loans and securities of $243.7 million. Certificates of deposit which are
scheduled to mature within one year totaled $1.08 billion at June 30, 1998. The
Bank anticipates that it will have sufficient funds available to meet its
current loan commitments.
    


                                       43

<PAGE>

   
        The Company reviews its liquidity position on a regular basis based
upon its current position and expected trends of loans and deposits. Management
believes that the Company maintains adequate sources of liquidity to meet
its needs. The Bank's level of liquidity exceeded the applicable regulatory
guidelines as of June 30, 1998 and December 31, 1997 and 1996.
    

         Market Risk and Net Portfolio Value. Market risk is the risk of loss
from adverse changes in market prices and rates. The Company's market risk
arises primarily from interest rate risk inherent in its lending, investment and
deposit taking activities. The Company's profitability is affected by
fluctuations in interest rates. A sudden and substantial change in interest
rates may adversely impact the Company's earnings to the extent that the
interest rates borne by assets and liabilities do not change at the same speed,
to the same extent or on the same basis. To that end, management actively
monitors and manages its interest rate risk exposure.

         The principal objective of the Company's interest rate risk management
is to evaluate the interest rate risk inherent in certain balance sheet
accounts, determine the level of risk appropriate given the Company's business
strategy, operating environment, capital and liquidity requirements and
performance objectives, and manage the risk consistent with the Board of
Directors' approved guidelines. Through such management, the Company seeks to
minimize the vulnerability of its operations to changes in interest rates. The
Company's Board of Directors reviews the Company's interest rate risk position
quarterly. The Company's Asset/Liability Committee is comprised of the Company's
senior management under the direction of the Board of Directors, with senior
management responsible for reviewing with the Board of Directors its activities
and strategies, the effect of those strategies on the Company's net interest
margin, the market value of the portfolio and the effect that changes in
interest rates will have on the Company's portfolio and the Company's exposure
limits.
   
         The Company utilizes the following strategies to manage interest rate
risk: (i) origination and retention of intermediate fixed-rate and
adjustable-rate mortgage loans; (ii) sale of substantially all fixed-rate
mortgage loans with terms of thirty years without recourse; and (iii)
origination of prime-based commercial loans. The Company currently participates
in hedging programs, interest rate swaps and caps or other activities involving
the use of off-balance-sheet derivative financial instruments, to mitigate
interest rate risk.
    
         The Company's interest sensitivity is monitored by management through
the use of a model which estimates the change in the Company's net portfolio
value ("NPV") over a range of interest rate scenarios. NPV is defined as the
current market value of assets, minus the current market value of liabilities,
plus or minus the current value of off-balance-sheet items. Current market
values are estimated through cash flow-based methodologies. The change in NPV
measures an institution's vulnerability to changes in interest rates by
estimating the change in the market value of an institution's assets,
liabilities and off-balance-sheet contracts in response to an instantaneous
change in the general level of interest rates.
       
         As market interest rates decrease, the average maturities of the Bank's
loans (and securities) shorten as a result of accelerated prepayment speeds,
causing a relatively moderate increase in the value of such assets. The
relatively minor movements in the repricing of the Bank's deposit accounts in a
downwardly moving interest rate environment result in the value of deposits
decreasing at a more rapid speed than the assets increase in value.


                                       44

<PAGE>

   
         The following table lists the Bank's percentage change in NPV assuming
an immediate change of plus or minus of up to 400 basis points from the level of
interest rates at June 30, 1998. All assets presented in this table are
held-to-maturity or available-for-sale. At June 30, 1998, the Bank had no
trading securities.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

           Change in Interest Rates in Basis Points
                         (Rate Shock)                                             Net Portfolio Value
           ----------------------------------------                  ----------------------------------------------
                                                                     Amount            $ Change           % Change
                                                                     ------            --------           --------
                                                                                (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                                 <C>                <C>                      <C>
 400..........................................................      $ 89,231           (84,890)                -49
 300..........................................................       116,162           (57,959)                -33
 200..........................................................       138,855           (35,267)                -20
 100..........................................................       158,037           (16,085)                 -9
   0..........................................................       174,122                 --                 --
(100).........................................................       171,413            (2,709)                 -2
(200).........................................................       162,220           (11,902)                 -7
(300).........................................................       145,810           (28,312)                -16
(400).........................................................       123,091           (51,031)                -29
</TABLE>

    
         As market interest rates rise, the average maturities of the Bank's
loans (and securities) lengthen as a result of decreasing prepayment speeds.
Given the COFI concentration within the Bank's loan and securities portfolios
and the lag effect of movements in the COFI index, the value of these assets
decreases when market rates rise. Decreases in the value of the loans and
securities occur at a more rapid rate in the model than increases in the value
with respect to the Bank's deposits. The value of the increase in the Bank's
deposits increases slowly in an increasing interest rate environment due to the
high concentration of time deposits within the Bank's deposit base for which the
deposit terms are generally one year or less.

   
         Certain shortcomings are inherent in the methodology used in the above
interest rate risk measurements. Modeling changes in NPV require the making of
certain assumptions which may or may not reflect the manner in which actual
yields and costs respond to market interest rates. In this regard, the NPV model
presented assumes that the composition of the Bank's interest sensitive assets
and liabilities existing at the beginning of a period remains constant over the
period being measured. Accordingly, although the NPV measurement and net
interest income models provide an indication of the Bank's interest rate risk
exposure at a particular point in time, such measurements are not intended to
and do not provide a precise forecast of the effect of changes in market
interest rates on the Bank's net interest income and will differ from actual
results.

         Year 2000 Compliance. The Year 2000 issue is a situation that may
affect many electronic data processing systems. In order to minimize the length
of date fields, most computer programs eliminated the first two digits in the
year date field. This problem could affect date-sensitive calculations and treat
"00" as the year 1900 rather than 2000.

         The Bank has implemented a detailed Year 2000 plan to evaluate Year
2000 compliance of its computer systems and the equipment which support the
operations of the Bank. Also included in this Year 2000 plan is a detailed
review of the readiness of the Bank's service providers, vendors, major funds
providers, major borrowers and companies with which the Bank has material
investments for the Year 2000 issues. As of August 10, 1998, the Bank has met
all current target objectives of the Year 2000 plan, and management believes
that it will continue to meet all future target objectives in accordance with
the terms of the plan.

         In conjunction with the Bank converting to a commercial banking
charter, the Bank installed a new core computer system which was compatible with
the commercial banking business needs. This commercial banking data processing
system is run in a service bureau environment by one of the leading national
vendors of data processing services for banks. The Bank implemented its new core
banking system because of the change in its business focus to commercial
banking. The commercial banking products offered by the Bank were not supported
by the software applications offered as part of the Bank's prior data processing
platform. Additionally, the vendor that ran the Bank's prior data processing
platform indicated that it would not support that data processing platform
beyond 1998, and in fact, service quality had begun to deteriorate in 1997. The
vendor of the new core system is executing its Year 2000 readiness plan in
cooperation with the Bank. Accordingly, the Bank's management expects its new
core banking system to be Year 2000 compliant.
    

                                       45

<PAGE>

   
         The Bank is also in the process of installing new financial accounting
and mortgage loan origination systems which are Year 2000 compliant. The new
financial accounting system is being installed independent of the Year 2000
issue since the vendor for the former system notified the Bank of its intention
to cease supporting the software beyond 1998. The new mortgage loan origination
system will also be installed independent of the Year 2000 issue to replace the
Bank's existing mortgage loan origination system with a lower cost software
solution. This implementation is consistent with the closure of the Bank's
mortgage banking division, its emphasis on portfolio lending within its niche
market, and its commercial banking focus.

         In each case described above, the system conversions were being made
for business reasons that were unrelated to the Year 2000 issue. Since the
Bank's conversions to the new systems were made independent of the Year 2000
issue, management has determined that the direct cost of the Year 2000
compliance will not have a material financial impact on the Bank.

         The Bank has adopted a new data processing system which is expected to
be Year 2000 compliant and the financial accounting and mortgage loan
origination systems presently being installed are Year 2000 compliant.
Additionally, the Bank's mortgage loan servicing system is run in a service
bureau environment by a large national vendor of data processing services. The
Bank has renewed its contract with the vendor. The renewed contract obligates
the vendor to have its system Year 2000 compliant by the end of 1998.
Accordingly, the Bank does not anticipate any failures of mission-critical
systems in conjunction with the onset of year 2000. However, in the event that
one or more of the systems fails to be Year 2000 compliant, the Bank has
developed a contingency plan which would involve the alternative processing of
information for segments of systems failures, if any, until the sub-system can
be modified to be Year 2000 compliant.

         The Company does not anticipate that any of the systems will fail to
meet Year 2000 compliance or that the cost of addressing the Year 2000 issues
will be material. However, no assurance can be made that the third party
vendor's efforts with respect to Year 2000 compliance will be successful or that
the Company's costs associated therewith will be as estimated.


                                    BUSINESS

Market Area

         The Bank concentrates on marketing its services in the San Francisco
Bay area (which includes Oakland), and the Sacramento/Stockton and Los Angeles
metropolitan areas with a particular focus on areas with a high concentration of
ethnic Chinese. The ethnic Chinese markets within the Bank's primary market area
have experienced rapid growth in recent periods. According to 1990 Census data,
management believes there were an estimated 2.7 million Asian and Pacific
Islanders residing in California, and approximately 70% of this population were
in the middle and upper income brackets. Based on 1995 and 1996 demographic
data, management believes there were 200,000 Asian and Pacific Islanders living
in San Francisco county, which represented approximately 30% of the total
population. In addition, the Bank recently opened a commercial banking office in
Pasadena, California to take advantage of the opportunities in the Los Angeles
metropolitan area, particularly in the ethnic Chinese market. Management has
tailored its products and services to meet the financial needs of these growing
Asian and ethnic Chinese communities within its market area. Management believes
that this approach, combined with the extensive ties of its management and Board
of Directors to the growing Asian and ethnic Chinese communities, provides the
Bank an advantage in competing for customers in its market area. After giving
effect to the recent consolidation activity in California, management believes
the Bank is the tenth largest thrift institution in California and the third
largest financial institution focused on serving the ethnic Chinese market
within California.

    

Historical Operations

         The Bank historically engaged in the origination of residential
mortgages (1-4 family) which were pooled and sold in the secondary market, with
loan servicing rights retained, and the servicing of loans for the Federal Home
Loan Mortgage Corporation ("FHLMC"), the Federal National Mortgage Association
("FNMA"), the Government National Mortgage Association ("GNMA") and private
investors. From time to time, the Bank sold its loan servicing rights and also
purchased agency servicing rights as part of its mortgage banking division
operations. The Bank also originated residential mortgages (1-4 family),
multi-family mortgages and commercial real estate mortgages for portfolio
retention. In addition, since 1993, the Bank has specialized in limited
documentation residential mortgage (1-4 family) lending. Furthermore, because
the Bank does not retain a large volume of fixed-rate mortgages in its permanent
portfolio for


                                       46

<PAGE>



interest rate risk considerations, and since the production of ARMs has been
insufficient to provide adequate balance sheet growth, the Bank has historically
relied heavily on loan and securities purchases to complement its asset base. In
1993, mortgage-backed securities represented approximately one-third of the
Bank's assets.

         Historically, the Bank maintained a heavy concentration of ARM assets
whose interest rates were based on COFI. Since adjustments in COFI generally lag
behind market interest rate changes, COFI-based assets can reduce net interest
margins during periods of rapidly increasing deposit and borrowing interest
rates. The Bank experienced such effect in 1994-1995 when its net interest
margin decreased as the COFI adjusted upward more slowly than the cost of the
Bank's deposits and borrowings. During the period from 1990 to 1994, the value
of California real estate collateral declined and the Bank experienced
significant loan losses on a portion of its real estate loans. In 1995, the
Bank's allowance for loan losses was increased from 0.78% of total loans to over
1.00% of total loans. This action was due to a combination of a depressed
California economy and real estate market and to significantly increase the
Company's overall level of allowance for loan losses to over 1.00% of gross
loans. The resulting $8.8 million charge to income, coupled with the diminished
interest income resulting from the 1995 COFI-lag effect resulted in a net loss
of $2.9 million in 1995. During 1996, the Company's net interest income improved
by 35.3% to $39.0 million primarily as a result of the Bank's COFI-based assets
becoming fully indexed and the correction of the COFI-lag impact.

         In recent years, the mortgage banking industry has been highly
competitive and, combined with the availability of more efficient delivery
systems through brokers and the Internet, the industry has experienced shrinking
profit margins and reduced loan servicing values. Higher levels of prepayment
activity resulting from a lower interest rate environment and the willingness of
lenders to offer mortgage loans with no points and, in many cases, no fees, have
reduced servicing values. To respond to these market factors and to improve the
long-term prospects of the Bank, the Bank took the following measures:

Responsive Measures

   
         COFI Asset Reduction. In the fourth quarter of 1996, to improve its net
interest margin, the Bank ceased all COFI-based mortgage lending and began to
reduce the Bank's COFI-based mortgage-backed securities portfolio. From December
31, 1996 to June 30, 1998, COFI-based loans have been reduced from 60.2% of the
Bank's total gross loan portfolio to 39.8%. From December 31, 1996 to June 30,
1998, total COFI exposure has been reduced from 64.9% of the Bank's
interest-earning assets to 40.2%.
    

         Closure of Mortgage Banking Division. In 1997, the Bank closed its
mortgage banking division and ceased the origination of non-conventional
mortgages for sale in the secondary market and sold its agency loan servicing
portfolio. While the Bank no longer engages in this activity, the Bank continues
to originate conventional residential mortgage loans for portfolio retention and
conforming mortgages for resale in the secondary market through its retail
branch network. See "Business--Lending Activities--Residential Mortgages (1-4
family)."

   
         Reduced Non-Performing and Non-Interest Earning Assets. The Bank
reduced its non-performing assets from $22.3 million as of December 31, 1995, to
$9.3 million as of June 30, 1998.

         Reduced Mismatched Borrowings. The Bank reduced its predominantly high
cost LIBOR-based borrowings (which were mismatched with COFI-based assets) from
$265.3 million at the beginning of 1995 to zero at December 31, 1996 and 1997 .
At June 30, 1998, the Bank had $298 million of borrowings which were entered
into in conjunction with the leveraging strategy to fund the purchase of
fixed-rate assets with scheduled maturities ranging from fifteen to thirty
years. Of the $298 million in borrowings, $202 million had scheduled maturities
in ten years, of which $185 million contained provisions that the FHLB could, at
their option, terminate the advances at quarterly intervals at specified periods
ranging from three to five years beyond the advance dates, and $17 million of
fixed-rate advances. The remaining $96 million of advances were short-term. Also
included in the leveraging strategy was the purchase of $200 million of
LIBOR-based interest rate caps to protect the Bank from a reduction in net
interest income in the event of an increase in market interest rates.
    


                                       47

<PAGE>



Implementation of Strategy

         In conjunction with the implementation of the balance sheet
restructuring described above which returned the Bank to profitability in 1996,
excluding the one-time SAIF recapitalization assessment, to further improve the
Bank's long-term prospects and to take advantage of the Bank's significant
deposit market share and the potential cross-selling opportunities to the ethnic
Chinese and Asian communities within its market area. The Board of Directors
adopted a business strategy to shift the primary business focus of the Bank from
a traditional thrift to a full service commercial bank. To implement its
business strategy, the Bank took the actions and adopted the initiatives
described below.

         Management. The Bank realigned management responsibilities and hired
commercial banking officers and SBA business banking officers with lending
experience in the Bank's market area. The management changes included the
following:

             o President. In January 1998, Tommy S. Wu became the Bank's
               President and Chief Executive Officer and was charged with the
               responsibility of implementing the shift of the Bank's focus to
               commercial banking services and products. Prior to that
               appointment Mr. Wu was the Executive Vice President and Director
               of the Bank as of September 25, 1997. Mr. Wu was Senior Vice
               President and Director of Retail Banking from 1992 to 1996 and
               also served the Bank as Vice President, Regional Manager, of its
               Southern California Retail Banking Division from 1991 to 1992.

             o Head of Commercial Banking Division. In January 1996, Sylvia Loh
               was appointed Head of the Bank's commercial banking division
               which was formally formed in 1996. Ms. Loh has over twenty years
               of commercial banking and trade finance experience with major
               financial institutions, including administrative and managerial
               experience in overseeing over 26 branches. She also has
               experience working with the United States EXIM Bank and has had
               extensive exposure in the ethnic Chinese markets as well as the
               Pacific Rim region. She also is a past President of the
               Association of Asian American Bankers from 1996 to 1997.

             o Chief Credit Officer. In January 1997, William T. Goldrick was
               appointed Senior Vice President and Chief Credit Officer to
               provide technical expertise to formulate the Bank's commercial
               lending policies and procedures. He has over 41 years of
               commercial bank credit experience and is responsible for the
               Bank's regulatory compliance.
   
         Established Commercial Banking Division. In 1996, to take advantage of
the opportunities in the Bank's targeted markets, the Bank established its
commercial banking division to offer an array of commercial bank services and
products to its customers particularly focused on the ethnic Chinese
communities. Since its establishment, the commercial banking division has
originated approximately $110.1 million in commercial loan commitments and had
$98.7 million in outstanding loans as of June 30, 1998. As of June 30, 1998,
the division had a current committed pipeline of approximately $129 million. To
support its commercial banking activities, the Bank acquired a commercial
banking data processing system to replace a system designed for thrift
institutions. The new system provides customer profitability reports, account
analysis and other commercial banking management tracking and reporting
mechanisms. The installation of this new system was completed in February 1998.
The Bank installed software to enhance commercial real estate loan marketing and
development. The PC based system provides key information on substantially all
commercial real estate transactions in the Bank's market area in California. The
software provides information instrumental to identifying lending and
refinancing opportunities, screening potential credit opportunities and
evaluating collateral values to facilitate efficient solicitation of borrowers
and related depository relationships from commercial and multi-family property
owners. The Bank opened a commercial, construction and SBA lending office in
Pasadena, California during the second quarter of 1998. In addition to other
personnel, the Bank has hired a team of three experienced SBA business banking
officers to staff the Pasadena office. These officers were previously affiliated
with one of the leading lenders focusing on SBA lending to Asians.
    


                                       48

<PAGE>


   
         Core Deposit Solicitation. To further develop the Bank's core deposit
base, the Bank is evaluating the establishment of mini-branches in or adjacent
to Asian supermarkets in selected target market areas. By continuing to
emphasize multilingual services at its ATMs, through its telephone banking
system and by its customer service and loan officers, the Bank expects to
continue to further its presence in the Asian, and specifically the ethnic
Chinese, markets in California. At June 30, 1998, less than 2% of the Bank's
deposits were held by customers located outside of the United States. In
addition, as of such date, the 100 depositors with the largest aggregate average
deposit balances comprised less than 10% of the Bank's total deposits. The Bank
also expects to increase its business accounts as its commercial lending
portfolio grows and correspondent accounts are established.

         Capital Enhancement. At December 31, 1997 the Company's stockholders'
equity was $62.6 million or 4.0% of total assets. In April 1998, the Company
completed the Private Offerings. Following the Private Offering, the Company's
stockholders' equity increased to $98.1 million at June 30, 1998 and the
Company's consolidated Tier I capital increased from $63.9 million at December
31, 1997 to $128.2 million at June 30, 1998. See "Supervision and
Regulation--Bank Holding Company and Bank Regulation--The Bank--Capital
Requirements."

         Leverage Strategy. As a result of the proceeds raised by the Private
Offerings, the Bank designed and implemented a plan to leverage such proceeds
through the purchase of U.S. Government agency mortgage-backed securities,
investment grade securities, investment grade municipal bonds and investment
grade residential mortgage (1-4 family) securities. The plan specifies that such
purchases will be funded primarily through intermediate and long-term secured
borrowings, advances from the FHLB and from cash made available from the
proceeds. The plan, which is consistent with the Bank's asset and liability
management policy, further specifies that certain interest rate caps are to be
purchased to reduce the Bank's exposure to increasing market interest rates.
Total assets to be purchased pursuant to the plan are approximately $337
million. As of June 30, 1998 the Bank had purchased $318 million of such assets
which were funded with $96 million of short-term borrowings and $202 million of
long-term borrowings. As of June 30, 1998, the Bank had purchased $200 million
of LIBOR-based interest rate caps to hedge the assets.

         As of June 30, 1998, the Bank purchased approximately $325 million of
such assets and entered into $202 million of long-term borrowings. Additionally,
the Bank had entered into certain interest rate cap agreements in the aggregate
principal amount of $200 million. The average spread on such assets is in the
range of 110 basis points to 120 basis points, including the amortization of the
interest rate caps.

         Charter Conversion. In the first quarter of 1998, the Bank changed its
name to United Commercial Bank to reflect the Bank's new emphasis on providing
commercial banking services to its customers. The Bank converted to a
California-chartered commercial bank and the Company became a bank holding
company on July 31, 1998. Following the conversions, the Bank's primary
regulator is the California Department of Financial Institutions and the
Company's primary regulator is the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco.
    

         As a result of the measures taken to effect the Bank's shift in its
primary business focus from mortgage banking to commercial banking, and the
implementation of its strategic initiatives, management believes that the Bank
is and will continue to be well positioned to take advantage of the
opportunities in its market area and particularly in the growing ethnic Chinese
market in California.


                                       49

<PAGE>


Current Banking Services

         Through its network of retail branches, the Bank provides a wide range
of personal and commercial banking services to small-and medium-sized
businesses, business executives, professionals and other individuals. The Bank
offers multilingual services to all of its customers in English, Cantonese and
Mandarin. The Bank offers a variety of deposit products which includes the
traditional range of personal and business checking and savings accounts, time
deposits and individual retirement accounts, as well as a wide range of
specialized services, including international trade services for business
clients, travelers' checks, safe deposit boxes and Master Card and Visa merchant
deposit services.

         The Bank engages in a full complement of lending activities, including
residential and commercial real estate, construction, commercial, trade finance,
account receivables, inventory, working capital and SBA loans. In addition to
the origination of residential mortgages, the Bank provides loans to small and
medium-sized developers for the construction of resale housing and interim real
estate loans primarily for construction of single-family residences. The Bank
provides commercial loans for working capital and expansion and account
receivables and inventory financing to small and medium size businesses with
annual revenues that generally range from $500,000 to $20.0 million. The Bank
provides short-term trade finance facilities for terms of less than one year to
U.S. importers, exporters and manufacturers. The Bank also generates loans which
are guaranteed by the SBA, which loans are generally working capital loans
secured by inventories and receivables, and commercial real estate loans secured
by real property. The Bank's commercial borrowers are engaged in a wide variety
of manufacturing, wholesale trade and service businesses.

Lending Activities

         Underwriting and Credit Administration. The Bank's lending activities
are guided by the basic lending policies established by the Board of Directors.
The Bank's lending policy requires that loans must meet minimum underwriting
criteria. Lending authority is granted to officers of the Bank on a limited
basis. Loan requests exceeding individual officer approval limits are approved
by the President. All commercial loans are generally ratified by the Credit
Review Committee. Loans in excess of $2.0 million are generally ratified by the
Board of Directors.

   
         The Bank's credit administration function includes an internal asset
credit quality review. In addition, all commercial loans over $100,000 are
reviewed by an outside credit review agency comprised of former bank regulators
with an emphasis in credit review. The President, Chief Credit Officer and Chief
Financial Officer meet biweekly to review delinquencies, non-performing assets,
classified assets and other pertinent information to evaluate credit risk within
the Bank's loan portfolio. The information reviewed by this group is submitted
to the Board of Directors bimonthly.

         Loan Portfolio. At June 30, 1998, approximately $712.4 million, or
56.0% of the Bank's gross loan portfolio was in residential mortgages (1-4
family), $334.2 million or 26.3% of gross loans was in multi-family mortgages,
$142.7 million or 11.2% of gross loans was in commercial real estate loans,
$35.8 million or 2.8% of gross loans was in construction loans,$15.9 million or
1.2% of gross loans was in home equity loans and $28.0 million or 2.2% of gross
loans was in commercial business loans.

         Residential Mortgages (1-4 family). The Bank offers fixed-rate and
adjustable rate mortgage loans which include intermediate fixed-rate loans
secured by residential mortgages. Substantially all such loans are secured by
properties located in the Bank's primary market area. Residential mortgage loan
originations are obtained through the Bank's two delivery networks: the retail
branches and the wholesale lending department. In 1997 and the first half of
1998, approximately 41% of all residential mortgage loans were originated by the
Bank's retail branches. The retail branches originate loans by salaried
personnel through customer contact, referral and solicitation. The wholesale
lending department originates loans with commissioned loan officers through loan
brokers. The Bank originates both fully documented loans for which income and
assets are verified with third parties, as well as loans for which the
borrower's stated income and assets are relied upon without independent
verification. The Bank specializes in a limited documentation mortgage loan
product which serves a particular niche of borrowers willing to pay a premium,
in the form of higher interest rates, and provide larger down payments in
exchange for more expedient loan processing by virtue of providing less
documentation.
    


                                       50


<PAGE>

   
         The Company underwrites one- to four-family residential mortgage loans
to the specific criteria of the program under which the loan is originated. The
residential originations are primarily for portfolio retention and are
underwritten to the Bank's program guidelines. Such guidelines differ from FNMA
and/or FHLMC guidelines with respect to factors such as, but not limited to,
loan amounts and specific loan documentation. Accordingly, such loans are not
saleable to these agencies. The Company has sold portfolio loans in the
secondary market from time to time to assess the saleability of its portfolio
loans. Based upon such sales, management believes that its one- to four-family
residential portfolio loans could be readily sold in the secondary market if
management elected to do so. The Company continues to underwrite loans to FNMA
and FHLMC guidelines which are sold from time to time in the secondary market
for inclusion in FNMA and/or FHLMC pools.
    

         The Bank's underwriting guidelines for loan origination require: (i)
for fully documented loans, up to 80% loan to value ("LTV") for loan amounts up
to $700,000 and up to 70% LTVfor loan amounts up to $800,000; (ii) for limited
documentation loans with no income verification, up to 80% LTV for loan amounts
up to $600,000 and up to 65% LTV for loan amounts up to $800,000; (iii) for low
documentation loans with no income or asset verification, up to 80% LTV for loan
amounts up to $450,000 and up to 60% LTV for loan amounts up to $800,000. A
borrower's employment and financial information are verified through third
parties and examination of paycheck stubs, bank statements and tax returns. The
Bank obtains appraisals from licensed appraisers approved by the credit review
committee.

   
         At June 30, 1998, the Bank had approximately 4,290 loans secured by
residential mortgages (1-4 family), which totaled $712.3 million in the
aggregate; as of such date, the Bank's average loan balance with respect to
residential mortgages (1-4 family) amounted to approximately $166,100. Of the
Bank's residential mortgages (1-4 family) at June 30, 1998: $221.4 million, or
31.1% consisted of fixed-rate loans; $214.1 million, or 30.1% consisted of ARMs
with an adjustment date in one year or less; and $276.9 million, or 38.8%
consisted of intermediate fixed-rate loans. The Bank's fixed-rate mortgage loans
are made for terms of 15 years or 30 years. The 30 year, fixed-rate loans are
generally sold in the secondary market on a servicing released basis. Fixed-rate
mortgage loans are originated with due on sale clauses which provide the Bank
with the contractual right to deem the loan immediately due and payable in the
event the borrower transfers ownership of the property without the Bank's
consent. The Bank currently originates 30 year, fixed-rate loans for portfolio
retention only on a customer accommodation basis. The Bank currently offers a
variety of ARM loan programs with interest rates fixed for six months and which
adjust semi-annually thereafter. Intermediate fixed-rate loans have interest
rates fixed for three or five years and adjust annually thereafter. The Bank's
ARM loans generally provide for periodic (not more than 2%) and lifetime (not
more than 6%) caps on the increase or decrease in interest rates over the life
of the loan. The interest rate adjustment on ARM loans currently made by the
Bank is indexed to the one-year U.S. Treasury CMT Index.

         Beginning in 1993, the Bank has specialized in the origination of
limited documentation residential mortgages (1-4 family). As of June 30, 1998,
$502.8 million, or 70.1% of the Bank's residential mortgages (1-4 family) were
comprised of limited documentation loans. Because of the less than full
documentation required for such loans, the Bank has emphasized relatively small
average loan size and low average loan-to-value ratios for these loans, as
evidenced by an average loan balance of $165,600 and average loan-to-value
ratios of 59% as of June 30, 1998. Approximately 34% of such loans in the first
half of 1998 were originated through the Bank's retail branches.

         Since it began originating limited documentation loans in 1993 the Bank
has experienced no net charge-offs with respect to such loans. At June 30, 1998,
the Bank had two loans more than three payments delinquent with an aggregate
principal balance of $199,000. Moreover, during the third quarter of 1997, the
Bank sold $17.2 million of the limited documentation loans to test the market
reception for this product. The Bank received a price in excess of par value on
the sale of such loans. Notwithstanding the historical performance of this type
of loan, there can be no assurance that such performance will continue.

    

                                       51

<PAGE>


   
         The Bank previously offered a variety of adjustable-rate programs,
which provided for interest rates which adjusted periodically based on COFI. In
the fourth quarter of 1996, the Bank ceased all COFI-based mortgage lending.
Nevertheless, at June 30, 1998, $146.0 million or 20.5% of the Bank's
residential mortgage (1-4 family) loan portfolio consisted of COFI-based loans.
    

         Commercial Lending-Generally. The Bank has recently established a
commercial banking division and has hired experienced commercial lending
officers. The Bank also has installed software to identify, market and develop
potential commercial real estate lending opportunities in its market area. The
Bank also offers an array of commercial loan products catering primarily to the
needs of its Chinese ethnic community. Set forth below is a description of the
types of commercial loans offered by the Bank.

         Multi-family Mortgages. The Bank originates multi-family mortgages
which are generally secured by five to 36 unit residential buildings. Loans
secured by residential buildings in excess of 36 units are underwritten pursuant
to the Bank's underwriting standards with respect to commercial real estate
loans. Substantially all of the Bank's multi-family loan originations are
secured by properties located in the Bank's primary market area. The Bank
underwrites multi-family mortgages by obtaining full credit information on the
borrower and through independent verification of the borrower's income and
assets. The borrower's ability to effectively manage the multi-family property
and ability to assume the financial responsibility of the debt service
obligation in the event of unforeseen expenses or increased vacancy are also
taken into consideration in the underwriting process. In making its assessment
of the creditworthiness of the borrower, the Bank generally reviews the
financial statements, employment and credit history of the borrower, as well as
other related documentation. The Bank's current program criteria for
multi-family originations generally provide for debt service coverages of 1.15x
or greater and LTV's of 75% or less. The Bank currently offers fixed-rate and
ARM multi-family mortgages. The Bank's ARM multi-family loans are fixed for six
months and thereafter adjust semi-annually based upon the LIBOR index.
Multi-family loans are generally amortized over 30 years with balloon payments
in 10 or 15 years.

   
         As of June 30, 1998, the Bank had approximately 819 multi-family
mortgages with an aggregate outstanding principal balance of $334.2 million. As
of such date, the Bank's average loan balance with respect to multi-family
mortgages amounted to approximately $408,100. As of June 30, 1998, $287.9
million, or 86.1% of these loans consisted of adjustable-rate loans with
COFI-based interest rates. In order to avoid an over concentration in
multi-family mortgages, the Bank limits its total multi-family mortgage exposure
to not more than 35% of total loans. As of June 30, 1998, the Bank had a 26.3%
concentration in multi-family mortgages. As a result of the Bank's limitations,
market competition and alternative investment opportunities, the Bank has not
originated a significant volume of multi-family mortgages during the past three
years ended December 31, 1998. During the first six months of 1998, the Bank
began to refocus on the origination of multifamily mortgage loans and originated
$15.6 million during this period.

         Commercial Real Estate Construction. The Bank originates construction
loans for the development of single-family residences, multi-family and
commercial properties. Such loans are made primarily to experienced builders and
developers known to the Bank in its primary market area. As of June 30, 1998,
the Bank had approximately 86 outstanding construction loans with an aggregate
outstanding principal balance of $35.8 million. As of such date, the Bank's
average loan balance with respect to construction loans amounted to $416,400.
    

         Construction loans are originated in amounts up to 80% of the lesser of
the appraised value of the property, as improved, or the sales price. Proceeds
for construction loans are disbursed on a percentage of completion basis or as
construction thresholds are met. Generally, if the borrower is a corporation or
partnership, guarantees by the principals are required. Construction loans are
adjustable and tied to the prime rate. Generally, the term of construction loans
is for one year, with a one year renewal option, if necessary.


                                       52

<PAGE>


         Construction financing generally involves a higher degree of credit
risk than long-term financing on improved, owner-occupied real estate. The risk
of loss on a construction loan is dependent largely upon the property's value at
completion of the construction compared to the estimated cost, including
interest, of construction. If the estimate of value proves to be inaccurate, the
Bank may be confronted with a completed project, having a value which is
insufficient to assure full repayment.

         Commercial Real Estate Non-Residential Mortgages. The Bank originates
medium-term commercial real estate loans secured by commercial or industrial
buildings where the properties are either used by the owner for business
purposes ("owner-user properties") or have income derived from tenants
("investment properties"). The Bank solicits potential borrowers through: (i)
its new database software system, which provides key information on
substantially all commercial real estate loans in its primary market in
California, (ii) referrals from its branches, (iii) direct solicitation of
borrowers and real estate brokers by the commercial banking lending officers,
and (iv) referrals from existing borrowing customers. Upon identification of a
prospective borrower, the Bank then makes a preliminary estimate of the value of
the property based upon the location, age, type of property and market rent. For
owner-user properties, the Bank may use market rent information from such
borrowers for its cash flow analysis. A proposal letter summarizing the
tentative terms of the prospective loan is then submitted to the borrower for
acceptance, at which time the non-refundable fee is paid to the Bank. This
pre-screening process helps the Bank control appraisal costs by reducing the
number of appraisals ordered for loans that ultimately are not approved. Upon
acceptance of the proposal, the Bank then performs property appraisal and
environmental surveys. The Bank's underwriting practices generally require the
principal balance of the loan to be no more than 65% of the stabilized appraised
value of the underlying real estate collateral. Commercial real estate loans are
typically secured by first deeds of trust, generally have terms of no more than
seven to ten years and are amortized up to 25 years. Although substantially all
of the commercial real estate loans currently being originated have interest
rates that adjust with changes in the prime rate or have fixed-rate terms of up
to five years, the Bank previously offered commercial real estate loans with
interest rates which adjusted periodically based on COFI.

   
         At June 30, 1998, the Bank had approximately 147 commercial real estate
loans with an aggregate principal balance of $142.7 million. As of such date,
the average balance with respect to the Bank's commercial real estate loans
amounted to $971,000. As of June 30, 1998, of the Bank's $142.7 million of
commercial real estate loans, $72.1 million, or 50.5% consisted of COFI-based
loans. The Bank's underwriting practice also generally requires that the
properties securing commercial real estate loans have debt service coverage
ratios (the ratio of earnings before debt service to debt service) of at least
1.35. The Bank's loan documentation usually provides the Bank the right to call
the loan in the event that the debt service coverage ratio falls below 1.35x.
The Bank generally requires that all commercial real estate loans made to
corporations, partnerships and other business entities be personally guaranteed
by the principals. The Bank utilizes tax returns to review and verify the income
stream of the borrower. Loan documentation is reviewed by the Bank's in-house
legal department. Such documentation typically requires annual financial
statements and rent rolls of a borrower, to determine covenant compliance.

         During the six months ended June 30, 1998, the Bank originated $35.3
million of commercial real estate loans. During the years ended December 31,
1997, 1996 and 1995, the Bank originated $23.7 million, $2.7 million and
$864,000 of commercial real estate loans, respectively. Management believes it
will originate $125.0 million of commercial real estate loans during 1998.
Through June 30, 1998, the Bank had in its pipeline $98.4 million of
commercial real estate loans. Notwithstanding the foregoing, no assurance can be
made that the Bank will achieve its year-end projections or that all of the
commercial real estate loans in the Bank's pipeline as of June 30, 1998, will
close.

         Loans secured by commercial real estate properties are generally larger
and involve a greater degree of risk than residential mortgages (1-4 family).
Because payments on loans secured by commercial real estate properties are
generally dependent on successful operation or management of the properties,
repayment of such loans is subject to a greater extent than the repayment of
residential mortgages on the then prevailing conditions in the real estate
market or the economy. The Bank seeks to minimize these risks through its
underwriting standards and in the first half of 1998, the Bank employed an
outside loan review firm to assist management with respect to internal asset
review of the Bank's commercial loans, including its commercial real estate
loans.
    


                                       53

<PAGE>


         Commercial Business Loans. The Bank provides commercial business loans
to customers for working capital purposes and to finance equipment, account
receivables and inventory. Working capital loans are generally subject to annual
review, and equipment loans have terms up to five years. Interest rates on these
loans are generally based on the prime rate. Working capital loan advances are
generally made against security interests in inventory and account receivables,
and equipment loans are secured by the underlying equipment. When appropriate,
the Bank may require additional collateral on such loans and may further secure
the indebtedness with a lien on real estate. In many cases, personal guarantees
are obtained as additional security.

   
         During the six months ended June 30, 1998, the Bank originated $25.8
million of commercial loans. During the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and
1995, the Bank originated $31.9 million, $9.9 million and $0 of commercial
business loans, respectively. Management believes it will originate $55.0
million of commercial business loans during 1998 (not including SBA loans).
Through June 30, 1998, the Bank had in its pipeline $21.1 million of commercial
business loans (not including SBA loans). Notwithstanding the foregoing, no
assurance can be made that the Bank will achieve its year-end projections or
that all of the commercial business loans in the Bank's pipeline as of June 30,
1998, will close.
    

         Unlike consumer residential mortgage loans, which generally are made on
the basis of the borrower's ability to make repayment from his or her employment
or other income and which are secured by real property whose value tends to be
more easily ascertainable, commercial business loans are of higher risk and
typically are made on the basis of the borrower's ability to make repayment from
the cash flow of the borrower's business. As a result, the availability of funds
for the repayment of commercial loans may be substantially dependent on the
success of the business itself. Further, any collateral securing such loans may
depreciate over time, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in value
based on the success of the business. The Bank currently utilizes the
unaffiliated firm referenced above to assist management with respect to internal
asset review of the Bank's commercial business loans.

         The Bank provides commercial lines of credit to small- and medium-sized
companies to finance their accounts receivable and inventory on a short term
basis (less than one year) and/or to finance their equipment and working capital
on a long term basis (over one year).

         Short term financing is structured to enable the borrower to complete
its trade cycle from purchase of inventory to collection of receivables. As
such, the credit line may also include an option for the issuance of letters of
credit to overseas suppliers/sellers in order for the borrower to obtain
inventory. Pursuant to such letters of credit, the Bank extends credit to the
borrower by providing assurance, to the borrower's foreign suppliers, that
payments will be made upon shipment of goods. Upon shipment of goods and when
the letters of credit are negotiated by the foreign suppliers, the borrower's
inventory is financed by the Bank under the pre-approved line of credit
facility.

         The underwriting criteria of such short term trade financings often
depends on the quality of the borrowers' inventory and their accounts
receivables. As a general rule, inventory should not be held for more than 60
days, and accounts receivables should not extend beyond 90 days. Total credit
exposure (outstanding loans plus letters of credit) under the line of credit are
monitored monthly by using a borrowing base formula of up to 80% against
eligible receivables aged up to 90 days, and up to 50% against eligible
inventory with or without limits. Aside from the established base formula, the
borrower's overall financial condition is considered, such as consistency in
revenue streams, gross margins, expense ratios, and net income. Another
important underwriting criteria is the adequacy of the borrower's capital in
relation to the financial growth it seeks to achieve. A company with a leverage
ratio below 2.5:1 is acceptable to the Bank.

         Fixed assets, such as machinery and equipment, provide long term
financial benefits to the borrowers. Accordingly, loans for these types of
financings are structured for a term longer than one year. Repayment of the
loans are structured to match the income generated over the life expectancy of
the assets. As such, the underwriting criteria is dependent upon the amount of
cash flow (income plus depreciation) the borrower has available to service debt
based on a full amortization schedule, usually between five to seven years. The
maximum amount financed on capital assets is approximately 70% of its value.
Similar to trade finance credits, financial evaluation of revenue, 
profitability, expense ratios and capital adequacy are made in considering this
type of credit for approval.


                                       54

<PAGE>


         The Bank originates and funds loans qualifying for guarantees issued by
the SBA. The SBA currently guarantees from 75% to 80% of the principal and
accrued interest of such loans. Loans are provided to eligible applicants or
small businesses to finance working capital, the purchase of equipment or real
estate. Depending upon the use of loan proceeds, the loan term may range from
seven to twenty-five years. The Bank typically requires that SBA loans be
secured by inventories and receivables or if commercial real estate is being
financed, secured by real property. Primary underwriting criteria are historical
cash flow to demonstrate repayment capability, experienced business management
and adequate collateral to secure the requested credit. Typically, the SBA
prefers that the applicant inject at least 30%- 33% cash (equity) into the
transaction. The Bank's benefits in originating loans under this program include
limited credit exposure for the Bank as a result of the SBA guaranty, increased
Bank revenues by selling the guaranteed portion of the loan through the
secondary market at a premium, and gaining "Preferred Lender Program" status
with the SBA by producing volume and quality credits while serving the financial
needs of small business communities.

   
         During the six months ended June 30, 1998, the Bank originated $2.5
million of SBA loans. Management believes it will originate approximately $20.0
million of SBA loans during 1998. Through June 30, 1998, the Bank had in its
pipeline $9.4 million of SBA loans. Notwithstanding the foregoing, no assurance
can be made that the Bank will achieve its year-end projections or that all of
the SBA loans in the Bank's pipeline as of June 30, 1998 will close.
    

         Consumer Loans. The Bank's consumer loan portfolio is substantially
comprised of home equity lines of credit which are secured by residential real
estate. These lines of credit generally consist of floating rate loans, tied to
the prime rate.

Deposits

   
         The Bank's deposits are obtained primarily from ethnic Chinese
households, small and medium-sized businesses owned by ethnic Chinese, and
ethnic Chinese business executives, professionals and other individuals. The
Bank offers the traditional range of depository products provided by commercial
banks. Rates paid on deposits vary depending on the deposit size, the term of
deposit, and the type of deposit. The Bank sets its deposit rates based on
deposit needs and market competition. As of June 30, 1998, less than 2% of the
Bank's deposits were held by customers located outside the United States. In
addition, as of such date, the 100 depositors with the largest aggregate average
deposit balances comprised less than 10% of the Bank's total deposits. As of
June 30, 1998, the Bank's weighted average cost of deposits was 4.28%, which was
60 basis points less than the COFI. The Bank does not solicit brokered deposits.
    

Competition

         The banking and financial services business in California generally,
and in the Bank's market area specifically, is highly competitive. The
increasingly competitive environment results from changes in regulation, changes
in technology and product delivery systems, and the consolidation among
financial services providers. The Bank competes for loans, deposits and
customers for financial services with other commercial banks, savings and loan
associations, securities and brokerage companies, mortgage companies, insurance
companies, finance companies, money market funds, credit unions, and other
nonbank financial service providers. Many of these competitors are much larger
in total assets and capitalization, have greater access to capital markets and
offer a broader array of financial services than the Bank. To compete with the
other financial services providers, the Bank relies on local promotional
activities, personal relationships established by officers, directors and
employees with its customers, and specialized services tailored to meet its
customers' needs.

         The Bank competes for deposits from the ethnic Chinese markets with
other banks serving the Asian community in California. The Bank believes that it
has two major competitors that are targeting the ethnic Chinese market. Such
institutions have branch locations in many of the same neighborhoods as the
Bank, provide similar loan, savings and financial services, and market their
services in similar Asian publications and media in California.

Employees

   
         At June 30, 1998, the Bank had 338 full-time equivalent employees. None
of the employees are covered by a collective bargaining agreement. The Bank
considers its employee relations to be satisfactory.
    



                                       55


<PAGE>


Properties

         The Bank owns the facility that is located at 711 Van Ness Avenue, San
Francisco, California and that serves as the Company's and the Bank's
headquarters. The Bank leases all of its remaining branch facilities under
noncancelable operating leases, many of which contain renewal options and some
of which have escalation clauses. The Bank's branch offices are set forth below:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                                                                Total Deposits
Office Location                                           Lease Expiration Date                at June 30, 1998
- ---------------                                           ---------------------                ----------------
                                                                                            (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                       <C>                                     <C>      
Alhambra:
1211 East Valley Blvd.
Alhambra, CA 91801......................................  October 2001                            $  44,097

Artesia:
11809 Artesia Blvd.
Artesia, CA 90701.......................................  May 2003                                   51,414

Balboa:
3555 Balboa Street
San Francisco, CA 94121.................................  March 1999                                 37,234

Citrus Heights:
7803 Madison Ave #650
Citrus Heights, CA 95610................................  February 1999                                  (1)

Clement:
498 Clement Street
San Francisco, CA 94118.................................  March 2004                                123,666

Cupertino:
20510 Stevens Creek Blvd.
Cupertino, CA 95014.....................................  March 2001                                 30,137

Daly City:
246 Skyline Plaza
Daly City, CA 94015.....................................  November 2002                               2,760

Freeport:
4790 Freeport Blvd.
Sacramento, CA 95822....................................  April 2009                                 56,883

Fremont:
34420 Fremont Blvd., Suite F
Fremont, CA 94555.......................................  January 1999                               32,179

Fresno:
1320 East Shaw Avenue, Suite 160
Fresno, CA  93710.......................................  December 1998                                  (2)
    
</TABLE>

- ----------
(1) Facility is a spot construction lending center that does not take deposits.
(2) Facility is a construction lending center that does not take deposits.


                                       56

<PAGE>



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                                                                Total Deposits
Office Location                                           Lease Expiration Date                at June 30, 1998
- ---------------                                           ---------------------                ----------------
                                                                                            (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>          <C>                                          <C>                                     <C>      
Geary:
6001 Geary Blvd.
San Francisco, CA 94121.................................  September 1999                          $  21,743

Irvine:
15333 Culver Dr., #670
Irvine, CA 92604........................................  May 2001                                   18,437

Irving:
2219 Irving Street
San Francisco, CA 94122.................................  October 1999                               23,621

Kearny:
900 Kearny Street
San Francisco, CA 94133.................................  November 2011                              46,298

Los Angeles Chinatown:
951 No. Broadway
Los Angeles, CA 90012...................................  February 2001                              46,734

Montebello:
863 N. Wilcox Avenue
Montebello, CA 90640....................................  April 2002                                     (3)

Monterey Park:
419 No. Atlantic Blvd., #101
Monterey Park, CA 91754.................................  November 2003                              90,469

Noriega:
1301 Noriega Street
San Francisco, CA 94122.................................  August 2005                                78,954

Oakland:
367 Eighth Street
Oakland, CA 94607.......................................  February 1999                             143,945

Oakland-MacArthur:
4148 MacArthur Blvd.
Oakland, CA 94619.......................................  August 1998                                    (3)

Oakland-Webster:
800 Webster Street
Oakland, CA 94607.......................................  September 2007                             62,539

Pasadena:
199 South Los Robles, Suite 780
Pasadena, CA 91101......................................  June 2003                                      (4)
    
</TABLE>

- ----------
(3)  Facility is a homeowners center that does not take deposits.
(4)  Facility is a commercial loan center that does not take deposits.


                                       57

<PAGE>



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                                                                Total Deposits
Office Location                                           Lease Expiration Date                at June 30, 1998
- ---------------                                           ---------------------                ----------------
                                                                                            (Dollars in Thousands)
<S>                                                       <C>                                     <C>      
Paso Robles:
825 Riverside Ave., Suite #2
Paso Robles, CA 93446...................................  January 2001                                   (5)

Rowland Heights:
1015 S. Nogales St., #102
Rowland Heights, CA 91748...............................  June 1999                               $  44,212

San Francisco Chinatown:
1066 Grant Avenue
San Francisco, CA 94133.................................  September 2003                            199,900

San Francisco Van Ness:
711 Van Ness Avenue
San Francisco, CA 94102.................................  Company-owned                              61,880

San Francisco Stockton:
1318 Stockton Street
San Francisco, CA 94133.................................  July 2003                                  62,330

San Jose:
1663 Lundy Avenue, Suite D
San Jose, CA 95131......................................  January 2001                               35,333

San Mateo:
27 East Fourth Avenue
San Mateo, CA 94401.....................................  November 2000                              16,378

Stockton:
146 E. Market Street
Stockton, CA 95202......................................  December 1998                              26,127

Temple City:
5607 N. Rosemead Blvd.
Temple City, CA 91780...................................  September 2001                            117,000
    
</TABLE>

- ----------
(5)  Facility is a SBA Loan office that does not take deposits.


         The Bank believes its present facilities are adequate for its present
needs. However, the Bank may acquire additional properties if needed due to
business expansion. The Bank believes that, if necessary, it could secure
suitable alternative facilities without adversely affecting operations.


                                       58

<PAGE>



Legal Proceedings

         The Bank is subject to pending or threatened actions and proceedings
arising in the normal course of business. In the opinion of management, the
ultimate disposition of all pending or threatened actions and proceedings will
not have a material adverse effect on the Bank's operations or financial
condition.

                           SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

Introduction

   
         Bank holding companies and commercial banks engaged in the commercial
banking business are extensively regulated under both federal and state law. Set
forth below is a summary description of certain laws which relate to the
regulation of the Company and the Bank The description below does not purport to
be complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to applicable laws and
regulations.

Recent Legislative Developments
    

         The Financial Services Act of 1998, introduced in March 1998, would
allow securities firms, insurance companies and commercial banks to merge under
a holding company structure. Among other things, the bill would expand the
Federal Reserve's regulatory authority over these financial institutions. The
Company is unable to predict whether this bill or any other such legislation
will be enacted, what the provisions of such final legislation may be, or the
extent to which the legislation would restrict, disrupt or otherwise have a
material effect on its operations.

Bank Holding Company and Bank Regulation

   
         The Company. As a registered bank holding company, the Companyis
subject to regulation under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended
(the "BHCA") and the regulations promulgated by the Federal Reserve Board
pursuant thereto. Holdings is required to file with the Federal Reserve Board
quarterly and annual reports and such additional information as the Federal
Reserve Board may require pursuant to the BHCA. The Federal Reserve Board may
conduct examinations of the Company and its non-bank subsidiaries. The Company
is a bank holding company within the meaning of Section 3700 of the California
Financial Code. As such, the Company and its subsidiaries are subject to
examination by, and may be required to file reports with, the DFI.

         The Federal Reserve Board could require that the Company terminate an
activity or terminate control of or liquidate or divest certain subsidiaries or
affiliates when the Federal Reserve Board believes the activity or the control
of the subsidiary or affiliate constitutes a significant risk to the financial
safety, soundness or stability of a banking subsidiary such as the Bank. The
Federal Reserve Board also has the authority to regulate provisions of certain
bank holding company debt, including authority to impose interest ceilings and
reserve requirements on such debt. Under certain circumstances, the Company
would be required to file written notice and obtain approval from the Federal
Reserve Board prior to purchasing or redeeming its equity securities. Further,
the Company is required by the Federal Reserve Board to maintain certain levels
of capital.

         The Company is required to obtain the prior approval of the Federal
Reserve Board for the acquisition of more than 5% of the outstanding shares of
any class of voting securities or substantially all of the assets of any bank
(other than the Bank) or bank holding company. Prior approval of the Federal
Reserve Board would also be required for the merger or consolidation of the
Company and another bank holding company.

         The Company is prohibited by the BHCA, except in certain statutorily
prescribed instances, from acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of
more than 5% of the outstanding voting shares of any company that is not a bank
or bank holding company and from engaging directly or indirectly in activities
other than those of banking,


                                       59

<PAGE>



managing or controlling banks or furnishing services to its subsidiaries.
However, the Company, subject to the prior approval of the Federal Reserve
Board, can engage in any, or acquire shares of companies engaged in, activities
that are deemed by the Federal Reserve Board to be so closely related to banking
or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto. In making
any such determination, the Federal Reserve Board would be required to consider
whether the performance of such activities by the Company or an affiliate could
reasonably be expected to produce benefits to the public, such as greater
convenience, increased competition or gains in efficiency, that outweigh
possible adverse effects, such as undue concentration of resources, decreased or
unfair competition, conflicts of interest or unsound banking practices. The
Federal Reserve Board is also empowered to differentiate between activities
commenced de novo and activities commenced by acquisition, in whole or in part,
of a going concern. In 1996, the Budget Act of 1996 (the "Budget Act")
eliminated the requirement that bank holding companies seek Federal Reserve
Board approval before engaging de novo in permissible nonbanking activities
listed in Federal Reserve Board Regulation Y, which governs bank holding
companies, if the holding company and its lead depository institution are well
managed and well capitalized and certain other criteria specified in the statute
are met. For purposes of determining the capital levels at which a bank holding
company shall be considered well capitalized under this section of the Budget
Act and Regulation Y, the Federal Reserve Board adopted, as a rule, risk-based
capital ratios (on a consolidated basis) that are the same as the level set for
determining that a state member bank is well capitalized under the provisions
established under the prompt corrective action provisions of federal law. See
"--Savings Institution Regulations--Prompt Corrective Action."
    

         Under Federal Reserve Board regulations, a bank holding company is
required to serve as a source of financial and managerial strength to its
subsidiary bank(s) and may not conduct its operations in an unsafe or unsound
manner. In addition, it is the Federal Reserve Board policy that in serving as a
source of strength to its subsidiary bank(s), a bank holding company should
stand ready to use available resources to provide adequate capital funds to its
subsidiary bank(s) during periods of financial stress or adversity and should
maintain the financial flexibility and capital-raising capacity to obtain
additional resources for assisting its subsidiary bank(s). A bank holding
company's failure to meet its obligations to serve as a source of strength to
its subsidiary bank(s) will generally be considered by the Federal Reserve Board
to be an unsafe and unsound banking practice or a violation of the Federal
Reserve Board's regulations or both.

   
         Transactions with Affiliates. The Company is a bank holding company and
as such is subject to the FRB regulations, examination, supervision and
reporting requirements As an insured institution and a subsidiary of a bank
holding company, the Bank is subject to restrictions in its dealings with
companies that are "affiliates" of the Company under the Federal Reserve Act.

         The Bank's transactions with its affiliates are subject to the
limitations set forth in Sections 23A, 23B, 22(g) and 22(h) of the Federal
Reserve Act and Regulation O adopted by the Federal Reserve Board. Affiliates
are defined as any company that controls or is under common control with an
institution. Under Section 23A, the Company is an "affiliate" of the Bank.
Sections 23A and 23B require that covered transactions and certain other
transactions with affiliates be on terms and conditions consistent with safe and
sound banking practices or on terms comparable to similar transactions with
non-affiliated parties, and impose quantitative restrictions on the amount of
and collateralization requirements on covered transactions. "Covered
transactions" generally include loans or extensions of credit to an affiliate,
purchases of securities issued by an affiliate, purchases of assets from an
affiliate (except as may be exempted by order or regulation), and certain other
transactions. In addition, a bank is prohibited from extending credit to an
affiliate (other than a subsidiary of the institution), unless the affiliate is
engaged only in activities that the Federal Reserve Board has determined, by
regulation, to be permissible for bank holding companies. Sections 22(g) and
22(h) of the Federal Reserve Act impose limitations on loans and extensions of
credit from an institution to its executive officers, directors and principal
stockholders and each of their related interests.

         The Bank. The Bank is a California state-chartered bank, and is subject
to primary supervision, periodic examination and regulation by the Commissioner
of the California DFI (the "Commissioner") and the FDIC. If, as a result of an
examination of a Bank, either of these Bank regulatory agencies should determine
that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings
prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of the Bank's operations are
unsatisfactory or that the Bank or its management is violating or has violated
any law or regulation,


                                       60

<PAGE>



various remedies are available to the bank regulatory agency. Such remedies
include the power to enjoin "unsafe or unsound" practices, to require
affirmative action to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or
practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to
direct an increase in capital, to restrict the growth of the bank, to assess
civil monetary penalties, to remove officers and directors and ultimately to
terminate a bank's deposit insurance, which would result in a revocation of the
Bank's charter. The Bank was not the subject of any such actions by the OTS in
the past.
    

         Safety and Soundness Standards. The FDIC and the Federal Reserve Board
have adopted final guidelines establishing standards for safety and soundness,
as required by FDICIA. These standards are designed to identify potential safety
and soundness concerns and ensure that action is taken to address those concerns
before they pose a risk to the deposit insurance funds. The standards relate to:
(i) internal controls, information systems and internal audit systems; (ii) loan
documentation; (iii) credit underwriting; (iv) asset growth; (v) earnings; and
(vi) compensation, fee and benefits. If the FDIC or the Federal Reserve Board
determine that an institution fails to meet any of these standards, the agency
may require the institution to submit to the agency an acceptable plan to
achieve compliance with the standard. In the event the institution fails to
submit an acceptable plan within the time allowed by the agency or fails in any
material respect to implement an accepted plan, the agency must, by order,
require the institution to correct the deficiency. The FDIC or the Federal
Reserve Board agencies have promulgated safety and soundness regulations and
accompanying interagency compliance guidelines on asset quality and earnings
standards. These new guidelines provide six standards for establishing and
maintaining a system to identify problem assets and prevent those assets from
deteriorating. The institution should: (i) conduct periodic asset quality
reviews to identify problem assets; (ii) estimate the inherent losses in those
assets and establish reserves that are sufficient to absorb estimated losses;
(iii) compare problem asset totals to capital; (iv) take appropriate corrective
action to resolve problem assets; (v) consider the size and potential risks of
material asset concentrations; and (vi) provide periodic asset reports with
adequate information for management and the board of directors to assess the
level of asset risk. These new guidelines also set forth standards for
evaluating and monitoring earnings and for ensuring that earnings are sufficient
for the maintenance of adequate capital and reserves. If an institution fails to
comply with a safety and soundness standard, the appropriate federal banking
agency may require the institution to submit a compliance plan. Failure to
submit a compliance plan or to implement an accepted plan may result in
enforcement action.

   

         Capital Requirements. The FDIC has adopted risk-based capital
guidelines to which the Bank is subject. The guidelines establish a systematic
analytical framework that makes regulatory capital requirements more sensitive
to differences in risk profiles among banking organizations. The Bank is
required to maintain certain levels of regulatory capital in relation to
regulatory risk-weighted assets. The ratio of such regulatory capital to
regulatory risk-weighted assets is referred to as the Bank's "risk-based capital
ratio." Risk-based capital ratios are determined by allocating assets and
specified off-balance sheet items to four risk-weighted categories ranging from
0% to 100%, with higher levels of capital being required for the categories
perceived as representing greater risk.

         These guidelines divide a bank's capital into two tiers. The first tier
("Tier I") includes common equity, retained earnings, certain non-cumulative
perpetual preferred stock (excluding auction rate issues) and minority interests
in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries, less goodwill and other
intangible assets (except mortgage servicing rights and purchased credit card
relationships subject to certain limitations). Supplementary ("Tier II") capital
includes, among other iterms, cumulative perpetual and long-term limited-life
preferred stock, mandatory convertible securities, certain hybrid capital
instruments, term subordinated debt and the allowance for loan and lease losses,
subject to certain limitations, less required deductions. Banks are required to
maintain a total risk-based capital ratio of 8%, of which at least 4% must be
Tier I capital.

         In addition, the FDIC has established regulations prescribing a minimum
Tier I leverage ratio (Tier I capital to adjusted total assets as specified in
the regulations). These regulations provide for a minimum Tier I leverage ratio
of 3% for banks that meet certain specified criteria, including that they have
the highest examination rating and are not experiencing or anticipating
significant growth. All other banks are required to maintain a Tier I leverage
ratio of 3% plus an additional cushion of at least 100 to 200 basis points. The
FDIC may, however, set higher leverage and risk-based capital requirements on
individual institutions when particular circumstances warrant. Banks
experiencing or anticipating significant growth are expected to maintain capital
ratios, including tangible capital positions, well above the minimum levels. At
June 30, 1998, the Bank's tangible and core capital ratios were 6.56% and the
risk-based capital ratio was 13.61%.

         In August 1995, the FDIC, along with the other federal banking
agencies, adopted a regulation providing that the agencies will take account of
the exposure of a bank's capital and economic value to changes in interest rate
risk in assessing a bank's capital adequacy. According to the agencies,
applicable considerations include the quality of the bank's interest rate risk
management process, the overall financial condition of the bank and the level of
other risks at the bank for which capital is needed. Institutions with
significant interest rate risk may be required to hold additional capital. The
agencies also have issued a joint policy statement providing guidance on
interest rate risk management, including a discussion of the critical factors
affecting the agencies' evaluation of interest rate risk in connection with
capital adequacy. The agencies have determined not to proceed with a previously
issued proposal to develop a supervisory framework for measuring interest rate
risk and an explicit capital component for interest rate risk.

    

         Insurance of Accounts. The FDIC has adopted a risk-based insurance
assessment system. The FDIC assigns an institution to one of three capital
categories based on the institution's financial information, as of the reporting
period ending seven months before the assessment period. The capital categories
are (1) well capitalized, (2) adequately capitalized or (3) undercapitalized. An
institution is also placed in one of three supervisory subcategories within each
capital group. The supervisory subgroup to which an institution is assigned is
based on a supervisory evaluation provided to the FDIC by the institution's
primary federal regulator and information that the FDIC determines to be
relevant to the institution's financial condition and the risk posed to the
deposit insurance funds. An institution's assessment rate depends on the capital
category and supervisory category to which it is assigned with the most well
capitalized, healthy institutions receiving the lowest rates.

         Deposits of the Bank are presently insured by the SAIF. Both the SAIF
and the BIF are statutorily required to achieve and maintain a ratio of
insurance reserves to total insured deposits equal to 1.25%. Until recently,
members of the SAIF and BIF were paying average deposit insurance assessments of
between 24 and 25 basis points. The BIF met the required reserve level in 1995,
whereas the SAIF was not expected to meet or exceed the required level until
2002 at the earliest. This situation was primarily due to the statutory
requirement that SAIF members make payments on bonds issued in the late 1980s by
the Financing Corporation ("FICO") to recapitalize the predecessor to the SAIF.

         In view of the BIF's achieving the 1.25% ratio, the FDIC ultimately
adopted a new assessment rate schedule ranging from 0-27 basis points under
which 92% of BIF members paid an annual premium of only $2,000. With respect to
SAIF member institutions, the FDIC adopted a final rule retaining the previously
existing assessment rate schedule applicable to SAIF member institutions of 23
to 31 basis points. As long as the premium differential continued, it may have
had adverse consequences for SAIF members, including reduced earnings and an
impaired ability to raise funds in the capital markets. In addition, SAIF
members, such as the Bank, could have been placed at a substantial competitive
disadvantage to BIF members with respect to pricing of loans and deposits and
the ability to achieve lower operating costs.


                                       61

<PAGE>



         On September 30, 1996, the President of the United States signed into
law the Funds Act which, among other things, imposed a special one-time
assessment on SAIF member institutions, including the Bank, to recapitalize the
SAIF. As required by the Funds Act, the FDIC imposed a special assessment of
65.7 basis points on SAIF assessable deposits held as of March 31, 1995, payable
November 27, 1996 (the "SAIF Special Assessment"). The SAIF Special Assessment
was recognized by the Bank as an expense in the quarter ended September 30,
1996, and is generally tax deductible. The SAIF Special Assessment recorded by
the Bank amounted to $7.7 million on a pre-tax basis and $4.5 million on an
after-tax basis.

         The Funds Act also spread the obligations for payment of the FICO bonds
across all SAIF and BIF members. Beginning on January 1, 1997, BIF deposits were
assessed for a FICO payment of 1.3 basis points, while SAIF deposits pay 6.48
basis points. Full pro rata sharing of the FICO payments between BIF and SAIF
members will occur on the earlier of January 1, 2000, or the date the BIF and
SAIF are merged.

         As a result of the Funds Act, the FDIC voted to effectively lower SAIF
assessments to 0-27 basis points as of January 1, 1997, a range comparable to
that of BIF members. SAIF members will also continue to make the FICO payments
described above. The FDIC also lowered the SAIF assessment schedule for the
fourth quarter of 1996 to 18-27 basis points. Management cannot predict the
level of FDIC insurance assessments on an on-going basis, whether the federal
thrift charter will be eliminated or whether the BIF and SAIF will eventually be
merged.

         The Bank's assessment rate, effective as of January 1, 1997, was
reduced to 0.164% based upon its current risk classification, and the regular
premium paid for 1997 was $1.8 million. As discussed in further detail under
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations--Results of Operations--Noninterest Expenses," the Bank's deposit
insurance premium has been reduced to 6.4 basis points, effective as of January
1, 1998.

         The FDIC is authorized to raise the assessment rates in certain
circumstances. The FDIC has exercised this authority several times in the past
and may raise insurance premiums in the future. If such action is taken by the
FDIC, it could have an adverse effect on the earnings of the Bank.

         Under the FDIA, insurance of deposits may be terminated by the FDIC
upon a finding that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices,
is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations or has violated any
applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by the FDIC or the
OTS. The management of the Bank does not know of any practice, condition or
violation that might lead to termination of deposit insurance.

   
         Prompt Corrective Action. The federal banking regulators have
established capital levels for institutions to implement the "prompt corrective
action" provisions of the FDICIA which require certain supervisory actions
against undercapitalized institutions. Based on these capital levels, insured
institutions will be categorized as well capitalized, adequately capitalized,
undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized or critically undercapitalized.
The FDICIA requires federal banking regulators to take prompt corrective action
to solve the problems of those institutions that fail to satisfy their
applicable minimum capital requirements. The level of regulatory scrutiny and
restrictions imposed become increasingly severe as an institution's capital
level falls.

         A "well capitalized" institution must have risk-based capital of 10% or
more, leverage capital ratio of 5% or more and Tier 1 risk-based capital (based
on the ratio of core capital to risk-weighted assets) of 6% or more and may not
be subject to any written agreement, order, capital directive, or prompt
corrective action directive. As of December 31, 1997 and thereafter, the Bank
was a well capitalized institution under the definitions. An institution will be
categorized as "adequately capitalized" if it has total risk-based capital of 8%
or more, Tier 1 risk-based capital of 4% or more, and generally a leverage
capital ratio of 4% or more and does not meet the definition of "well
capitalized;" "undercapitalized" if it has total risk-based capital of less than
8%, or Tier 1 risk-based capital of less than 4%, or


                                       62

<PAGE>



generally a leverage ratio of less than 4%; "significantly undercapitalized" if
it has total risk-based capital of less than 6%, or Tier 1 risk-based capital of
less than 3%, or leverage capital of less than 3%; and "critically
undercapitalized" if it has a ratio of tangible equity to total assets that is
equal to less than 2%.

         In the case of an institution that is categorized as
"undercapitalized," such an institution must submit a capital restoration plan
to the FDIC. An undercapitalized depository institution generally will not be
able to acquire other banks or thrifts, establish additional branches, pay
dividends, or engage in any new lines of business unless consistent with its
capital plan. A "significantly undercapitalized" institution will be subject to
additional restrictions on its affiliate transactions, the interest rates paid
by the institution on its deposits, the institution's asset growth, compensation
of senior executive officers, and activities deemed to pose excessive risk to
the institution. Regulators may also order a significantly undercapitalized
institution to hold elections for new directors, terminate any director or
senior executive officer employed for more than 180 days prior to the time the
institution became significantly undercapitalized, or hire qualified senior
executive officers approved by the regulators. The FDICIA provides that an
institution that is "critically undercapitalized" must be placed in
conservatorship or receivership within 90 days of becoming categorized as such
unless the institution's regulator and the FDIC jointly determine that some
other course of action would result in a lower resolution cost to the
institution's insurance fund.

         Potential Enforcement Actions. Commercial banking organizations, such
as the Company and the Bank, and their institution-affiliated parties, may be
subject to potential enforcement actions by the Federal Reserve Board, the FDIC
and/or the Commissioner for violations of any law, rule, regulation or any
condition imposed in writing by the agency or any written agreement with the
agency for unsafe or unsound practices in conducting their businesses.
Enforcement actions may include the imposition of a conservator or receiver, the
issuance of a cease-and-desist order that can be judicially enforced, the
termination of insurance of deposits (in the case of the Bank), the imposition
of civil money penalties, the issuance of directives to increase capital, the
issuance of formal and informal agreements, the issuance of removal and
prohibition orders against institution affiliated parties, and the imposition of
restrictions and sanctions under the prompt corrective action provisions of the
FDICIA. Additionally, a holding company's inability to serve as a source of
strength to its subsidiary banking organizations could serve as an additional
basis for a regulatory action against the holding company. Neither the Company
nor the Bank has been subject to any such enforcement actions.

         Federal Home Loan Bank System. The Bank is a member of the FHLB system,
which consists of 12 regional Federal Home Loan Banks governed and regulated by
the Federal Housing Finance Board. The Federal Home Loan Banks provide a central
credit facility for member institutions. The Bank, as a member of the FHLB of
San Francisco, is required to acquire and hold shares of capital stock in the
FHLB of San Francisco in an amount at least equal to the greater of 1% of the
aggregate principal amount of its unpaid residential mortgage loans, home
purchase contracts and similar obligations as of the close of each calendar
year, or 5% of its borrowings from the FHLB of San Francisco (including advances
and letters of credit issued by the FHLB on the Bank's behalf). The Bank is
currently in compliance with this requirement, with a $14.9 million investment
in stock of the FHLB of San Francisco as of June 30, 1998.
    
   
         The FHLB of San Francisco makes advances to members in accordance with
policies and procedures periodically established by the Federal Housing Finance
Board and the Board of Directors of the FHLB of San Francisco. Currently
outstanding advances from the FHLB of San Francisco are required to be secured
by a member's shares of stock in the FHLB of San Francisco and by certain types
of mortgages and other assets. The FIRREA further limited the eligible
collateral in certain respects. Interest rates charged for advances vary
depending on maturity, the cost of funds to the FHLB of San Francisco and the
purpose of the borrowing. As of June 30, 1998, there were $298.0 million in
outstanding advances from the FHLB of San Francisco to the Bank.

         Federal Reserve System. The Federal Reserve Board regulations require
depository institutions to maintain non-interest-earning reserves against their
transaction accounts. The Federal Reserve Board regulations generally required
that reserves be maintained against aggregate transaction accounts as follows:
for accounts aggregating $47.8 million or less (subject to adjustment by the
Federal Reserve Board) the reserve requirement is 3%; and for accounts greater
than $47.8 million, the reserve requirement is $1.4 million plus 10% (subject to
adjustment by the Federal


                                       63

<PAGE>



Reserve Board between 8% and 14%) against that portion of total transaction
accounts in excess of $47.8 million. The first $4.7 million of otherwise
reservable balances (subject to adjustment by the Federal Reserve Board) are
exempted from the reserve requirements. The Bank is in compliance with the
foregoing requirements. Because required reserves must be maintained in the form
of either vault cash, a non-interest-bearing account at a Federal Reserve Bank
or a pass-through account as defined by the Federal Reserve Board, the effect of
this reserve requirement is to reduce the Bank's interest-earning assets. FHLB
System members are also authorized to borrow from the Federal Reserve "discount
window," but Federal Reserve Board regulations require institutions to exhaust
all FHLB sources before borrowing from a Federal Reserve Bank.

         Community Reinvestment Act. Under the Community Reinvestment Act (the
"CRA"), as implemented by FDIC regulations, an institution has a continuing and
affirmative obligation consistent with its safe and sound operation, to help
meet the credit needs of its entire community, including low and moderate income
neighborhoods. The CRA does not establish specific lending requirements or
programs for financial institutions nor does it limit an institution's
discretion to develop the types of products and services that it believes are
best suited to its particular community, consistent with the CRA. The CRA
requires the federal bank regulators, in connection with its examination of a
financial institution, to assess the institution's record of meeting the credit
needs of its community and to take such records into account in its evaluation
of certain applications. As a state chartered bank, the Bank is subject to the
fair lending requirements and reporting obligations involving home mortgage
lending operations of the CRA. The FIRREA amended the CRA to require public
disclosure of an institution's CRA rating and to require that the federal
regulators provide a written evaluation of an institution's CRA performance
utilizing a four-tiered descriptive rating system in lieu of the existing
five-tiered numerical rating system. Based upon OTS examinations in 1996 and
1998, the Bank's CRA ratings were "outstanding."

         Loans-to-One-Borrower Limitations. The FIRREA provided that
loans-to-one-borrower limits applicable to national banks apply to other
depository institutions. Generally, under current limits, loans and extensions
of credit outstanding at one time to a single borrower shall not exceed 15% of
the savings institution's unimpaired capital and unimpaired surplus. Loans and
extensions of credit fully secured by certain readily marketable collateral may
represent an additional 10% of unimpaired capital and unimpaired surplus. As of
June 30, 1998, the Bank was in compliance with the loans-to-one-borrower
limitations.
    

         Interstate Banking and Branching. Under the Interstate Branching Act, a
bank holding company that is adequately capitalized and managed may obtain
approval under the BHCA (via merger) to acquire (via merger) an existing bank
located in another state without regard to state law. A bank holding company is
not permitted to make such an acquisition if, upon consummation, it would
control (a) more than 10% of the total amount of deposits of insured depository
institutions in the United States or (b) 30% or more of the deposits in the
state in which the bank is located. A state may limit the percentage of total
deposits that may be held in that state by any one bank or bank holding company
if application of such limitation does not discriminate against out-of-state
banks or bank holding companies. An out-of-state bank holding company may not
acquire a state bank in existence for less than a minimum length of time that
may be prescribed by state law, except that a state may not impose more than a
five-year age requirement.

         The Interstate Branching Act also permits mergers of insured banks
located in different states and conversion of the branches of the acquired bank
into branches of the resulting bank. Each state may adopt legislation to
prohibit interstate mergers after that date in that state or in other states by
that state's banks. The same concentration limits discussed in the preceding
paragraph apply. The Interstate Branching Act also permits a national or state
bank to establish branches in a state other than its home state if permitted by
the laws of that state, subject to the same requirements and conditions as for a
merger transaction.

         Under the Interstate Branching Act, the extent of a commercial bank's
ability to branch into a new state will depend on the law of the state.
California has adopted an early "opt in" statute under the Interstate Branching
Act that permits out-of-state banks to acquire California banks that satisfy a
five-year minimum age requirement (subject to exceptions for supervisory
transactions) by means of merger or purchases of assets; although entry through
acquisition of individual branches of California institutions and de novo
branching into California are not permitted. The Interstate Branching Act and
the California branching statute allows out-of-state banks to enter and compete
in the markets in which the Bank operates.


                                       64

<PAGE>



                     MANAGEMENT OF THE COMPANY AND THE BANK

   
         In accordance with the respective bylaws of the Company and the Bank,
the Boards of Directors of the Company and the Bank consists of seven members.
The directors of the Company have been elected to the following classes: one
class of directors, consisting of Messrs. Fell and McMeekin, has a term expiring
at the first annual meeting of stockholders; the second class, consisting of
Messrs. Downing and Lam, has a term of office expiring at the second annual
meeting of stockholders; and the third class, consisting of Messrs. Wong and Wu,
has a term of office expiring at the third annual meeting of stockholders. The
remaining vacancy is expected to be filled by the Board of Directors of the Bank
in the near future. There are no arrangements or understandings between the
Company and the Bank and any person pursuant to which such person has been
proposed to be a director, and no director nominee is related to any other
director nominee or executive officer of the Company or the Bank by blood,
marriage or adoption.
    

Directors and Executive Officers

         The directors and executive officers of the Company and the Bank are
set forth below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
NAME                                                        AGE    POSITION
- ----                                                        ---    --------
Directors:

<S>                                                         <C>    <C>                 
Sau-wing Lam.............................................   45     Chairman of the Boards of Directors
Tommy S. Wu..............................................   40     President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
Jonathan H. Downing......................................   46     Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer,
                                                                      Treasurer and Director
Robert Fell..............................................   77     Director
Ronald McMeekin..........................................   65     Director
Godwin Wong..............................................   48     Director
                                                                  
Executive Officers Who Are Not Directors:                         
                                                                  
Louis E. Barbarelli......................................   57     Senior Vice President and Director of Operations
                                                                      and Systems
William T. Goldrick......................................   66     Senior Vice President and Chief Credit Officer
Cecilia Lai..............................................   48     Senior Vice President, Director of Retail
                                                                      Banking
Dennis Alan Lee..........................................   55     Vice President and Corporate Counsel
Sylvia Loh...............................................   42     Senior Vice President and Director of Commercial
                                                                      Banking
Deanne Miller............................................   50     Senior Vice President and Director of Human
                                                                      Resources
    
</TABLE>


         Mr. Lam was appointed President, Chief Executive Officer and Vice
Chairman of the Board of Directors of the Bank in December 1996. On December 31,
1997, he retired as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Bank but
remained as Vice Chairman of the Board of Directors. Previously, Mr. Lam served
as President and Chief Executive Officer of Pacific Link Communications Limited
located in Hong Kong, a subsidiary of the First Pacific Group. Mr. Lam was
appointed President, Chief Executive Officer and Director of the Bank in March
1991 and left in 1995 to head up Pacific Link Communications Limited. Mr. Lam's
banking experience began when he joined the International Division of Crocker
National Bank in San Francisco in July 1977. He was transferred to Crocker's
Hong Kong Regional Officer in 1979 where he directed the administration,
correspondent banking and marketing functions. He returned to Crocker's
headquarters in 1983 where he directed Correspondent Banking for the Asia
Pacific Region. In February 1984, he joined The Hibernia Bank in San Francisco,
then a First Pacific Group ("Group") subsidiary, as the head of Trust Banking.
When the Group acquired the Bank in 1986, Mr. Lam was appointed its Chief
Administrative Officer and Senior Vice President, Retail Banking. In 1989, he
was transferred to the Group's headquarters in Hong Kong to become the Group
Treasurer. Mr. Lam devotes a significant amount of his personal time on
voluntary services in the ethnic Chinese communities. Mr. Lam graduated with a
B.S. degree in Business Administration from California State University at
Fresno in 1975, and a MBA degree in International Finance at the University of
California at Berkeley in 1977.


                                       65

<PAGE>



         Mr. Wu was appointed President and Chief Executive Officer of the Bank
effective January 1, 1998. Prior to that appointment, Mr. Wu was the Executive
Vice President and Director of the Bank as of September 25, 1997. Previously,
Mr. Wu was the Director of Customer Care for Pacific Link Communications Limited
in Hong Kong where he managed over 600 employees and was responsible for
formulating and implementing customer care, customer retention, and customer
communications strategies. Mr. Wu served as a director of the Bank from
1995-1996 and was a Senior Vice President, Head of Retail Banking of the Bank
from 1992-1996 when he directed the marketing, public relations, loan
originations, branch administration and operations control functions. Mr. Wu
also served the Bank as Vice President, Regional Manager, of its Southern
California Retail Banking Division from 1991-1992. Prior to joining the Bank in
1991, Mr. Wu was at First Pacific Bank, Hong Kong where he served as Vice
President and Team Leader of its Business Banking Group; Vice President, Deputy
Head, Retail Banking Group; and Assistant Vice President, Retail Banking Group
from 1986-1991. Prior to First Pacific Bank, Mr. Wu's experience included the
following: Assistant Treasurer, and Branch Manager for Chase Manhattan Bank,
N.A., Hong Kong; Assistant Manager, Banque Nationale De Paris, Hong Kong;
Assistant Officer, Standard Chartered Bank, Hong Kong (1977-1986). Mr. Wu has
also served on the Board of Directors of the Self-Help For the Elderly (also a
member of the finance committee) and the PineView Housing Corporation (also
chairperson of the finance committee). Mr. Wu is a graduate of Cognitio College,
Hong Kong and has taken numerous banking and management courses at the
University of California, Berkeley and the Chartered Institute of Bankers.

         Mr. Barbarelli has been Senior Vice President and Director of
Operations and Systems of the Bank since August 1993, and served as a member of
the Board of Directors from 1994 to 1998. Prior to 1993, he served for two years
as a Senior Vice President and Chief Auditor of the Bank. Before joining the
Bank, Mr. Barbarelli was the General Auditor at Jackson County Federal Bank in
Medford, Oregon. Mr. Barbarelli has also served at the senior management level
at Hibernia Bancshares (San Francisco, California), Central Bank (Concord,
California), Bank of California, Fireman's Fund Insurance and U.S. Leasing. Mr.
Barbarelli has a B.S. in Information Systems Management from the University of
San Francisco.

         Mr. Downing has been Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
of the Bank since 1989. Mr. Downing has served as a director of the Bank since
January 1991. Mr. Downing joined the First Pacific Group in July 1983 as one of
four professionals contracted to create a de novo mortgage banking operation
(FPM Inc.) in California. Mr. Downing served as Chief Financial Officer of FPM
Inc. until it was merged into United Savings Bank in 1986. At that time he
assumed the responsibilities of Director of Secondary Marketing for the Bank and
was appointed its Chief Financial Officer in 1989. Prior to joining the First
Pacific Group, Mr. Downing was with Arthur Andersen and Co. Mr. Downing received
a B.S. in Business Administration from California State University, San Diego.
Mr. Downing is a CPA and a member of the American Institute of Certified Public
Accountants and the California Society of Certified Public Accountants.

   
         Mr. Goldrick has been Senior Vice President and Chief Credit Officer of
the Bank since January 1997. Prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Goldrick was the
Senior Vice President, Senior Credit Officer for America California Bank from
1995 to 1997; Chief Lending Officer for National American Bank from 1992 to
1995; First Vice President-Manager Loan Administration for MBANK from 1987 to
1991; Vice President-Credit Policy, Vice President-Senior Credit Officer for
Asia and Vice President-Division Administrator for Crocker National Bank. Mr.
Goldrick has also held various international banking positions with Crocker
National Bank from 1969 to 1986. Mr. Goldrick received a B.A. in Economics from
the University of California, Santa Barbara in 1957.
    

         Ms. Lai has served as a member of the Board of Directors from 1997 to
1998, and has served as the Senior Vice President and Director of Retail Banking
since 1997. Prior to holding that position she was Vice President of Credit Risk
Management and Compliance, as well as CRA Officer and Compliance Officer at the
Bank since 1992. From 1988 to 1992, Ms. Lai held a variety of positions
(Director of Marketing, Manager, Market Support Group, Branch


                                       66

<PAGE>



Manager and Marketing Analyst) within the Bank. Prior to joining the Bank, Ms.
Lai served as Executive Director of the Oakland Chinese Community Council and in
various positions at Automatic Data Processing, Underwriters Travelers
Insurance., and Allstate Insurance Company. Ms. Lai received a B.A. and M.A.
from Holy Names College.

         Mr. Lee has served as Corporate Counsel for the Bank since June, 1993.
Currently, he also serves as Vice President for the Bank. Prior to joining the
Bank, Mr. Lee was a director and General Counsel for Golden Coin Savings and
Loan Association. Prior to this, Mr. Lee was in private practice at the Law
Office of Barkley & Lee. Mr. Lee has also served in a variety of positions in
the legal profession, including City Attorney for the City of Pleasant Hill,
City Attorney for the cities of Martinez and Pleasant Hill, Senior Assistant
City Attorney for the City of Redwood City, Acting City Attorney and Assistant
City Attorney for the City of Berkeley, Judge Pro-Tem at the Berkeley-Albany
Municipal Court and Temporary Court Commissioner. Mr. Lee received an A.A.
degree from Warren Wilson Junior College (Asheville, North Carolina), B.A.
degree from San Francisco State College in 1966 and a J.D. from the University
of California, Hastings College of Law in 1969. Mr. Lee is a member of the State
Bar of California.

         Ms. Loh is a Senior Vice President and Director of Commercial Banking
of the Bank and joined the Bank as Vice President and Head of Commercial Banking
in January 1996. Ms. Loh created the commercial banking division for the Bank
and manages three marketing teams which focus on commercial real estate, trade
finance, business banking loan products and SBA. Prior to joining the Bank, Ms.
Loh held the position of Vice President, Relationship Manager, Bank of America,
International Trade Bank from 1992-1996. In this position, she managed an export
portfolio with an annual fee income of $12,000,000 and managed and increased an
import credit portfolio to $45,000,000. From 1988-1992, Ms. Loh was the Vice
President, Team Manager, Commercial Banking, Security Pacific Asian Bank where
she managed a team of loan officers with a focus on trade finance, real estate
investment and private banking. Ms. Loh was the Vice President, Preferred
Banking Manager, Bank of America, Golden Gate Area Management Group from 1987-
1988 where she managed a team of seven Preferred Bankers supporting 26 retail
branches with a focus on high net worth clientele. From 1982-1985, Ms. Loh was
the Assistant Vice President, Credit Administration, San Francisco Main Office
where she was responsible for the credit quality of a $200,000,000 commercial
loan portfolio, assisted the commercial banking officers in credit structuring
and achieved excellent credit examinations for three consecutive years. Ms. Loh
was the Branch Manager, for Bank of America's Mandarin Towers Branch from 1979-
1982. Ms. Loh received a B.A. degree in Accounting and Finance from the
California State University in San Francisco in 1979 and is a past President of
the Association of Asian American Bankers (1996-1997).

         Ms. Miller is Senior Vice President and Director of Human Resources of
the Bank. Ms. Miller joined the Bank in 1986 as Assistant Vice President and
Employment Manager. In 1993 Ms. Miller was promoted to Vice President and
Director of Human Resources, and was promoted to Senior Vice President in 1997.
Prior to joining the Bank, Ms. Miller was a Human Resources Representative at
Crocker National Bank/Wells Fargo Bank, and a Personnel Recruiter for Allan Kent
Personnel Service. Ms. Miller is a graduate of Cedar Rapids Business College,
and completed the Paralegal Studies Program at San Francisco State University
and has taken personnel course work at the University of California, Berkeley.

         Mr. Fell was appointed to the Board of the Bank in 1994. Mr. Fell
joined the Board of the FPB Bank Holding Company Limited in August 1993. Mr.
Fell is currently a financial consultant and is Chairman of the International
Securities Consultancy Limited. Mr. Fell is a published author, having written
his personal account of the history of the stock market and banking in Hong Kong
during the last ten years. Mr. Fell is a British subject who currently resides
in London, United Kingdom. He began his Civil Service career after the War with
the British Board of Trade where he concentrated on international trade and
finance. He served for five years in Australia as a Trade Commissioner and five
years in India. From 1967 to 1980 he was in charge of the United Kingdom's
export policy and commercial relations with the United States. He later became
the head of the Export Credits Guarantee Department where he was closely
involved with the United States EXIM Bank and the Department of the Treasury. In
1974 he left government service to become the first Chief Executive of the
London Stock Exchange. In 1981, he was invited by the Hong Kong government to
become a Commissioner for Securities. He was instrumental in the unification of
Hong Kong's three stock exchanges and the creation of a financial futures
market. In 1984 he was appointed Commissioner of Banking and of Deposit-taking
Companies. He was directly responsible for the changes in Hong Kong's banking
regulations and the successful rescue of several banks during the crisis of
1983. After the stock market crash in October 1987, he took over as Chief
Executive of the Hong Kong Stock Exchange and introduced the new management set
up which is still in use today.


                                       67

<PAGE>



   
         Mr. McMeekin was appointed as a director of the Company and the Bank in
July 1998. With over 30 years of extensive domestic and overseas banking
experience, he has served as Chief Executive Officer for the following banks:
Bank of the Orient in San Francisco from 1990 to 1996, I.B.I. Asia in Hong Kong
from 1988 to 1989, and Ocean Leila in Hong Kong from 1973 to 1976. Mr. McMeekin
has developed banking operations in the United States, Europe, and Asia. His
experience in environments undergoing rapid change has allowed him to engineer
the turn-around of a major financial services group in Hong Kong as well as a
United States bank. Earlier assignments included senior management positions
with Crocker Bank (now Wells Fargo Bank) in San Francisco and Standard Chartered
Bank, London. Mr. McMeekin is also a member of the Institute of Bankers,
Scotland, and has attended management development programs at Harvard Business
School.
    

         Dr. Wong has been a director of the Bank since 1994. Dr. Wong has been
on the Faculty of the Haas School of Business at the University of California at
Berkeley for the last thirteen years. Dr. Wong has also been a tenured professor
of management at Golden Gate University for the last fifteen years. Dr. Wong has
been on the faculty of the Graduate School of Business Administration, Zurich,
Switzerland for the last nine years and lectured in 16 countries to high level
business executives throughout the world. Dr. Wong was appointed by the FDIC,
Federal Home Loan Bank Board, Resolution Trust Corporation and the OTS to be on
the Boards of Directors of various financial institutions, including Gateway
Bank and California National Bank. Dr. Wong has also served on the Boards of
other organizations, including World Affairs Council, International Forum,
Harvard Club and Chinatown Resources Development Center. Dr. Wong graduated with
a Bachelor's degree from the University of Wisconsin, a M.B.A. from the
University of California, Los Angeles and a M.A. and Ph.D from Harvard
University.

Meetings of the Board of Directors and Committees of the Board of Directors of
the Company

         The Board of Directors of the Company conducts its business through
meetings of the Board of Directors and through activities of its committees. The
Board of Directors of the Company meets every other month and may have
additional meetings as needed. During the year ended December 31, 1997, the
Board of Directors of the Company acted eight times by unanimous written consent
in lieu of meeting. All of the directors of the Company participated in at least
75% of the total number of the Company's Board meetings held and committee
meetings on which such directors served during 1997. The Board of Directors of
the Company maintains an Audit and Examining Committee, a Credit Policy and
Investment Committee and a Human Resources Committee, the nature and composition
of which are described below:

   
         Audit Committee. The Audit and Examining Committee of the Company and
the Bank consist of Messrs. Fell, Wong and McMeekin. The Audit Committee is
responsible for reporting to the Board on the general financial condition of the
Bank and the results of the annual audit, and is responsible for ensuring that
the Bank's activities are being conducted in accordance with applicable laws and
regulations. The Audit and Examining Committee of the Company was formed in May
1998. The Audit and Examining Committee of the Bank met six times in 1997.
    

         Human Resources Committee. The Human Resources Committee of the Company
consists of Messrs. Lam and Fell. The Human Resources Committee of the Company
reviews and recommends to the Board of Directors compensation for senior
management of the Bank; the adoption, amendment and implementation of incentive
compensation plans, stock option plans, and other benefit plans and programs for
the Company and the Bank. The Human Resources Committee of the Company and the
Bank is also responsible for maintaining on behalf of the Board of Directors a
current senior management succession and contingency plan; charged with the
investigation and resolution of any incident which may be construed as a
potential conflict of interest on behalf of any member of senior management or
other offices of the Company and the Bank wherein Board of Directors oversight
and action are appropriate; and may be required from time to time that senior
management of the Bank and officers and directors of the Company provide
proposals for, or status or progress reports on, policies or programs which may
have a material bearing on the strategic human resources philosophy and
consequent operational direction of the Bank. The Human Resources Committee of
the Company was formed in 1998. The Compensation Committee of the Bank met four
times in 1997.


                                       68

<PAGE>



   
         Credit Policy and Investment Committee. The Credit Policy and
Investment Committee of the Company and the Bank consists of Messrs. Wong,
Downing, Fell, Lam, McMeekin and Wu. The committee is responsible for approving
credit policies, setting parameters for credit risks, monitoring the overall
credit risk profile of the Company and the Bank and the valuation allowance
reserve. The Credit Policy and Investment Committee of the Company was formed in
May 1998. The Credit Policy and Investment Committee of the Bank met six times
in 1997.
    

Directors' Compensation

         Directors' Fees. Currently, all outside directors of the Company and
the Bank each receive an annual retainer of $25,200, while the Chairman of the
Board of Directors of the Company and the Bank receives an annual retainer of
$150,000, for service on the Board of Directors of the Company and the Bank. No
committee meeting fees are paid by the Company or the Bank. Messrs. Wu and
Downing do not receive any additional compensation for serving as directors of
the Company and the Bank.


                                       69

<PAGE>



Summary Compensation Table

         The following shows, for the year ended December 31, 1997, the cash
compensation paid by the Company and the Bank as well as certain other
compensation paid for that year, to the Chief Executive Officer and the other
five most highly compensated executive officers at the Company.


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                Long Term Compensation
                                                                         --------------------------------------------
                                                                                     Awards               Payouts
                                                                                     ------               -------

                                           Annual Compensation


                                                            Other        Restricted       Securities        LTIP          All
Name and                                     Bonus         Annual          Stock         Underlying       Payouts       Other
Principal Position       Year      Salary      (3)       Compensation      Awards        Options/SARs        (4)      Compensation
- ------------------       ----      ------      ---       ------------      ------        ------------        ---      ------------

<S>          <C>         <C>     <C>         <C>           <C>              <C>                <C>           <C>          <C>
Sau-wing Lam (1)         1997    $285,554    $    --       $3,529           $--                --            $--          $--
Chairman of the                                                                                             
Board of Directors                                                                                          
                                                                                                            
Tommy S. Wu (2)          1997     $47,788    $30,000       $1,334            --                --             --           --
President, Chief                                                                                            
Executive Officer                                                                                           
and Director                                                                                                
                                                                                                            
Jonathan H.              1997    $159,000    $17,500         $499            --                --             --           --
Downing                                                                                                     
Senior Vice                                                                                                 
President, Chief                                                                                            
Financial Officer,                                                                                          
Treasurer and                                                                                               
Director                                                                                                    
                                                                                                            
Louis E. Barbarelli      1997    $126,000    $25,000         $242            --                --             --           --
Senior Vice                                                                                                 
President and                                                                                               
Director of                                                                                                 
Operations and                                                                                              
Systems                                                                                                     
                                                                                                            
Cecilia Lai              1997    $101,246    $20,000         $194                                           
Senior Vice                                                                                                 
President and                                                                                               
Director of Retail                                                                                          
Banking                                                                                                     
                                                                                                            
Dennis A. Lee            1997    $117,468     $3,000       $2,697            --                --             --           --
Vice President and                                                                                          
Corporate Counsel                                                                                           
                                                                                                            
Sylvia Loh               1997    $117,600    $20,000         $220            --                --             --           --
Senior Vice                                                                                                     
President and                                                                                                
Director of              
Commercial               
Banking                  
</TABLE>

                                       70

<PAGE>



   
- ----------
(1)  Mr. Lam was President and Chief Executive Officer of the Bank and Vice
     Chairman of the Board of Directors of the Bank during 1997. Effective
     December 31, 1997, Mr. Lam resigned as President and Chief Executive
     Officer of the Bank but remained as Vice Chairman of the Board of
     Directors. Effective April 17, 1998, Mr. Lam was elected as Chairman of the
     Board of Directors of the Bank and the Company.
(2)  Mr. Wu re-joined the Bank on September 23, 1997, after spending one year
     with a former overseas affiliate. Mr. Wu was named President and Chief
     Executive Officer of the Bank effective January 1, 1998. Mr. Wu was elected
     President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company effective March 26,
     1998 and as a director of the Company on April 17, 1998. As of September
     23, 1997, Mr. Wu's annual base compensation was $175,000 per annum.
(3)  The referenced bonus represents a performance bonus for the year ended
     December 31, 1996 which was paid in the first quarter of 1997.
(4)  The former Long-Term Incentive Plan was terminated in conjunction with the
     Private Offerings.
    


Employment and Change in Control Agreements

         The Bank and the Company have entered into employment agreements with
Tommy S. Wu, the President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and the
Bank (the "Executive"). These employment agreements are intended to ensure that
the Bank and the Company will be able to maintain a stable and competent
management base. The continued success of the Bank and the Company depends to a
significant degree on the skills and competence of the Executive.

         The employment agreements provide for a three-year term. The Bank
employment agreement provides that, commencing on the first anniversary date and
continuing each anniversary date thereafter, the Board of Directors will review
the agreement and the Executive's performance for purposes of determining
whether to extend the agreement for an additional year so that the remaining
term shall be three years, unless written notice of non-renewal is given by the
Board of Directors after conducting a performance evaluation of the Executive.
The term of the Company employment agreement shall be extended on a daily basis
unless written notice of non-renewal is given by the Board of Directors after
conducting a performance evaluation of the Executive. The agreements provide
that the Executive's base salary will be reviewed annually. In addition to the
base salary, the agreements provide for, among other things, participation in
stock benefit plans and other fringe benefits applicable to executive personnel.
The agreements provide for termination by the Bank or the Company for cause as
would be defined in the agreements, at any time. In the event the Bank or the
Company choose to terminate the Executive's employment for any reasons other
than for cause, or in the event of the Executive's resignation from the Bank and
the Company upon: (i) failure to re-elect the Executive to Executive's current
offices; (ii) a material change in the Executive's functions, duties or
responsibilities; (iii) a relocation of the Executive's principal place of
employment by more than 25 miles; (iv) liquidation or dissolution of the Bank or
the Company; or (v) a breach of the agreement by the Bank or the Company; the
Executive or, in the event of death, the Executive's beneficiary, would be
entitled to receive an amount equal to the remaining base salary payments due to
the Executive and the contributions that would have been made on the Executive's
behalf to any employee benefit plans of the Bank or the Company during the
remaining term of the agreement. The Bank and the Company would also continue
and pay for the Executive's life, health and disability insurance coverage for
the remaining term of the agreement.

         Under the agreements, if voluntary or involuntary termination follows a
change in control of the Bank or the Company as defined in the proposed
employment agreements, it is expected that, the Executive, or, in the event of
the Executive's death, his beneficiary, would be entitled to a severance payment
equal to the greater of: (i) the payments due for the remaining terms of the
agreement; or (ii) three times the highest annual compensation paid for the
preceding three years. It is expected that the Bank and the Company would also
continue the Executive's life, health and disability insurance coverage for 36
months.

         The Bank and the Company have entered into three-year termination and
change in control agreements ("CIC Agreements") with certain other executive
officers (the "Officers") of the Company and the Bank. The CIC Agreements
provide that commencing on the first anniversary date and continuing on each
anniversary thereafter, the Bank's CIC Agreements may be renewed by the Board of
Directors for an additional year. The Company's CIC Agreements are similar to
the Bank's CIC Agreements except that the term of the Company's CIC Agreements
shall be extended on a


                                       71

<PAGE>



daily basis. The CIC Agreements provide that in the event voluntary or
involuntary termination follows a change in control of the Bank or the Company,
the Officer would be entitled to receive a severance payment equal to three
times the Officer's highest annual compensation for the three years preceding
the change in control. The Bank would also continue, and pay for, the Officer's
life, health and disability insurance coverage for the remaining term of the
agreements. Payments to the Officer under the Bank's CIC Agreements are
guaranteed by the Company in the event that payments of benefits are not paid by
the Bank. The CIC Agreements also provide that if an Officer is terminated
during the existence of the CIC Agreement for any reason other than resignation,
cause (as defined in the CIC Agreements), death or permanent disability, but
prior to any change in control of the Company or the Bank, the Officer shall be
paid a severance payment equal to the highest annual compensation paid to such
Officer for the three preceding years.

         In the event of a change in control, total payments to executives and
officers under the employment agreements and the CIC Agreements, based solely on
current base salary, would be $3.2 million.

Stock Option Plan

   
         The Board of Directors of the Company has adopted a Stock Option Plan
(the "Stock Option Plan") which provides for the granting of stock options to
eligible officers, employees and directors of the Company and the Bank. The
Company has reserved 653,333 shares of Common Stock to be issued pursuant to the
Stock Option Plan, of which 620,000 were granted at an exercise price of $15.00
and will vest over a three-year period.
    

         The stock option benefits provided under the Stock Option Plan are
designed to attract and retain qualified personnel in key positions, provide
officers, directors and key employees with a proprietary interest in the Company
as an incentive to contribute to the success of the Company, promote the
attention of management to other Stockholders' concerns and reward key employees
for outstanding performance. All employees and directors of the Company and its
subsidiaries are eligible to participate in such plan. The Stock Option Plan
provides for the grant of: (i) options to purchase the Company's Common Stock
intended to qualify as incentive stock options under Section 422 of the Code
("Incentive Stock Options"); or (ii) options that do not so qualify
("Non-Statutory Stock Options"). Unless sooner terminated, the Stock Option Plan
will be in effect for a period of ten years from the date of adoption by the
Board of Directors. The Company intends to grant all future options under the
Stock Option Plan at an exercise price equal to the fair market value of the
underlying Common Stock on the date of grant. Following termination of
employment or service in the event of disability, a change in control or death,
all Non-Statutory Stock Options, whether or not exercisable, shall vest and
become immediately exercisable. In the event of termination for cause or
termination of employment for any other reason including retirement or voluntary
resignation, all vested Non-Statutory Stock Options as of the date of
termination shall remain exercisable for a period of one year, and all unvested
Non-Statutory Stock Options shall become null and void. Following termination of
employment or service in the event of disability, retirement, a change in
control or death, all Incentive Stock Options, whether or not exercisable, shall
vest and become immediately exercisable. In the event of termination for cause
or termination of employment for any other reason including voluntary
resignation, all vested Incentive Stock Options as of the date of termination
shall remain exercisable for a period of one year, and all unvested Incentive
Stock Options shall become null and void. It is anticipated that all options
granted to officers and employees will be intended to be Incentive Stock Options
to the extent permitted under Section 422 of the Code.

Transactions With Certain Related Persons

         The Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery and Enforcement Act
("FIRREA") requires that all loans or extensions of credit to executive officers
and directors must be made on substantially the same terms, including interest
rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable
transactions with the general public and must not involve more than the normal
risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features. In addition, loans made
to a director or executive officer in excess of the greater of $25,000 or 5% of
the Bank's capital and surplus (up to a maximum of $500,000) must be approved in
advance by a majority of the disinterested members of the Board of Directors.
The Bank's policy provides that no loans may be made by the Bank to its
executive officers and directors.

         It is the policy of the Company that all transactions between the
Company and holders of 10% or more of the shares of any class of its common
stock and affiliates thereof, contain terms no less favorable to the Company
than could have been obtained by it in arm's-length negotiations with
unaffiliated persons and are required to be approved by a majority of
independent outside directors of the Company not having any interest in the
transaction.

                                       72


<PAGE>



Security Ownership of Management and Other Beneficial Owners

         The following table sets forth, as of August 12, 1998, certain
information as to those persons who were known by management to be beneficial
owners of more than 5% of the Company's outstanding shares of Common Stock, each
director, each Named Executive Officer and the shares of Common Stock
beneficially owned by all directors and executive officers of the Company as a
group.


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
   
                                                                                 Number           Percentage
                                                                                   of            Beneficially
Name of Beneficial Owner                    Position(s) with the Company       Shares (1)           Owned
- ------------------------                    ----------------------------       ----------          ------
<S>                                         <C>                                   <C>               <C>
Sau-wing Lam............................    Chairman of the Board of              50,000              *
                                              Directors                                       
Tommy S. Wu.............................    Director, President and               33,333              *
                                              Chief Executive Officer                               
Jonathan H. Downing.....................    Senior Vice President,                16,667              *
                                              Chief Financial Officer,                           
                                              Treasurer and Director
Robert Fell.............................    Director                                  --              *
Godwin Wong.............................    Director                              20,000              *
Ronald McMeekin.........................    Director                                  --              *
Louis E. Barbarelli.....................    Senior Vice President and              3,333              *
                                              Director of Operations
                                              and Systems
Cecilia Lai.............................    Senior Vice President and             10,000              *
                                              Director of Retail Banking                         
Dennis Alan Lee.........................    Vice President and                     6,667              *
                                              Corporate Counsel                                  
Sylvia Loh..............................    Senior Vice President and             16,667              *
                                              Director of Commercial Banking
All Executive Officers and Directors                                             163,333            1.75%
   as a Group (12 persons).............. 
    
</TABLE>

- ----------
*    Does not exceed 1.0% of the Company's voting securities.
(1)  The number of shares of Common Stock outstanding and the number owned by
     the individuals or entities listed does not include any shares issuable
     pursuant to outstanding options, none of which may be exercised until April
     17, 1999.


                                       73


<PAGE>



                   DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK OF THE COMPANY

General

         The Company is authorized to issue 25 million shares of Common Stock
having a par value of $.01 per share and 10 million shares of preferred stock
having a par value of $.01 per share (the "Preferred Stock"). The Company issued
9,333,333 shares of Common Stock and no shares of Preferred Stock in the Private
Offerings. Each share of the Company's Common Stock has the same relative rights
as, and is identical in all respects with, each other share of Common Stock. All
such stock has been duly authorized and is fully paid and non-assessable.

Common Stock

         Dividends. The Company can pay dividends out of statutory surplus or
from certain net profits if, as and when declared by its Board of Directors. The
payment of dividends by the Company is subject to limitations which are imposed
by law and applicable regulation. See "Supervision and Regulation." The holders
of Common Stock of the Company are entitled to receive and share equally in such
dividends as may be declared by the Board of Directors of the Company out of
funds legally available therefor. If the Company issues Preferred Stock, the
holders thereof may have a priority over the holders of the Common Stock with
respect to dividends.

         Voting Rights. The holders of Common Stock of the Company possess
exclusive voting rights in the Company. They elect the Company's Board of
Directors and act on such other matters as are required to be presented to them
under Delaware law or the Company's Certificate of Incorporation or as are
otherwise presented to them by the Board of Directors. Except as discussed in
"Restrictions on Acquisition," each holder of Common Stock are entitled to one
vote per share and do not have any right to cumulate votes in the election of
directors. If the Company issues Preferred Stock, holders of the Preferred Stock
may also possess voting rights. Certain matters require an 80% stockholder vote.
See "Restrictions on Acquisition."

         Voting rights with respect to the Bank are vested exclusively in the
owners of the shares of capital stock of the Bank, which is the Company, and
voted at the direction of the Company's Board of Directors. Consequently, the
holders of the Common Stock do not have direct control of the Bank.

         Liquidation. In the event of any liquidation, dissolution or winding up
of the Bank, the Company, as holder of the Bank's capital stock, would be
entitled to receive, after payment or provision for payment of all debts and
liabilities of the Bank, all assets of the Bank available for distribution. In
the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company, the holders
of its Common Stock would be entitled to receive, after payment or provision for
payment of all its debts and liabilities, all of the assets of the Company
available for distribution. If Preferred Stock is issued, the holders thereof
may have a priority over the holders of the Common Stock in the event of
liquidation or dissolution.

         Preemptive Rights. Holders of Common Stock of the Company are not be
entitled to preemptive rights with respect to any shares which may be issued.
The Common Stock is not subject to redemption.

Preferred Stock

         None of the shares of the Company's Preferred Stock have been issued.
Such stock may be issued with such preferences and designations as the Board of
Directors may from time to time determine. The Board of Directors can, without
stockholder approval, issue preferred stock with voting, dividend, liquidation
and conversion rights which could dilute the voting strength of the holders of
the Common Stock and may assist management in impeding an unfriendly takeover or
attempted change in control.


                                       74

<PAGE>



                           RESTRICTIONS ON ACQUISITION

General

         Certain provisions in the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and
Bylaws and in its management remuneration, together with provisions of Delaware
corporate law, may have anti-takeover effects. In addition, regulatory
restrictions may make it difficult for persons or companies to acquire control
of either the Company or the Bank.

Restrictions in the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws

         A number of provisions of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation
and Bylaws deal with matters of corporate governance and certain rights of
stockholders. The following discussion is a general summary of certain
provisions of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws and certain
other statutory and regulatory provisions relating to stock ownership and
transfers, the Board of Directors and business combinations, which might be
deemed to have a potential "anti-takeover" effect. These provisions may have the
effect of discouraging a future takeover attempt, which is not approved by the
Board of Directors but which individual Company stockholders may deem to be in
their best interests or in which stockholders may receive a substantial premium
for their shares over then current market prices. As a result, stockholders who
might desire to participate in such a transaction may not have an opportunity to
do so. Such provisions will also render the removal of the current Board of
Directors or management of the Company more difficult. The following is a
general description of certain of the provisions of the Certificate of
Incorporation and Bylaws of the Company.

         Limitation on Voting Rights. The Certificate of Incorporation of the
Company provides that in no event shall any record owner of any outstanding
Common Stock which is beneficially owned, directly or indirectly, by a person
who beneficially owns in excess of 10% of the then outstanding shares of Common
Stock (the "Limit") be entitled or permitted to any vote in respect of the
shares held in excess of the Limit. Beneficial ownership is determined pursuant
to Rule 13d-3 of the General Rules and Regulations promulgated pursuant to the
Exchange Act, and includes shares beneficially owned by such person or any of
his affiliates (as defined in the Certificate of Incorporation), shares which
such person or his affiliates have the right to acquire upon the exercise of
conversion rights or options and shares as to which such person and his
affiliates have or share investment or voting power, but shall not include
shares beneficially owned by directors, officers and employees of the Bank or
Company or shares that are subject to a revocable proxy and that are not
otherwise beneficially owned or deemed by the Company to be beneficially owned,
by such person and his affiliates. The Certificate of Incorporation of the
Company further provides that this provision limiting voting rights may only be
amended upon the vote of 80% of the outstanding shares of voting stock (after
giving effect to the limitation on voting rights).

         Board of Directors. The Board of Directors of the Company is divided
into three classes, each of which shall contain approximately one-third of the
whole number of members of the Board. Each class shall serve a staggered term,
with approximately one-third of the total number of directors being elected each
year. The Company's Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws provide that the
size of the Board shall be determined by a majority of the directors. The
Certificate of Incorporation and the Bylaws provide that any vacancy occurring
in the Board, including a vacancy created by an increase in the number of
directors or resulting from death, resignation, retirement, disqualification,
removal from office or other cause, shall be filled for the remainder of the
unexpired term exclusively by a majority vote of the directors then in office.
The classified Board is intended to provide for continuity of the Board of
Directors and to make it more difficult and time consuming for a stockholder
group to fully use its voting power to gain control of the Board of Directors
without the consent of the incumbent Board of Directors of the Company. The
Certificate of Incorporation of the Company provides that a director may be
removed from the Board of Directors prior to the expiration of his term only for
cause, upon the vote of 80% of the outstanding shares of voting stock.

         In the absence of these provisions, the vote of the holders of a
majority of the shares could remove the entire Board, with or without cause, and
replace it with persons of such holders' choice.


                                       75

<PAGE>



         Cumulative Voting, Special Meetings and Action by Written Consent. The
Certificate of Incorporation does not provide for cumulative voting for any
purpose. Moreover, special meetings of stockholders of the Company may be called
only by the Board of Directors of the Company. The Certificate of Incorporation
also provides that any action required or permitted to be taken by the
stockholders of the Company may be taken only at an annual or special meeting
and prohibits stockholder action by written consent in lieu of a meeting.

         Authorized Shares. The Certificate of Incorporation authorizes the
issuance of 25 million shares of Common Stock and 10 million shares of Preferred
Stock. The shares of Common Stock and Preferred Stock were authorized to provide
the Company's Board of Directors with as much flexibility as possible to effect,
among other transactions, financings, acquisitions, stock dividends, stock
splits and employee stock options. However, these additional authorized shares
may also be used by the Board of Directors consistent with its fiduciary duty to
deter future attempts to gain control of the Company. The Board of Directors
also has sole authority to determine the terms of any one or more series of
Preferred Stock, including voting rights, conversion rates, and liquidation
preferences. As a result of the ability to fix voting rights for a series of
Preferred Stock the Board has the power, to the extent consistent with its
fiduciary duty, to issue a series of Preferred Stock to persons friendly to
management in order to attempt to block a post-tender offer merger or other
transaction by which a third party seeks control, and thereby assist management
to retain its position. The Company's Board of Directors currently has no plans
for the issuance of additional shares, other than the issuance of additional
shares upon exercise of stock options to be issued pursuant to the terms of the
Stock Option Plan.

         Stockholder Vote Required to Approve Business Combinations with
Principal Stockholders. The Certificate of Incorporation requires the approval
of the holders of at least 80% of the Company's outstanding shares of voting
stock to approve certain "Business Combinations," as defined therein, and
related transactions. Under Delaware law, absent this provision, Business
Combinations, including mergers, consolidations and sales of all or
substantially all of the assets of a corporation must, subject to certain
exceptions, be approved by the vote of the holders of only a majority of the
outstanding shares of Common Stock of the Company and any other affected class
of stock. Under the Certificate of Incorporation, at least 80% approval of
stockholders is required in connection with any transaction involving an
Interested Stockholder or (ii) if the proposed transaction meets certain
conditions set forth therein which are designed to afford the stockholders a
fair price in consideration for their shares in which case, if a stockholder
vote is required, approval of only a majority of the outstanding shares of
voting stock would be sufficient. The term "Interested Stockholder" is defined
to include any individual, corporation, partnership or other entity (other than
the Company or its subsidiary) which owns beneficially or controls, directly or
indirectly, 10% or more of the outstanding shares of voting stock of the
Company. This provision of the Certificate of Incorporation applies to any
"Business Combination," which is defined to include (i) any merger or
consolidation of the Company or any of its subsidiaries with or into any
Interested Stockholder or Affiliate (as defined in the Certificate of
Incorporation) of an Interested Stockholder; (ii) any sale, lease, exchange,
mortgage, pledge, transfer, or other disposition to or with any Interested
Stockholder or Affiliate of 25% or more of the assets of the Company or combined
assets of the Company and its subsidiary; (iii) the issuance or transfer to any
Interested Stockholder or its Affiliate by the Company (or any subsidiary) of
any securities of the Company in exchange for any assets, cash or securities of
the Company in exchange for any assets, cash or securities the value of which
equals or exceeds 25% of the fair market value of the Common Stock of the
Company; (iv) the adoption of any plan for the liquidation or dissolution of the
Company proposed by or on behalf of any Interested Stockholder or Affiliate
thereof; and (v) any reclassification of securities, recapitalization, merger or
consolidation of the Company which has the effect of increasing the
proportionate share of Common Stock or any class of equity or convertible
securities of the Company owned directly or indirectly by an Interested
Stockholder or Affiliate thereof.
   
         Evaluation of Offers. The Certificate of Incorporation of the Company
further provides that the Board of Directors of the Company, when evaluating any
offer of another "Person" (as defined therein) to (i) make a tender or exchange
offer for any equity security of the Company, (ii) merge or consolidate the
Company with another corporation or entity, or (iii) purchase or otherwise
acquire all or substantially all of the properties and assets of the Company,
may, in connection with the exercise of its judgment in determining what is in
the best interest of the Company, the Bank and the stockholders of the Company,
give due consideration to all relevant factors, including, without limitation,
the social and economic effects of acceptance of such offer on the Company's
customers and the bank's present and future account holders, borrowers and
employees; on the communities in which the Company and the Bank operate or are
located; and


                                       76

<PAGE>

on the ability of the Bank to fulfill the objectives of a banking institution
under applicable statutes and regulations. By having these standards in the
Certificate of Incorporation of the Company, the Board of Directors may be in a
stronger position to oppose such a transaction if the Board concludes that the
transaction would not be in the best interest of the Company, even if the price
offered is significantly greater than the then market price of any equity
security of the Company.
    
         Amendment of Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws. Amendments to the
Company's Certificate of Incorporation must be approved by a majority vote of
its Board of Directors and also by a majority of the outstanding shares of its
voting stock; provided, however, that an affirmative vote of at least 80% of the
outstanding voting stock entitled to vote (after giving effect to the provision
limiting voting rights) is required to amend or repeal certain provisions of the
Certificate of Incorporation, including the provision limiting voting rights,
the provisions relating to approval of certain business combinations, calling
special meetings, the number and classification of directors, director and
officer indemnification by the Company and amendment of the Company's Bylaws and
Certificate of Incorporation. The Company's Bylaws may be amended by its Board
of Directors, or by a vote of 80% of the total votes eligible to be voted at a
duly constituted meeting of stockholders.

         Certain Bylaw Provisions. The Bylaws of the Company also require a
stockholder who intends to nominate a candidate for election to the Board of
Directors, or to raise new business at a stockholder meeting to give at least 90
days advance notice to the Secretary of the Company. The notice provision
requires a stockholder who desires to raise new business to provide certain
information to the Company concerning the nature of the new business, the
stockholder and the stockholder's interest in the business matter. Similarly, a
stockholder wishing to nominate any person for election as a director must
provide the Company with certain information concerning the nominee and the
proposing stockholder.

     ANTI-TAKEOVER EFFECTS OF THE COMPANY'S CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION AND
                                     BYLAWS
                           AND MANAGEMENT REMUNERATION

         The provisions described above are intended to reduce the Company's
vulnerability to takeover attempts and certain other transactions which have not
been negotiated with and approved by members of its Board of Directors. The
provisions of the employment agreements, CIC Agreements and Stock Option Plan
may also discourage takeover attempts by increasing the costs to be incurred by
the Bank and the Company in the event of a takeover. See "Management of the
Company and Bank--Employment and Change in Control Agreements" and "--Stock
Option Plan."

         The Company's Board of Directors believes that the provisions of the
Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws and management remuneration plans are in
the best interest of the Company and its stockholders. An unsolicited
non-negotiated proposal can seriously disrupt the business and management of a
corporation and cause it great expense. Accordingly, the Board of Directors
believes it is in the best interests of the Company and its stockholders to
encourage potential acquirors to negotiate directly with management and that
these provisions will encourage such negotiations and discourage non-negotiated
takeover attempts. It is also the Board of Directors' view that these provisions
should not discourage persons from proposing a merger or other transaction at a
price that reflects the true value of the Company and that otherwise is in the
best interest of all stockholders.

Delaware Corporate Law

         The state of Delaware has a statute designed to provide Delaware
corporations with additional protection against hostile takeovers. The takeover
statute, which is codified in Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporate Law
("Section 203"), is intended to discourage certain takeover practices by
impeding the ability of a hostile acquiror to engage in certain transactions
with the target company.

         In general, Section 203 provides that a "Person" (as defined therein)
who owns 15% or more of the outstanding voting stock of a Delaware corporation
(an "Interested Stockholder") may not consummate a merger or other business


                                       77

<PAGE>



combination transaction with such corporation at any time during the three-year
period following the date such "Person" became an Interested Stockholder. The
term "business combination" is defined broadly to cover a wide range of
corporate transactions including mergers, sales of assets, issuances of stock,
transactions with subsidiaries and the receipt of disproportionate financial
benefits.

         The statute exempts the following transactions from the requirements of
Section 203; (i) any business combination if, prior to the date a person became
an Interested Stockholder, the Board of Directors approved either the business
combination or the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an
Interested Stockholder; (ii) any business combination involving a person who
acquired at least 85% of the outstanding voting stock in the transaction in
which he became an Interested Stockholder, with the number of shares outstanding
calculated without regard to those shares owned by the corporation's directors
who are also officers and by certain employee stock plans; (iii) any business
combination with an Interested Stockholder that is approved by the Board of
Directors and by a two-thirds vote of the outstanding voting stock not owned by
the Interested Stockholder; and (iv) certain business combinations that are
proposed after the corporation had received other acquisition proposals and
which are approved or not opposed by a majority of certain continuing members of
the Board of Directors. A corporation may exempt itself from the requirements of
the statute by adopting an amendment to its Certificate of Incorporation or
Bylaws electing not to be governed by Section 203. At the present time, the
Board of Directors does not intend to propose any such amendment.

Regulatory Restrictions

   
         The Change in Bank Control Act and the BHCA, together with FRB
regulations promulgated under those acts, require that the consent of the FRB be
obtained prior to any person or company acquiriing "control" of a bank holding
company. Control is conclusively presumed to exist if an individual or company
acquires more than 25% of any class of voting stock of the bank holding company.
Control is rebuttably presumed to exist if the person acquires more than 10% of
any class of voting stock of a bank holding company and if either (i) the
company has registered securities under Section 12 of the Exchange Act or (ii)
no other person will own a greater percentage of that class of voting securities
immediately after the transaction. The regulations provide a procedure to rebut
the foregoing presumption. Since the Company's Common Stock will be registered
under Section 12 of the Exchange Act, any acquisition of 10% or more of the
outstanding Common Stock will give rise to a rebuttable presumption that the
acquiror of such stock controls the Company, requiring the acquiror, prior to
acquiring such stock, to rebut the presumption of control to the satisfaction of
the FRB or obtain FRB approval for the acquisition of control.
    

                               REGISTRATION RIGHTS

         In connection with the Private Offerings, the Company on April 13, 1998
entered into the Registration Rights Agreement with the initial purchasers of
the Common Stock, pursuant to which the Company agreed to (i) cause to be filed
with the Commission within 120 days after the original issuance of the Common
Stock pursuant to the Purchase Agreement, a shelf registration statement
providing for the offer and sale of the Common Stock issued in the Private
Offerings, (ii) use its best efforts to cause the shelf registration statement
to be declared effective under the Securities Act as promptly as possible and
(iii) use its best efforts to keep effective the shelf registration statement
until the earlier of the second anniversary of the date such shelf registration
statement is declared effective by the Commission or such time as all of the
Common Stock have been sold thereunder or otherwise may be sold without the need
for the shelf registration statement, as set forth in the Registration Rights
Agreement. The Company agreed to bear the expenses arising out of the filing of
such shelf registration statement. The Registration Statement of which this
Prospectus forms a part has been filed to satisfy the Company's obligations
under the Registration Rights Agreement.

         Pursuant to the terms of the Registration Rights Agreement, a holder of
Common Stock and the Placement Agent desiring to sell some or all of such
securities pursuant to the shelf registration statement shall give the Company
not less than ten days' prior written notice, and the Company will use its best
efforts to promptly file any required amendment(s) to the shelf registration
statement in order to facilitate such sales. Initiating Holders, as defined in
the Registration Rights Agreement to mean one or more holders of not less than
25% of the then-outstanding Common


                                       78

<PAGE>



Stock, may elect that the offering of Common Stock be in the form of an
underwritten offering. Under such circumstances, the Company will provide
written notice to all holders of the Common Stock and the Placement Agent of
such underwritten offering and will provide them with an opportunity to
participate in such underwritten offering, under terms and with such conditions
as set forth in the Registration Rights Agreement.
   

         Under the Registration Rights Agreement, a holder that sells Common
Stock pursuant to the shelf registration statement generally is required to be
named as a selling security holder in the related prospectus and is required to
deliver a prospectus to purchasers, is subject to certain of the civil liability
provisions under the Securities Act in connection with such sales and is bound
by the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement that are applicable to
such a holder (including certain indemnification rights and obligations).

         Each certificate representing shares of Common Stock contain a legend
to the effect that the holder thereof, by its acceptance thereof, is deemed to
have agreed to be bound by the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement.
In that regard, each holder is deemed to have agreed that, upon receipt of
notice from the Company of the occurrence of any event which makes a statement
in the prospectus which is part of the shelf registration statement untrue in
any material respect or which requires the making of any changes in such
prospectus in order to make the statements therein not misleading, such holder
will suspend the sale of Common Stock pursuant to such prospectus until the
Company has amended or supplemented such prospectus to correct such misstatement
or omission and has furnished copies of the amended or supplemented prospectus
to such holder or the Company has given notice that the sale of the Common Stock
may be resumed.
    

         The Registration Rights Agreement is governed by, and construed in
accordance with, the laws of the State of Delaware. The summary herein of
certain provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement does not purport to be
complete and is subject to, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to,
all the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement.

                                 SELLING HOLDERS

         The Common Stock was originally issued and sold by the Company in the
Private Offerings in transactions exempt from the registration requirements of
the Securities Act, to persons reasonably believed by the Company to be
"qualified institutional buyers" (as defined in Rule 144A under the Securities
Act) or other "accredited investors" (as defined in Rule 501(a) under the
Securities Act). The Selling Holders (which term includes their transferees,
pledgees, donees or their successors) may from time to time offer and sell
pursuant to this Prospectus any or all of the Common Stock owned by each of
them.

         The following table sets forth information with respect to the Selling
Holders named herein and the shares of Common Stock beneficially owned and
offered hereby by such Selling Holders. Such information has been obtained from
such Selling Holders. Except as otherwise disclosed herein, such Selling Holders
do not have, or within the past three years have not had, any position, office
or other material relationship with the Company or affiliates. Because such
Selling Holders may offer all or some portion of the Common Stock pursuant to
this Prospectus, no estimate can be given as to the amount of the Common Stock
that will be held by such Selling Holders upon termination of any such sales. In
addition, the Selling Holders identified below may have sold, transferred or
otherwise disposed of all or a portion of their Common Stock since the date on
which it provided the information regarding their Common Stock in transactions
exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act. Finally, if
required, additional Selling Holders may from time to time be identified and
information with respect to such Selling Holders be provided in a Prospectus
Supplement.




                                       79

<PAGE>

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                      Number of Shares of Common Stock
                   Name of Selling Holder                          Beneficially Owned and Offered Hereby
                   ----------------------                          -------------------------------------
<S>                                                                               <C>  
Russell T. Abbott...........................................                        6,667
Metropolitan Capital Advisors Intl.  Ltd....................                      150,700
Everen Clearing Corp.  Cust.................................                       81,600
Amster Trading Co.  Charitable Remainder Unitrust...........                       16,700
Michael J. Antonelli........................................                       10,000
Apple Ridge Partners........................................                       25,000
BK Investments A Wisconsin Ltd.  Partnership................                        6,667
Louis E. Barbarelli.........................................                        3,333
Bay Pond Investors Bermuda L.P..............................                      216,000
Bay Pond Partners L.P.......................................                      366,000
Bayhill Fund Limited .......................................                       21,667
Bedford Falls Investors LP..................................                      239,300
Benefit Designs Inc. Pension Plan...........................                        3,334
Bear Stearns Cust...........................................                       16,700
Francois Bitz...............................................                       20,000
Frank Boides................................................                       10,000
Allan Bortel & Sydne Bortel Comm.  Prop.....................                       13,333
Nathan S. Brand.............................................                       30,000
Robert J. Buckley...........................................                       10,000
King Street Capital L.P.....................................                      133,333
Charles Schwab & Co.  Inc...................................                        3,333
Charles W. Palmer Trust.....................................                        6,667
Chester County Fund Inc.....................................                       10,000
Sally Chow..................................................                        1,000
John Sheldon Clark..........................................                       13,333
John Cleary.................................................                          666
Mark B. Cohen...............................................                       45,140
The Common Fund.............................................                       18,000
Joe A. Comer................................................                        6,667
James Connor................................................                        6,667
Deem Sum International Inc..................................                        6,667
Delverde Corporation........................................                       66,667
Raymond Digregorio..........................................                        6,667
Sandy Ding..................................................                        6,667
Donaldson Lufkin & Jenrette.................................                        6,667
Jonathan H. Downing.........................................                       16,667
Jonathan J. Doyle...........................................                        6,667
Drake Associates L.P........................................                       15,000
James J. Dunne III..........................................                       51,562
Eagle Capital Partners L.P..................................                      125,000
Emerald Fund Ltd............................................                       24,500
Emerald Partners L.P........................................                      231,350
Engineers Joint Pension.....................................                       11,550
John R. Eppinger............................................                        6,667
Marc L. Flaster.............................................                       20,476
Financial Stocks Private Equity Fund 1998 L.P...............                      386,667
Formula Fund LLC............................................                       50,931
Formula Offshore Investment Fund............................                        2,736
Francis H. Tse MD A Professional Corporation................                       10,000
</TABLE>
    


                                       80

<PAGE>

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                      Number of Shares of Common Stock
                   Name of Selling Holder                          Beneficially Owned and Offered Hereby
                   ----------------------                          -------------------------------------
<S>                                                                               <C>
Brian Fraser................................................                          333
Emerging Managers Fund......................................                        5,500
Gabrielle R. Propp Marital Trust B..........................                       66,667
Lance S. Gad................................................                       35,000
GAM Equity 10...............................................                       16,000
Gerlach & Co................................................                      390,000
Thomas Glasser..............................................                       13,030
Sandra Go...................................................                        1,000
Donald F. U. Goebert........................................                        3,333
William T. Goldrick.........................................                        3,333
Daniel L. Gorman............................................                        6,667
Gould Trading Co............................................                       46,700
H. Wayne Griest & Barbara W. Griest JT Ten..................                        5,000
Haberman Value Fund LP......................................                        6,667
Paul R. Haklisch............................................                       16,288
Hanaper Partners............................................                       10,000
Brian Hartline..............................................                       10,000
Ahron Haspel & Ruth Haspel..................................                       10,000
Lawrance Haspel.............................................                       10,000
Haussmann Holdings..........................................                       34,300
Helen Heller................................................                       66,990
Melvin S. Heller............................................                      200,000
William F. Hickey...........................................                        6,667
Andrea Ho...................................................                          667
El Coronado Holdings........................................                       35,000
Richard A. Hortsman.........................................                      140,000
Neelam Idnani...............................................                       14,833
Rajesh Idnani...............................................                       14,834
Sarah Y.  Ip................................................                        2,000
Jackson Boulevard Investments LP............................                       23,000
Jackson Boulevard Partners..................................                       42,000
Jam Partners LP.............................................                      220,000
JDN Partners LP.............................................                       45,000
Kaufman Family LLC..........................................                       66,667
Keefe Offshore Fund.........................................                      160,000
Steven Kelly................................................                        6,667
Gary Kilgore................................................                       13,333
Thomas W. Killian...........................................                        7,163
Sam Klein & Leslie Klein JT Ten.............................                       20,000
Paul M. La Noce.............................................                        3,333
Cecilia Lai.................................................                       10,000
Lakeview Financial Corp.....................................                       66,667
Anne Man Chi Lam............................................                        2,667
George Lam..................................................                       17,665
Jonathan Y. Lam.............................................                        5,000
Justin Y. Lam...............................................                        7,000
Lam Family Living Trust.....................................                       38,000
Lawrence Offshore Partners..................................                       22,500
Lawrence Partners...........................................                       37,500
Catherine A. Lawton.........................................                        6,667
</TABLE>
    

                                       81

<PAGE>

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       Number of Shares of Common Stock
                   Name of Selling Holder                          Beneficially Owned and Offered Hereby
                   ----------------------                          -------------------------------------
<S>                                                                               <C>  
Dennis Lee..................................................                        6,667
Lenient & Co................................................                      133,333
Bruce R. Lesser.............................................                        3,334
Lawrence R. Lesser..........................................                        3,333
Bruce A. Levy...............................................                       10,000
Clunet Lewis................................................                        6,667
Dominic S. Li...............................................                          667
Asset Management Holding LLC................................                       13,000
Matle Lo....................................................                        1,333
Sylvia Loh..................................................                       16,667
T. Joseph Longino...........................................                        6,667
Endicott Partners LP........................................                       50,000
Jackson Boulevard Equities LP...............................                       60,000
The Seedling Fund LP........................................                       14,500
Endicott Offshore Investors Ltd.............................                       10,000
Leona S. Ma.................................................                        6,000
Mac & Co....................................................                        6,667
Patrick E. Malloy III.......................................                      166,667
Malta Hedge Fund II L.P.....................................                       67,000
Malta Hedge Fund L.P........................................                       80,000
Malta Partners II L.P.......................................                       56,000
Malta Partners L.P..........................................                      147,000
Bijan Capital Management....................................                       17,500
Keefe Managers L.P..........................................                      156,000
George R. Mark..............................................                        7,334
John P. Mark................................................                        6,667
Dennis S. Marlo.............................................                        6,667
Timothy Matz and Jane Matz Jt Ten...........................                        6,667
Michael McKilligan..........................................                        6,667
Joseph A. Melillo...........................................                       10,000
Mercer Insurance Company....................................                        6,667
Merrill Lynch Pierce........................................                        6,667
Deanne Miller...............................................                        3,333
Bruce Mommsen...............................................                        6,667
Morey Organization Inc......................................                       10,000
Morgan Stanley & Co.........................................                        6,667
Morgan Stanley & Co.  Incorporated..........................                      333,333
James C. Ng.................................................                        6,667
Christine Noland............................................                        2,000
Northfork Bancorporation Inc................................                      457,000
Thomas F. O'Neill...........................................                        6,667
P II Inc....................................................                        6,667
Angela Pan..................................................                       13,333
Janet E. Paroo..............................................                        6,667
Endeavour Capital Partners..................................                       83,333
Charles Patton..............................................                       10,000
PH Industries...............................................                       10,000
May F. Della Pietra.........................................                        6,667
PMLDSS Ltd..................................................                        6,667
Points West Intl.  Investments Ltd..........................                       41,420
</TABLE>
    


                                       82

<PAGE>

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                      Number of Shares of Common Stock
                   Name of Selling Holder                          Beneficially Owned and Offered Hereby
                   ----------------------                          -------------------------------------
<S>                                                                               <C>   
PRB Investors LP............................................                       80,000
Fred D. Price...............................................                       13,961
Progress Capital Inc........................................                       88,334
Douglas Propp...............................................                        6,667
Eve Propp...................................................                        6,666
James Propp.................................................                        6,667
Morris Propp................................................                        6,666
Prudential Securities.......................................                       25,000
Kenneth F. Puglisi IRA......................................                        6,667
Christopher Quackenbush.....................................                       51,562
Rainbow Partners L.P........................................                       68,000
Ramat Securities Ltd........................................                       13,300
Reliance Bancorp Inc........................................                       66,667
Rembrandt Balanced Fund.....................................                       36,735
Rembrandt Value Fund........................................                      359,930
Robert Riccio...............................................                       20,000
Michael W. Richardson.......................................                        6,667
William F. Richardson IV....................................                        6,667
Eileen Romero...............................................                        1,333
Ronald J. Morey Radio Parnership............................                        6,667
J. David Rosenberg..........................................                      125,000
Roslyn Bancorp Inc..........................................                      135,000
Steven Roth.................................................                       19,833
Michael Rowe................................................                       10,000
Frank G. Salvaterra.........................................                        6,667
David Sandler...............................................                        8,720
Herman S. Sandler...........................................                       58,555
T. Dennis Sanford...........................................                       10,000
Hugh Sargant................................................                        1,667
Stanley Seid................................................                        8,000
Selective Insurance Co......................................                       50,000
Seymour Propp Nominee.......................................                        6,667
Mary Ann Shula..............................................                        6,667
Bruce E. Simmons............................................                        6,667
Smith Barney Inc............................................                       20,000
Vincent Smyth...............................................                       66,000
Spear Leeds & Kellogg.......................................                      178,333
Glen Spiro..................................................                        6,667
Edward Stein................................................                        6,667
Carrie Ann Stephens.........................................                        6,667
Charles P. Stevenson Jr.....................................                       66,667
Stillwell Associates LP.....................................                       33,000
Susan Mravca Dec.  of Trust.................................                        6,667
TFP Overseas Fund Ltd.......................................                       40,000
Third Point Offshore Fund Ltd...............................                       61,170
Third Point Partners LP.....................................                       89,750
Thistle Group Holdings Inc..................................                       33,333
John B. Thompson II.........................................                       21,872
Robert G. Thomson...........................................                       13,333
Raymond Tiernan.............................................                        6,667

</TABLE>
    

                                       83

<PAGE>

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                      Number of Shares of Common Stock
                   Name of Selling Holder                          Beneficially Owned and Offered Hereby
                   ----------------------                          ------------------------------------
<S>                                                                               <C>    
Tontine Financial Partners L.P..............................                      200,000
Tontine Overseas Find.......................................                       95,000
Tontine Partners L.P........................................                       40,000
MLPF&S Cust.................................................                       16,667
John Traynor................................................                       13,333
Kenny Tse...................................................                          667
USA Capital Inc.............................................                       23,334
Value Realization Fund......................................                       15,000
David X. Wang...............................................                        1,000
The Walt Disney Company Retirement Plan Master Trust........                       48,300
Westlakes Capital Partners..................................                        6,667
Lynn Wiese..................................................                        6,667
William P. O'Reilly Ttee....................................                       13,333
Godwin Wong.................................................                       20,000
Debby Wu....................................................                          667
Tommy S. Wu.................................................                       33,333
Kirk Wycoff.................................................                        6,667
ZPG Securities LLC..........................................                        7,660
1st Matthew.................................................                       46,667
1867 Western Financial......................................                      100,000
</TABLE>
    
         The Company has agreed to indemnify the Selling Holders against certain
liabilities arising out of any actual or alleged material misstatements or
omissions in the Registration Statement, other than liabilities arising from
information supplied by the Selling Holders for use in the Registration
Statement. Each Selling Holder, severally but not jointly, has agreed to
indemnify the Company against liabilities arising out of any actual or alleged
material misstatements or omissions in the Registration Statement insofar as
such misstatements or omissions were made in reliance upon written information
furnished to the Company by such Selling Holder expressly for use in the
Registration Statement.

                              PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

         The Common Stock offered hereby may be sold from time to time to
purchasers directly by the Selling Holders at market prices or at negotiated
prices. Alternatively, the Selling Holders may from time to time offer the
Common Stock to or through underwriters, dealers or agents who may receive
compensation in the form of underwriting discounts, concessions or commissions
from the Selling Holders or the purchasers of Common Stock, for whom they may
act as agents. The Selling Holders and any underwriters, dealers or agents which
participate in the distribution of Common Stock may be deemed to be
"underwriters" within the meaning of the Securities Act and any profit on the
sale of Common Stock by them and any discounts, commissions, concessions or
other compensation received by any such underwriter, dealer or agent may be
deemed to be underwriting discounts and commissions under the Securities Act.
   
         The Common Stock may be sold from time to time in one or more
transactions at fixed prices, at prevailing market prices at the time of sale,
at varying prices determined at the time of sale or at negotiated prices. The
sale of the Common Stock may be effected in transactions (which may involve
block transactions) (i) on any national securities exchange or quotation service
on which the Common Stock may be listed or quoted at the time of sale, (ii) in
the over-the-counter market or (iii) in transactions otherwise than on such
exchanges or in the over-the-counter market. At the time a particular offering
of the Common Stock is made, a Prospectus Supplement, if required, will be
distributed which will set forth the aggregate amount and type of Common Stock
being offered and the terms of the offering, including the name or names of any
underwriters, dealers or agents, any discounts, commissions and other terms
constituting compensation from the Selling Holders and any discounts,
commissions or concessions allowed or reallowed or paid to dealers.
    

                                       84

<PAGE>




         To comply with the securities laws of certain jurisdictions, if
applicable, the Common Stock will be offered or sold in such jurisdictions only
through registered or licensed brokers or dealers. In addition, in certain
jurisdictions the Common Stock may not be offered or sold unless they have been
registered or qualified for sale in such jurisdictions or an exemption from
registration or qualification is available and is complied with.

         Under applicable rules and regulations under the Exchange Act, any
person engaged in a distribution of the Common Stock may not simultaneously
engage in market-making activities with respect to such securities for a
restricted period prior to the commencement of such distribution. In addition to
and without limiting the foregoing, each Selling Holder and any other person
participating in a distribution will be subject to applicable provisions of the
Exchange Act and the rules and regulations thereunder, including without
limitation Rules 102, 103 and 104, which provisions may limit the timing of
purchases and sales of any of the securities by the Selling Holders or any such
other person. All of the foregoing may affect the marketability of the Common
Stock and brokers' and dealers' ability to engage in market-making activities
with respect to these securities.

         Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, all expenses of the
registration of the Common Stock will be paid by the Company, including, without
limitation, Commission filing fees and expenses of compliance with state
securities or "blue sky" laws; provided, however, that the Selling Holders will
pay all underwriting discounts and selling commissions, if any. The Selling
Holders will be indemnified by the Company against certain civil liabilities,
including certain liabilities under the Securities Act, or will be entitled to
contribution in connection therewith. The Company will indemnified by the
Selling Holders against certain civil liabilities, including certain liabilities
under the Securities Act, or will be entitled to contribution in connection
therewith.

                         SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
   
         As of August 12, 1998, there were 9,333,333 shares of Common Stock of
the Company outstanding. All shares of Common Stock sold in the Offering will be
freely tradable without restriction or further registration under the Securities
Act, except that any shares purchased by affiliates of the Company, as that term
is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act, may generally only be resold in
compliance with applicable provisions of Rule 144.
    

         In general, under Rule 144, as currently in effect, a person (or
persons whose shares are aggregated) who has beneficially owned restricted
shares for at least one year is entitled to sell, within any three-month period,
a number of such shares that does not exceed the greater of (i) 1% of the then
outstanding shares of Common Stock or (ii) the average weekly trading volume in
the Common Stock during the four calendar weeks preceding the date of the notice
filed pursuant to Rule 144. Sales under Rule 144 are also subject to certain
manner of sale restrictions and notice requirements and to the availability of
current public information about the Company. In addition, a person who is
deemed an "affiliate" of the Company must comply with Rule 144 in any sale of
shares of Common Stock not covered by a registration statement (except, in the
case of registered shares acquired by the affiliate on the open market, for the
holding period requirement). A person (or person whose shares are aggregated)
who is not deemed an "affiliate" of the Company and who has beneficially owned
restricted shares for at least two years is entitled to sell such shares under
Rule 144(k) without regard to the volume, notice and other limitations of Rule
144. In meeting the one and two year holding periods described above, a holder
of restricted shares can include the holding periods of a prior owner who was
not an affiliate.

   
         The Company has reserved 653,333 shares for grants under its existing
Stock Option Plan. As of August 12, 1998, the Company had options outstanding to
purchase up to 620,000 shares of Common Stock. See "Management--Stock Option
Plan." The Company intends to file a registration statement under the Securities
Act to register all shares of Common Stock issuable under such Stock Option
Plan. Shares covered by this registration statement will be eligible for sale in
the public market after the effective date of such registration statement.
    
                                     EXPERTS

         The consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 1997 and 1996 and
the consolidated statements of operations, of stockholders' equity and of cash
flows for the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995 included


                                       85

<PAGE>



in this Prospectus have been so included in reliance on the report of
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, independent accountants, given on the authority of
said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

                                  LEGAL MATTERS

         The validity of the Common Stock will be passed upon for the Company by
Patton Boggs LLP, Washington, D.C., counsel to the Company.

                             ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

         The Company has filed with the SEC a registration statement under the
Securities Act with respect to the Common Stock offered hereby. As permitted by
the rules and regulations of the SEC, this Prospectus does not contain all the
information set forth in the registration statement. Such information can be
examined without charge at the public reference facilities of the SEC located at
450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, and copies of such material can
be obtained from the SEC at prescribed rates. In addition, the SEC maintains a
web site (http://www.sec.gov) that contains reports, proxy and information
statements and other information regarding registrants that file electronically
with the SEC, including the Company. This Prospectus contains a description of
the material terms and features of all material contracts, reports or exhibits
to the Registration Statement required to be described, however, the statements
contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other
document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement are, of necessity,
brief descriptions thereof and are not necessarily complete; each such statement
is qualified by reference to such contract or document.

         In connection with the Offering, the Company will register its Common
Stock with the SEC under Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act and, upon such
registration, the Company and the holders of its stock will become subject to
the proxy solicitation rules, reporting requirements and restrictions on stock
purchases and sales by directors, officers and greater than 10% stockholders,
the annual and periodic reporting and certain other requirements of the Exchange
Act.

         A copy of the Certificate of Incorporation and the Bylaws of the
Company are available without charge from the Company.




                                       86
<PAGE>

                   INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                                         <C>
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of June 30, 1998 and December 31, 1997....................................   F-2
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Six Months Ended June 30, 1998 and 1997....................   F-3
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity for Six Months Ended June 30, 1998............   F-4
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Six Months Ended June 30, 1998 and 1997....................   F-5
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the Six Months Ended June 30, 1998 and 1997...............   F-6
 
Report of Independent Accountants........................................................................   F-18
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1997 and 1996.............................................   F-19
Consolidated Statements of Operations For Years Ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995...................   F-20
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity For Years Ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and
  1995...................................................................................................   F-21
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows For Years Ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995...................   F-22
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements For Years Ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995..............   F-24
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-1
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                      DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                                          1997
                                                                                       JUNE 30,      ---------------
                                                                                         1998
                                                                                      -----------
                                                                                       UNAUDITED
<S>                                                                                   <C>            <C>
                                      ASSETS
Cash and due from banks............................................................   $    15,855      $    13,853
Federal funds sold.................................................................            --           21,000
Investment securities available for sale, at market value..........................        98,614               --
Investment securities, at cost (market value $3,998 at December 1997)..............            --            4,000
Mortgage-backed securities available for sale, at market value.....................       302,942           84,308
Mortgage-backed securities, at cost (market value $168,258 at June 30, 1998 and
  $174,972 at December 31, 1997)...................................................       173,754          181,795
Federal Home Loan Bank stock.......................................................        14,900           13,914
Loans..............................................................................     1,272,151        1,214,237
Allowance for loan losses..........................................................       (13,207)         (12,142)
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
Net loans..........................................................................     1,258,944        1,202,095
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
Accrued interest receivable........................................................        11,515            8,594
Premises and equipment, net........................................................        23,487           23,931
Other assets.......................................................................        10,368            8,160
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
     Total assets..................................................................   $ 1,910,379      $ 1,561,650
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
 
                                    LIABILITIES
Deposits...........................................................................   $ 1,474,270      $ 1,468,987
Federal funds purchased............................................................        96,000               --
Other borrowings...................................................................       202,000               --
Long-term debt to affiliates (including capitalized interest)......................            --           20,060
Accrued interest payable...........................................................         2,513              452
Other liabilities..................................................................         7,487            9,599
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
     Total liabilities.............................................................     1,782,270        1,499,098
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
Guaranteed preferred beneficial interests in junior subordinated debentures........        30,000               --
 
                               STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
Preferred stock, par value $.01, 10,000,000 shares authorized, none outstanding at
  June 30, 1998; none authorized or outstanding at December 31, 1997...............            --               --
Common stock, par value $.01, authorized 25,000,000 shares; 9,333,333 shares issued
  and outstanding at June 30, 1998; par value $0.00167, 18,000,000 shares
  authorized, 6,000,000 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 1997.........            93               10
Additional paid-in capital.........................................................        60,044           30,278
Accumulated other comprehensive income.............................................          (419)          (1,728)
Retained earnings-substantially restricted.........................................        38,391           33,992
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
     Total stockholders' equity....................................................        98,109           62,552
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
     Total liabilities and stockholders' equity....................................   $ 1,910,379      $ 1,561,650
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
                                                                                      -----------    ---------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-2
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AMOUNTS)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                               FOR THE SIX MONTHS
                                                                                                 ENDED JUNE 30,
                                                                                             ----------------------
                                                                                               1998         1997
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
                                                                                                  (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                                          <C>          <C>
Interest income:
  Interest on loans.......................................................................    $47,954      $41,197
  Interest on funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell..............        471        1,081
  Interest on investment and mortgage-backed securities...................................      9,766        9,828
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
     Total interest income................................................................     58,191       52,106
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
Interest expense:
  Interest on deposits....................................................................     31,254       28,999
  Interest on short-term borrowings.......................................................         66          798
  Interest on guaranteed preferred beneficial interests in junior subordinated
     debentures...........................................................................        570           --
  Interest on long-term borrowings........................................................      1,270           --
  Interest on long-term debt to affiliates................................................        599          893
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
     Total interest expense...............................................................     33,759       30,690
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
 
     Net interest income..................................................................     24,432       21,416
Provision for loan losses.................................................................      1,401          132
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
     Net interest income after provision for loan losses..................................     23,031       21,284
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
Noninterest income:
  Commercial banking fees.................................................................        565          429
  Service charges on deposit accounts.....................................................        544          482
  Gain on sale of loans, securities and servicing rights..................................        307         (530)
  Loan servicing income...................................................................        292          526
  Miscellaneous income....................................................................         24          258
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
     Total noninterest income.............................................................      1,732        1,165
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
Noninterest expense:
  Personnel...............................................................................      8,247        7,169
  Occupancy...............................................................................      2,447        2,306
  Data processing.........................................................................      1,180          979
  Furniture and equipment.................................................................      1,170          852
  Deposit insurance.......................................................................        457        1,142
  Communication...........................................................................        201          172
  Professional fees and contracted services...............................................        902          882
  Foreclosed assets expense...............................................................         (3)         393
  Miscellaneous expense...................................................................      2,693        2,050
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
     Total noninterest expense............................................................     17,294       15,945
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
Income before taxes.......................................................................      7,469        6,504
Income tax expense........................................................................      3,070        2,677
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
       Net income.........................................................................    $ 4,399      $ 3,827
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
                                                                                             ---------    ---------
Basic earnings per share..................................................................    $  0.60      $  0.64
Diluted earnings per share................................................................    $  0.56      $  0.55
</TABLE>
    
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-3
<PAGE>
   
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
           CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
                     FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            ACCUMULATED
                                                             ADDITIONAL        OTHER         TOTAL
                                     NUMBER OF     COMMON     PAID-IN      COMPREHENSIVE    RETAINED    STOCKHOLDERS'
                                       SHARES      STOCK      CAPITAL         INCOME        EARNINGS       EQUITY
                                     ----------    ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
<S>                                  <C>           <C>       <C>           <C>              <C>         <C>
Balance at December 31, 1997......    6,000,000     $ 10     $   30,278       $(1,728)      $ 33,992      $  92,830
  Net income......................           --       --             --            --          4,399          4,399
  Change in accumulated other
     comprehensive income, net of
     taxes........................           --       --             --         1,309             --          1,309
  Conversion of long-term debt to
     affiliates to common stock...    1,974,000        3         20,597            --             --         41,253
  Common stock issued.............    9,333,333       93        129,156            --             --        269,156
  Common stock redeemed...........   (7,974,000)     (13)      (119,987)           --             --       (239,987)
                                     ----------    ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
Balance at June 30, 1998..........    9,333,333     $ 93     $   60,044       $  (419)      $ 38,391      $ 168,960
                                     ----------    ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
                                     ----------    ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-4
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                FOR THE SIX MONTHS
                                                                                                  ENDED JUNE 30,
                                                                                               --------------------
                                                                                                 1998        1997
                                                                                               --------    --------
                                                                                                   (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                                            <C>         <C>
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
  Net income................................................................................   $  4,399    $  3,827
    Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating
     activities:
      Amortization of investment and mortgage-backed securities premium.....................        (94)         97
      Amortization of loan discount.........................................................        403         123
      Provision for loan losses.............................................................      1,401         132
      Increase in accrued interest receivable...............................................     (2,921)       (419)
      Depreciation and amortization of premises and equipment...............................      1,323       1,057
      Amortization of servicing assets......................................................         91         250
      (Increase) decrease in other assets...................................................     (3,401)      1,554
      Increase in accrued interest payable..................................................      2,061       1,341
      Decrease in other liabilities.........................................................     (2,113)     (1,190)
      Gain on sale of servicing rights......................................................         --        (214)
      Gain on sale of foreclosed assets.....................................................        (99)       (181)
      (Gain) loss on sale of loans..........................................................       (307)        744
                                                                                               --------    --------
         Net cash provided by operating activities..........................................        743       7,120
                                                                                               --------    --------
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
  Investments and mortgage-backed securities held to maturity:
    Principal payments and maturities.......................................................     11,859      12,601
    Purchases...............................................................................       (612)       (200)
  Investments and mortgage-backed securities, available for sale:
    Principal payments and maturity.........................................................      2,957       8,934
    Purchases...............................................................................   (318,084)         --
    Sales of securities.....................................................................         --          --
    Securities called.......................................................................         --          --
  Net decrease in credit card loans.........................................................        351          38
  Loans purchased...........................................................................       (217)       (797)
  Loans originated net of principal collections.............................................    (62,612)    (38,151)
  Proceeds from sale of loans...............................................................      3,816       4,152
  Purchases of premises and equipment.......................................................       (942)       (424)
  Proceeds from sale of premises and equipment..............................................         63          87
  Proceeds from sale of servicing rights....................................................         --       1,317
  Proceeds from sale of foreclosed assets...................................................        607       2,573
                                                                                               --------    --------
    Net cash used in investing activities...................................................   (362,814)     (9,869)
                                                                                               --------    --------
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
  Net increase in NOW accounts, money market accounts and passbook accounts.................     24,090       7,398
  Net (decrease) increase in time deposits..................................................    (18,807)     63,454
  Net increase in short-term borrowings.....................................................     96,000          --
  Net increase in long-term borrowings......................................................    202,000          --
  Net (decrease) increase in long-term debt to affiliates...................................    (20,060)      1,500
  Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net of redemptions and of issue costs.............     29,850          --
  Proceeds from issuance of guaranteed preferred beneficial interests in subordinated
    debentures, gross.......................................................................     30,000          --
    Net cash provided by financing activities...............................................    343,073      72,352
                                                                                               --------    --------
(Decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents............................................    (18,998)     60,603
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period............................................     34,853      18,394
                                                                                               --------    --------
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period..................................................   $ 15,855    $ 87,997
                                                                                               --------    --------
                                                                                               --------    --------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION
  Cash paid during the period for interest..................................................   $ 31,698    $ 29,349
  Cash paid during the period for income taxes..............................................      2,575         450
 
SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULE OF NONCASH INVESTING AND FINANCING ACTIVITIES
  Receivable resulting from sale of servicing rights........................................         --         146
  Real estate acquired through foreclosure..................................................        392       3,363
</TABLE>
    
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-5
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
1. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING AND REPORTING
POLICIES
 
  Basis of Presentation
 
   
     The Consolidated Balance Sheet as of June 30, 1998 and the Consolidated
Statements of Operations and Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the six
months ended June 30, 1998 and 1997 have been prepared by UCBH Holdings, Inc.
(the Company) and are not audited.
    
 
   
     The unaudited financial statement information presented was prepared on the
same basis as the audited financial statements for the year ended December 31,
1997. In the opinion of management such unaudited financial statements reflect
all adjustments necessary for a fair statement of the results of operations and
balances for the interim periods presented. Such adjustments are of a normal
recurring nature. The results of operations for the six months ended June 30,
1998 are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the full
year.
    
 
     On April 17, 1998, the Company completed a 6,000-for-1 stock split.
Accordingly, the financial statements for all periods presented have been
restated to reflect the impact of the stock split. On April 17, 1998, the
Company's long-term debt to affiliates was converted to 1,974,000 shares of
common stock, as adjusted for the aforementioned stock split. Given the
occurrence of this conversion, management has considered this long-term debt to
affiliates as convertible debt for purposes of its calculation of diluted
earnings per share.
 
  Principles of Consolidation and Presentation
 
   
     The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company
and its wholly owned subsidiaries. There have been no changes in the
subsidiaries of the Company between December 31, 1997 and June 30, 1998. All
significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in
consolidation.
    
 
2. RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS
 
     The provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards ('SFAS') No.
125, 'Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and
Extinguishments of Liabilities,' that were deferred by SFAS No. 127, 'Deferral
of the Effective Date of Certain Provisions of FASB Statement No. 125--An
Amendment of FASB Statement No. 125,' became effective as to repurchase
agreements, dollar rolls, securities lending and certain other transactions
after December 31, 1997. Management does not believe implementation of such
provisions will have a significant effect on the Company's financial position,
results of operations, or capital.
 
     As of December 31, 1997, the Company adopted SFAS No. 128, 'Earnings per
Share,' which specifies the computation, presentation and disclosure
requirements for earnings per share ('EPS'). Basic EPS is computed by dividing
net income by the weighted average number of shares outstanding during the
period. Diluted EPS considers the possible dilutive effect of instruments such
as convertible debt, convertible preferred stock, and stock options. Prior
period EPS has been expanded to comply with the provisions of SFAS No. 128.
 
   
     SFAS No. 130, 'Reporting Comprehensive Income,' is effective for fiscal
years beginning after December 15, 1997. SFAS No. 130 establishes presentation
and disclosure requirements for comprehensive income; however, it does not
affect existing recognition or measurement standards. For the Company,
comprehensive income consists of net income and the change in unrealized gains
and losses on available-for-sale securities. For the six months ended June 30,
1998 and 1997, total comprehensive income was $5.7 million and $3.6 million,
respectively.
    
 
     SFAS No. 131, 'Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related
Information,' is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 1997.
SFAS No. 131 establishes standards for reporting information about operating
segments in annual financial statements and requires reporting of selected
information about operating segments in interim reports issued to shareholders.
It also establishes standards for related disclosures about products and
services, geographic areas, and major customers. SFAS No. 131 does not affect
existing
 
                                      F-6
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
2. RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
recognition or measurement standards. The provisions of SFAS No. 131 need not be
applied to interim financial statements in the initial year of its application.
Accordingly, such disclosures have not been presented herein.
 
   
     SFAS No. 133, 'Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging
Activities' will become effective for fiscal years beginning after June 15,
1999. SFAS 133 defines derivative instruments and requires that they be
recognized as assets or liabilities in the statement of financial position,
measured at fair value. It further specifies the nature of changes in the fair
value of the derivatives which are included in the current period results of
operations and those which are included in other comprehensive income.
Management has not yet quantified the impact that SFAS 133 will have on the
financial statements of the Company, if any.
    
 
   
3. INVESTMENT SECURITIES
    
 
   
     The Company had no investment securities classified as available for sale
at December 31, 1997. The amortized cost and approximate market value of
investment securities classified as available for sale at June 30, 1998 are
shown in the table below (dollars in thousands):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   JUNE 30, 1998
                                                  ------------------------------------------------
                                                                 GROSS         GROSS
                                                  AMORTIZED    UNREALIZED    UNREALIZED    MARKET
                                                    COST         GAINS         LOSSES       VALUE
                                                  ---------    ----------    ----------    -------
<S>                                               <C>          <C>           <C>           <C>
Available for sale
  Trust Preferred Securities...................    $73,935        $735          $ --       $74,670
  Municipals...................................     23,845         113            14        23,944
  Other........................................         --          --            --            --
                                                  ---------    ----------        ---       -------
                                                   $97,780        $848          $ 14       $98,614
                                                  ---------    ----------        ---       -------
                                                  ---------    ----------        ---       -------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
     The amortized cost and approximate value of investment securities
classified as available for sale at June 30, 1998, by contractual maturity are
shown in the table below (dollars in thousands):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             JUNE 30, 1998
                                                                          --------------------
                                                                          AMORTIZED    MARKET
                                                                            COST        VALUE
                                                                          ---------    -------
<S>                                                                       <C>          <C>
Available for sale
  Due after ten years..................................................    $97,780     $98,614
                                                                          ---------    -------
                                                                           $97,780     $98,614
                                                                          ---------    -------
                                                                          ---------    -------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-7
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
4. MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES
    
 
   
     The amortized cost and approximate market value of mortgage-backed
securities classified as held to maturity and available for sale at June 30,
1998 and December 31, 1997 are shown in the table below (dollars in thousands):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  JUNE 30, 1998
                                                -------------------------------------------------
                                                               GROSS         GROSS
                                                AMORTIZED    UNREALIZED    UNREALIZED     MARKET
                                                  COST         GAINS         LOSSES       VALUE
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
<S>                                             <C>          <C>           <C>           <C>
Held to maturity
     FHLMC...................................   $  45,935       $ --         $1,556      $ 44,379
     FNMA....................................     113,859         --          3,541       110,318
     Other...................................      13,960         --            399        13,561
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
                                                $ 173,754       $ --         $5,496      $168,258
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
Available for sale
     FNMA....................................   $  84,602       $ 37         $2,271      $ 82,368
     GNMA....................................     120,202        572             --       120,774
     Other...................................      99,682        118             --        99,800
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
                                                $ 304,486       $727         $2,271      $302,942
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                      1997
                                                -------------------------------------------------
                                                               GROSS         GROSS
                                                AMORTIZED    UNREALIZED    UNREALIZED     MARKET
                                                  COST         GAINS         LOSSES       VALUE
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
<S>                                             <C>          <C>           <C>           <C>
Held to maturity
     FHLMC...................................   $  48,536        $--         $1,918      $ 46,618
     FNMA....................................     117,184        --           4,396       112,788
     Other...................................      16,075        --             509        15,566
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                $ 181,795        $--         $6,823      $174,972
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
Available for sale
     FNMA....................................   $  87,237        $--         $2,929      $ 84,308
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
     Approximately $246.5 million and $45.6 million of mortgage-backed
securities have been pledged to secure contractual arrangements entered into by
the Company at June 30, 1998 and December 31, 1997, respectively.
    
 
   
     There were no sales of available for sale securities during the six months
ended June 30, 1998. Proceeds from the sale of available for sale securities
during 1997 totaled $23.4 million.
    
 
   
     Mortgage-backed securities sold under agreements to repurchase as of June
30, 1998 and December 31, 1997 were (dollars in millions):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         JUNE 30,      DECEMBER 31,
                                                           1998            1997
                                                         --------      ------------
<S>                                                       <C>           <C>
Book value..............................................  $  --         $  --
Market value............................................     --            --
Obligations.............................................     --            --
Weighted average interest rate at end of period.........     --            --
Weighted average interest rate during the period........   5.79%         5.47%
Average balance during the period.......................   95.0           5.3
Maximum amount outstanding at any month end during the
  year..................................................     --            --
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-8
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
4. MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES--(CONTINUED)
    
   
     When the Company enters into these transactions, the obligations generally
mature within one year and generally represent agreements to repurchase the same
securities.
    
 
   
     As of June 30, 1998 and December 31, 1997, remaining maturities on
mortgage-backed securities classified as held to maturity and available for sale
were as follows (dollars in thousands):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    JUNE 30, 1998          DECEMBER 31, 1997
                                                ---------------------    ---------------------
                                                AMORTIZED     MARKET     AMORTIZED     MARKET
                                                  COST        VALUE        COST        VALUE
                                                ---------    --------    ---------    --------
<S>                                             <C>          <C>         <C>          <C>
Held to maturity
     In one year or less.....................   $      --    $     --    $   1,413    $  1,406
     After one year through five years.......          --          --           --          --
     After five years through ten years......       2,343       2,299        2,961       2,881
     After ten years.........................     171,411     165,959      177,421     170,685
                                                ---------    --------    ---------    --------
                                                $ 173,754    $168,258    $ 181,795    $174,972
                                                ---------    --------    ---------    --------
                                                ---------    --------    ---------    --------
Available for sale
     After ten years.........................   $ 304,486    $302,942    $  87,237    $ 84,308
                                                ---------    --------    ---------    --------
                                                ---------    --------    ---------    --------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
5. BORROWINGS
    
 
   
     The Company maintains a secured credit facility with the Federal Home Loan
Bank of San Francisco ('FHLB-SF') against which the Company may take advances.
The terms of this credit facility require the Company to maintain in safekeeping
with the FHLB-SF eligible collateral of at least 100% of outstanding advances.
    
 
   
     At June 30, 1998, the Company had a total of $298 million of outstanding
advances, of which $96 million were short-term and $202 million were long-term.
The advances were secured with mortgage-backed securities. The fixed rate
long-term debt of $202 million matures in 2008. The weighted average contractual
maturity as of June 30, 1998 was seven years. Included in the long-term debt as
of June 30, 1998 were $185 million of advances with provisions which allow the
FHLB-SF, at their option, to terminate the advances at quarterly intervals at
specified periods ranging from three to five years beyond the advance dates. For
the six months ended June 30, 1998, the following advances were outstanding:
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                  <C>
Average outstanding advances during the period....................................   $ 46,927
Maximum advances outstanding at any month end during the period...................   $298,000
</TABLE>
    
 
   
     The interest rate on this debt ranged from 5.30% to 6.03% and the weighted
average interest rate was 5.64% at June 30, 1998 and 5.49% for the six months
then ended. Interest is paid quarterly on substantially all of these advances
and principal is due at maturity. The interest expense on such advances was
$1,336,000 for the six months ended June 30, 1998.
    
 
   
     At June 30, 1998, the unused credit available under this facility was
approximately $64 million.
    
 
   
6. LONG-TERM DEBT TO AFFILIATES
    
 
   
     Included in the liabilities of the Company as of December 31, 1997, is
long-term debt payable to affiliates in the aggregate amount of $20,060,000.
Such debt was comprised of two promissory notes with interest rates of 10%. In
conjunction with the Private Offerings which closed on April 17, 1998, such
notes were exchanged for shares of Common Stock of the Company. Subsequently,
the Company redeemed all of the stock owned by affiliates with the proceeds
raised in the Private Offerings. The Selling Shareholders are no longer
affiliated with the Company.
    
 
                                      F-9
<PAGE>


                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
7. GUARANTEED PREFERRED BENEFICIAL INTERESTS IN COMPANY'S JUNIOR SUBORDINATED
   DEBENTURES
    
 
   
     On April 17, 1998, UCBH Trust Co. (the 'Trust'), a Delaware statutory
business trust owned by the Company, issued $30 million of 9.375% Guaranteed
Preferred Beneficial Interest in the Company's Subordinated Debentures ('Capital
Securities'). The Trust exists for the sole purpose of issuing the Capital
Securities and investing the proceeds thereof in 9.375% Junior Subordinated
Debentures issued by the Company. The Junior Subordinated Debentures mature on
May 1, 2028. Payment of distributions out of the monies held by the Trust and
payments on liquidation of the Trust or the redemption of the Capital Securities
are guaranteed by the Company to the extent the Trust has funds available
therefore. The obligations of the Company under the Guarantee and the Junior
Subordinated Debentures are subordinate and junior in right of payment to all
indebtedness of the Company and will be structurally subordinated to all
liabilities and obligations of the Company's subsidiaries. Distributions on the
Capital Securities are payable semi-annually in arrears on May 1 and November 1
of each year, commencing November 1, 1998. The Junior Subordinated Debentures
are not redeemable prior to May 1, 2005, unless certain events have occurred.
The proceeds from the issuance of the Capital Securities were used primarily to
provide additional capital for the Bank.
    
 
   
     Interest expense on the Capital Securities was $570,000 for the six months
ended June 30, 1998.
    
 
   
8. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
    
 
   
     The Company and United Commercial Bank (the Bank) are subject to various
regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking agencies.
Under these capital requirements, the Bank must meet specific minimum capital
requirements (described below) that involve quantitative measures of the Bank's
assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under
regulatory accounting practices. The Bank's capital amounts and classification
are also subject to qualitative judgements by the regulators about components,
risk weightings, and other factors.
    
 
   
     Specifically, current federal capital regulations require the Bank to
maintain minimum ratios (set forth in the table below) of total and Tier I
capital to risk-weighted assets (as defined). Tier I capital is defined as
common equity, retained earnings and qualifying perpetual preferred stock, less
certain intangibles. The remainder of capital may consist of certain
subordinated debt, certain hybrid capital instruments and other qualifying
preferred stock, and a limited amount of loan loss allowance. Each of the
federal banking agencies also has established minimum leverage capital
requirements. In addition, under the prompt corrective action provisions of
federal law, financial institutions are categorized as 'well capitalized,'
'adequately capitalized,' 'undercapitalized,' or 'critically undercapitalized,'
depending on their capital level. 'Well capitalized' banks are defined as
institutions that have a total risk-based capital ratio of 10%, a Tier I
risk-based capital ratio of 6%, and a leverage ratio of 5%. An 'adequately
capitalized' bank is defined as an institution with a total risk-based capital
ratio of 8%, a Tier I risk-based capital ratio of 4% and a leverage ratio of 4%.
If the Bank were to fail to meet the minimum capital requirements and/or were to
fall within the 'undercapitalized' or 'critically undercapitalized' categories
of the prompt corrective action provisions could cause the regulators to
initiate certain mandatory-- and possibly additional discretionary--actions
that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Bank and on the
Company's financial statements.
    
 
   
     As of December 31, 1997, the most recent notification from the Office of
Thrift Supervision (the former regulator of the Bank) categorized the Bank as
'well capitalized' under the prompt corrective action provisions. There are no
conditions or events since that notification that management believes have
changed the institution's category. As of December 31, 1996, the Office of
Thrift Supervision categorized the Bank as 'adequately capitalized' under the
regulatory framework for prompt corrective action.
    
 

<PAGE>


   
     The Company converted from a unitary savings and loan holding company to a
bank holding company under Section 3(a)(1) of the Bank Holding Company Act of
1956 effective on July 31, 1998. The Bank simultaneously converted from a
federally chartered savings bank to a state chartered non-member commercial
bank.
    

 
                                      F-10
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
8. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY--(CONTINUED)
    
   
     As a result of the conversion, the Company's primary regulator is now the
Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System ('Federal Reserve'). Under the
Federal Reserve's capital adequacy guidelines for bank holding companies, the
minimum standard of total capital to risk-weighted assets is 8%; and the minimum
standards of Tier I capital to risk-weighted assets is 4%. The Federal Reserve
also requires bank holding companies to maintain a minimum leverage ratio of
Tier I capital to adjusted average quarterly assets equal to 3%, if such
companies meet certain specified criteria, including that they have the highest
regulatory rating. All other bank holding companies generally are required to
maintain a leverage ratio of at least 100 to 200 basis points above the stated
minimum.
    
 
   
     The Bank's primary federal regulator now is the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation (FDIC). The FDIC has adopted minimum risk-based and leverage capital
ratio regulations at 12 CFR 325 that are substantially similar to those
requirements imposed by the Federal Reserve on bank holding companies described
above.
    
 
   
     The Company's and the Bank's actual capital amounts and ratios are also
presented in the following table (dollars in thousands):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                        TO BE WELL
                                                                                                    CAPITALIZED UNDER
                                                                        FOR CAPITAL                 PROMPT CORRECTIVE
                                              ACTUAL                 ADEQUACY PURPOSES              ACTION PROVISIONS
                                          ---------------          ---------------------          ----------------------
                                           AMOUNT   RATIO          AMOUNT          RATIO           AMOUNT          RATIO
                                          --------  -----          -------         -----          --------         -----
<S>                                       <C>       <C>            <C>             <C>            <C>              <C>
As of June 30, 1998:
Total Capital (to risk weighted assets)
  United Commercial Bank...............   $137,729  13.61%         $80,985         8.00 %
  UCBH Holdings, Inc. .................    140,901  13.90           81,115         8.00           $101,393         10.00%
Tier I Capital (to risk weighted
  assets)
  United Commercial Bank...............   $125,068  12.35%         $40,492         4.00 %
  UCBH Holdings, Inc. .................    128,220  12.65           40,557         4.00           $ 60,836          6.00%
Tier I Capital (to average assets)
  (Leverage Ratio)
  United Commercial Bank...............   $125,068   7.47%         $67,009         4.00 %
  UCBH Holdings, Inc. .................    128,220   7.64           67,109         4.00           $ 83,887          5.00%
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-11
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
8. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY--(CONTINUED)
    
   
     The following is a reconciliation of capital under Generally Accepted
Accounting Principles ('GAAP') with regulatory capital at June 30, 1998 (dollars
in thousands):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 TIER I CAPITAL                     RISK-BASED CAPITAL
                                        ---------------------------------    ---------------------------------
                                            UNITED              UCBH             UNITED              UCBH
                                        COMMERCIAL BANK    HOLDINGS, INC.    COMMERCIAL BANK    HOLDINGS, INC.
                                        ---------------    --------------    ---------------    --------------
<S>                                     <C>                <C>               <C>                <C>
GAAP Capital.........................      $ 124,957          $ 98,109          $ 124,957          $ 98,109
Nonallowable components:
  Unrealized losses on securities
     available for sale..............            419               419                419               419
  Goodwill...........................           (301)             (301)              (301)             (301)
  Mortgage servicing rights--
     excess..........................             (7)               (7)                (7)               (7)
Additional capital components:
  Guaranteed preferred beneficial
     interests in junior subordinated
     debentures......................                           30,000                               30,000
  Allowance for loan losses--
     limited.........................                                              12,662            12,662
                                        ---------------    --------------    ---------------    --------------
Regulatory capital...................      $ 125,068          $128,220          $ 137,730          $140,882
                                        ---------------    --------------    ---------------    --------------
                                        ---------------    --------------    ---------------    --------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
     On March 31, 1998, the Company entered into an Exchange and Redemption
Agreement ('Agreement') with its Selling Stockholders. In conjunction with the
Private Offerings and pursuant to the terms of the Agreement, the $20,600,000 of
Long-term Debt to Affiliates, which was payable to the Selling Stockholders, was
exchanged for shares of Common Stock. Subsequently, the Company used
approximately $120,000,000 of the proceeds raised by the Private Offerings to
redeem all of the shares of Common Stock then owned by the Selling Shareholders,
which included the shares of Common Stock exchanged for the notes. As a result,
the Selling Shareholders are no longer affiliated with the Company.
    
 
                                      F-12
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
9. EARNINGS PER SHARE
    
 
   
     The following is a reconciliation of the numerators and denominator of the
basic and diluted earnings per share (Dollars in thousands, except for per share
data):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998
                                                                            -----------------------------------------
                                                                              INCOME          SHARES        PER SHARE
                                                                            (NUMERATOR)    (DENOMINATOR)     AMOUNT
                                                                            -----------    -------------    ---------
<S>                                                                         <C>            <C>              <C>
Basic:
  Net income.............................................................     $ 4,399        7,370,370        $0.60
Effect of long-term debt to affiliates...................................         353        1,162,467
                                                                            -----------    -------------
Diluted:
  Net income and assumed conversion......................................     $ 4,752        8,532,837        $0.56
                                                                            -----------    -------------
                                                                            -----------    -------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1997
                                                                            -----------------------------------------
                                                                              INCOME          SHARES        PER SHARE
                                                                            (NUMERATOR)    (DENOMINATOR)     AMOUNT
                                                                            -----------    -------------    ---------
<S>                                                                         <C>            <C>              <C>
Basic:
  Net income.............................................................     $ 3,827        6,000,000        $0.64
Effect of long-term debt to affiliates...................................         527        1,974,000
                                                                            -----------    -------------
Diluted:
  Net income and assumed conversion......................................     $ 4,354        7,974,000        $0.55
                                                                            -----------    -------------
                                                                            -----------    -------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
10. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-BALANCE
    SHEET RISK
    
 
   
     The Company is a party to derivative financial instruments and financial
instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet
the financing needs of its customers and to reduce its own exposure to
fluctuations in interest rates. The Company does not hold or issue financial
instruments for trading purposes. Financial instruments in the normal course of
business include commitments to extend and purchase credit, forward commitments
to sell loans, long put and call options, letters of credit and interest-rate
swaps and caps. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of
credit and interest-rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in the
statement of financial position. The contract or notional amounts of those
instruments reflects the extent of involvement the Company has in particular
classes of financial instruments.
    
 
   
     The Company's exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the
other party to the financial instrument for commitments to extend credit is
represented by the contractual or notional amount of those instruments. The
Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional
obligations as it does for on-balance-sheet instruments. For interest-rate swap
and cap transactions and forward commitments to sell loans, the contract or
notional amounts do not represent exposure to credit loss. The Company controls
the credit risk of its interest-rate swap and cap agreements and forward
commitments to sell loans through credit approvals, limits, and monitoring
procedures. The Company does not require collateral or other security to support
interest-rate swap transactions with credit risk.
    
 
                                      F-13
<PAGE>
   
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
10. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-BALANCE
SHEET RISK
    --(CONTINUED)
    
 
   
     Contract or notional amounts of derivative financial instruments and
financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk as of June 30, 1998 and
December 31, 1997 are as follows (dollars in millions):
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   JUNE 30, 1998    DECEMBER 31, 1997
                                                                                   -------------    -----------------
<S>                                                                                <C>              <C>
Financial instruments whose contract amounts represent credit risk:
  Commitments to extend credit:
     Consumer...................................................................       $67.6              $65.0
     Commercial (excluding construction)........................................        24.3               10.8
     Construction...............................................................       105.0               78.7
  Commitments to purchase loans.................................................        25.0                0.1
  Commitments to purchase investment securities.................................        18.5
  Letters of credit.............................................................         3.3                1.9
Financial instruments whose notional or contract amounts exceed the amount of
  credit risk:
  Interest-rate swap and cap agreements.........................................       200.0                 --
  Forward commitments to sell loans.............................................          --                3.5
</TABLE>
    
 
   
     Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long
as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract.
Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses.
The Company evaluates each customer's credit worthiness on a case-by-case basis.
The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the Company upon
extension of credit, is based on management's credit evaluation of the
counterparty. Collateral held generally includes residential or commercial real
estate, accounts receivable, or other assets.
    
 
   
     Commitments to purchase loans are agreements to buy loans from a primary
broker/dealer as long as there are no violations of any condition established in
the contract. Commitments terminate on the final closing date mutually agreed
upon by the purchaser and seller as defined in the contract. The Company
evaluates each loan's worthiness on a loan-by-loan basis. Each loan is
collateralized by residential real estate.
    
 
   
     Letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Company to
guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. The credit risk
involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved
in extending loan facilities to customers. These letters of credit are usually
secured by inventories or by deposits held at the Company.
    
 
   
     Interest rate swap transactions generally involve the exchange of fixed-
and floating-rate interest payment obligations without the exchange of the
underlying principal amounts. Interest-rate swaps are entered into to reduce the
Company's exposure to interest rate movements and are used as part of
asset/liability management. The Company typically becomes a principal in the
exchange of fixed- and floating-rate interest payment obligations with another
party and, therefore, is exposed to loss if the other party defaults. The
Company minimizes this risk by performing normal credit reviews on its swap
counterparties.
    
 
   
     Interest rate caps are interest rate protection instruments that involve
the payment from the seller to the buyer of an interest differential. This
differential represents the difference between current interest rates and
agreed-upon rate applied to a notional principal amount. The Company is a
purchaser of interest rate caps.
    
 
   
     Entering into interest-rate swap agreements involves not only the risk of
dealing with counterparties and their ability to meet the terms of the
contracts, but also the interest-rate risk associated with unmatched positions.
Notional principal amounts often are used to express the volume of these
transactions, but the amounts potentially subject to credit risk are much
smaller.
    
 
   
     Forward contracts are contracts for delayed delivery of securities or loans
in which the seller agrees to make delivery at a specified future date of a
specified instrument at a specified price or yield. Risks arise from the
    
 
                                      F-14
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
10. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-BALANCE
    SHEET RISK
    
    --(CONTINUED)
   
possible inability of counterparties to meet the terms of their contracts and
from movements in security values and interest rates.
    
 
   
     In order to minimize the exposure arising from forward contracts, the
Company enters into hedge options from time to time. At June 30, 1998 the
Company had LIBOR-based interest rate caps with a notional amount of $200
million outstanding. At December 31, 1997, the Company had long put options
amounting to $1 million and long call options of $600,000.
    
 
   
     For the six months ended June 30, 1998 and the six months ended June 30,
1997, the Company incurred costs associated with interest rate swaps and caps of
$50,000 and $65,000, respectively.
    
 
   
11. PARENT COMPANY
    
 
   
     Condensed unconsolidated financial information of UCBH Holdings, Inc. is
presented below.
    
 
   
                            CONDENSED BALANCE SHEET
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          JUNE 30,       DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                            1998             1997
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
<S>                                                                                     <C>              <C>
                                       ASSETS
Cash and due from banks..............................................................     $   1,899        $     56
Investment in subsidiary.............................................................       124,957          82,556
Other assets.........................................................................         1,823              --
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
     Total assets....................................................................     $ 128,679        $ 82,612
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
 
                                     LIABILITIES
Accrued interest payable.............................................................           570        $     --
Long-term debt to affiliates.........................................................            --          20,060
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
     Total liabilities...............................................................           570          20,060
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
Guaranteed preferred beneficial interests in junior subordinated debentures..........        30,000              --
 
                                STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
Common stock.........................................................................            93              10
Additional paid-in capital...........................................................        60,044          30,278
Accumulated other comprehensive income...............................................          (419)         (1,728)
Retained earnings....................................................................        38,391          33,992
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
     Total stockholders' equity......................................................        98,109          62,552
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
     Total liabilities and stockholders' equity......................................     $ 128,679        $ 82,612
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
                                                                                        -------------    ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-15
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
11. PARENT COMPANY--(CONTINUED)
    
   
                         CONDENSED STATEMENT OF INCOME
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   FOR THE             FOR THE
                                                                               SIX MONTHS ENDED    SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                                                   JUNE 30,            JUNE 30,
                                                                                     1998                1997
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
<S>                                                                            <C>                 <C>
                                   INCOME
Interest income.............................................................        $    8             $     --
                                                                                   -------             --------
     Total income...........................................................             8                   --
                                                                                   -------             --------
                                  EXPENSE
Interest expense on guaranteed preferred beneficial interests in junior
  subordinated debentures...................................................           570                   --
Interest expense on long-term debt to affiliates............................           596                  893
Miscellaneous expense.......................................................            64                   --
                                                                                   -------             --------
     Total expense..........................................................         1,230                  893
                                                                                   -------             --------
Loss before taxes and equity in undistributed net income of subsidiary......        (1,222)                (893)
Income tax benefit..........................................................           279                   --
Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiary............................         5,342                4,720
                                                                                   -------             --------
     Net income.............................................................        $4,399             $  3,827
                                                                                   -------             --------
                                                                                   -------             --------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
                       CONDENSED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   FOR THE             FOR THE
                                                                               SIX MONTHS ENDED    SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                                                   JUNE 30,            JUNE 30,
                                                                                     1998                1997
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
<S>                                                                            <C>                 <C>
                            OPERATING ACTIVITIES
Net income..................................................................       $  4,399            $  3,827
  Adjustment to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used for)
     operating activities:
     Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiary.......................         (5,342)             (4,720)
     Increase in other assets...............................................         (1,823)                 --
     Increase in accrued interest payable...................................            570                 893
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
       Net cash used in operating activities................................         (2,196)                 --
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
                            INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Capital contribution to subsidiary..........................................        (35,750)             (1,500)
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
     Net cash used in investing activities..................................        (35,750)             (1,500)
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
                            FINANCING ACTIVITIES
Proceeds from issuance of guaranteed preferred beneficial interests in
  Company's subordinated debentures, gross..................................         30,000                  --
Long-term debt to affiliates issued.........................................             --               1,500
Long-term debt to affiliates repaid.........................................        (20,060)                 --
Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net.................................         29,849                  --
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
     Net cash provided by financing activities..............................         39,789               1,500
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents...................................          1,843                  --
Cash and cash equivalents beginning of period...............................             56                  11
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
Cash and cash equivalents end of period.....................................       $  1,899            $     11
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
                                                                               ----------------    ----------------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-16
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
   
12. SUBSEQUENT EVENT
    
 
   
     On July 31, 1998, the Bank converted its charter to a California-chartered
commercial bank and the Company to a bank holding company. The Company, as a
bank holding company, is subject to examination and regulation by the Federal
Reserve Bank. The Bank, as a state-chartered commercial bank is subject to
comprehensive regulation and examination by the California Department of
Financial Institutions ('DFI'), as its primary regulator, and by the FDIC, which
administers the SAIF, which insures the Bank's deposits to the maximum extent
permitted by law.
    
 
                                      F-17
<PAGE>
                       REPORT OF INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS
 
To the Board of Directors and
Stockholders of UCBH Holdings, Inc.
 
     In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the
related consolidated statements of operations and of changes in stockholders'
equity and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial
position of UCBH Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries at December 31, 1997 and
1996, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the three
years in the period ended December 31, 1997, in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles. These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management; our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our
audits of these statements in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards which require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable
assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the
accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and
evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our
audits provide a reasonable basis for the opinion expressed above.
 
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
San Francisco, California
March 30, 1998, except for paragraph 3 of Note 1,
as to which the date is June 26, 1998
 
                                      F-18
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                               DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                         ------------------------
                                                                                            1997          1996
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
<S>                                                                                      <C>           <C>
                                        ASSETS
Cash and due from banks...............................................................   $   13,853    $   16,044
Federal funds sold....................................................................       21,000         2,350
Investment securities, at cost (market value $3,998 in 1997 and $15,617 in 1996)......        4,000        15,670
Mortgage-backed securities available for sale, at market value........................       84,308       119,514
Mortgage-backed securities, at cost (market value $174,972 in 1997 and $199,483 in
  1996)...............................................................................      181,795       208,555
Federal Home Loan Bank stock..........................................................       13,914        13,082
Loans.................................................................................    1,214,237     1,066,368
Allowance for loan losses.............................................................      (12,142)      (11,682)
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
Net loans.............................................................................    1,202,095     1,054,686
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
Accrued interest receivable...........................................................        8,594         8,002
Premises and equipment, net...........................................................       23,931        22,839
Other assets..........................................................................        8,160        13,875
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
     Total assets.....................................................................   $1,561,650    $1,474,617
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
 
                                     LIABILITIES
Deposits..............................................................................   $1,468,987    $1,393,125
Accrued interest payable..............................................................          452           500
Long-term debt to affiliates (including capitalized interest).........................       20,060        16,736
Other liabilities.....................................................................        9,599         9,912
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
     Total liabilities................................................................    1,499,098     1,420,273
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
Commitments and contingent liabilities
 
                                 STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
Common stock, par value $0.00167 authorized 18,000,000 shares; 6,000,000 shares issued
  and outstanding.....................................................................           10            10
Additional paid-in capital............................................................       30,278        30,278
Unrealized loss on mortgage-backed securities available for sale......................       (1,728)       (2,637)
Retained earnings-substantially restricted............................................       33,992        26,693
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
     Total stockholders' equity.......................................................       62,552        54,344
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
     Total liabilities and stockholders' equity.......................................   $1,561,650    $1,474,617
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
                                                                                         ----------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-19
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        FOR THE YEARS ENDED
                                                                                           DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                  -------------------------------
                                                                                    1997        1996       1995
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
<S>                                                                               <C>         <C>         <C>
Interest income:
  Interest on loans............................................................   $ 86,141    $ 78,711    $72,742
  Interest on funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell...      2,760       1,417        398
  Interest on investment and mortgage-backed securities........................     18,690      22,836     25,894
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
     Total interest income.....................................................    107,591     102,964     99,034
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
Interest expense:
  Interest on deposits.........................................................     61,513      59,273     56,038
  Interest on short-term borrowings............................................        294         998      6,550
  Interest on Federal Home Loan Bank advances..................................        620       2,044      5,867
  Interest on long-term debt to affiliates.....................................      1,825       1,640      1,741
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
     Total interest expense....................................................     64,252      63,955     70,196
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
     Net interest income.......................................................     43,339      39,009     28,838
Provision for loan losses......................................................      1,154       1,476      8,777
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
     Net interest income after provision for loan losses.......................     42,185      37,533     20,061
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
Noninterest income:
  Commercial banking fees......................................................        977         421         92
  Service charges on deposit accounts..........................................        888         615        566
  Gain on sale of loans, securities and servicing rights.......................        155       1,200      1,137
  Loan servicing income........................................................        601         680        272
  Miscellaneous income.........................................................        473         481      1,700
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
     Total noninterest income..................................................      3,094       3,397      3,767
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
Noninterest expense:
  Personnel....................................................................     14,087      14,875     12,000
  Occupancy....................................................................      4,811       4,754      4,355
  Data processing..............................................................      2,059       1,859      1,696
  Furniture and equipment......................................................      1,902       1,814      1,357
  Deposit insurance............................................................      1,798       3,519      3,051
  SAIF recapitalization assessment.............................................         --       7,716         --
  Communication................................................................        400         383        317
  Professional fees and contracted services....................................      2,242       1,551      1,303
  Foreclosed assets expense....................................................        671         686      2,785
  Miscellaneous expense........................................................      4,220       4,256      3,278
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
     Total noninterest expense.................................................     32,190      41,413     30,142
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
Income (loss) before taxes.....................................................     13,089        (483)    (6,314)
Income tax expense (benefit)...................................................      5,790        (177)    (3,406)
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
       Net income (loss).......................................................   $  7,299    $   (306)   $(2,908)
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
Basic earnings (loss) per share................................................   $   1.22    $  (0.05)   $ (0.48)
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
Diluted earnings (loss) per share..............................................   $   1.05    $  (0.05)   $ (0.48)
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
                                                                                  --------    --------    -------
</TABLE>
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-20
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
           CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
              FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997, 1996 AND 1995
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               UNREALIZED
                                                                               GAIN (LOSS)
                                                                ADDITIONAL    ON SECURITIES     TOTAL
                                                      COMMON     PAID-IN        AVAILABLE      RETAINED    STOCKHOLDERS'
                                                      STOCK      CAPITAL        FOR SALE       EARNINGS       EQUITY
                                                      ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
<S>                                                   <C>       <C>           <C>              <C>         <C>
Balance at December 31, 1994.......................    $ 10      $ 30,278        $  (845)      $ 29,907       $59,350
  Net loss.........................................                                              (2,908)       (2,908)
  Change in unrealized net loss on securities
     available for sale, after applicable taxes....                                 (985)                        (985)
                                                      ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
Balance at December 31, 1995.......................      10        30,278         (1,830)        26,999        55,457
  Net loss.........................................                                                (306)         (306)
  Change in unrealized net loss on securities
     available for sale, after applicable taxes....                                 (807)                        (807)
                                                      ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
Balance at December 31, 1996.......................      10        30,278         (2,637)        26,693        54,344
  Net income.......................................                                               7,299         7,299
  Change in unrealized net loss on securities
     available for sale, after applicable taxes....                                  909                          909
                                                      ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
Balance at December 31, 1997.......................    $ 10      $ 30,278        $(1,728)      $ 33,992       $62,552
                                                      ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
                                                      ------    ----------    -------------    --------    -------------
</TABLE>
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-21
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         FOR THE YEARS ENDED
                                                                                            DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                 -----------------------------------
                                                                                   1997         1996         1995
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
<S>                                                                              <C>          <C>          <C>
Operating activities
  Net income (loss)...........................................................   $   7,299    $    (306)   $  (2,908)
    Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used for)
      operating activities:
      Amortization of investment and mortgage-backed securities premium.......         138          193          762
      Amortization of loan discount...........................................          66           76         (571)
      Provision for loan losses...............................................       1,154        1,476        8,777
      Decrease (increase) in accrued interest receivable......................        (592)       1,140       (1,038)
      Depreciation and amortization of premises and equipment.................       2,254        1,981        1,576
      Amortization of servicing rights........................................        (590)         849        1,527
      Decrease in other assets................................................       2,808        1,439        3,426
      Decrease in accrued interest payable....................................         (49)        (663)        (186)
      Increase (decrease) in other liabilities................................        (313)         133       (2,967)
      Gain on sale of servicing rights........................................      (1,165)        (672)        (755)
      Gain on sale of foreclosed assets.......................................        (401)        (602)        (684)
      Loss on sale of loans...................................................         204           --           28
      Gain on branch sale.....................................................          --           --         (656)
      Loss on sale of securities..............................................         806          335           --
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
         Net cash provided by operating activities............................      11,619        5,379        6,331
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
Investing activities
  Investments and mortgage-backed securities held to maturity:
    Principal payments and maturities and securities called...................      37,980       56,095       33,899
    Purchases.................................................................        (200)         (80)         (75)
  Investments and mortgage-backed securities, available for sale:
    Principal payments and maturities and securities called...................      12,124       18,217        1,373
    Sale of securities........................................................      23,495        8,800           --
  Net increase in credit card loans...........................................         (39)        (131)      (1,121)
  Loans purchased.............................................................     (44,416)      (7,643)     (16,677)
  Loans originated net of principal collections...............................    (151,334)     (41,217)     (49,698)
  Proceeds from sale of loans.................................................      43,350          478        8,384
  Purchases of premises and equipment.........................................      (3,453)      (2,540)      (2,035)
  Proceeds from sale of premises and equipment................................         106           61           74
  Proceeds from sale of servicing rights......................................       3,760          672          227
  Proceeds from sale of foreclosed assets.....................................       4,280        4,532        6,766
  Proceeds from sale of branch deposits.......................................          --           --      (28,770)
  Purchase of branch deposits.................................................          --           --       10,582
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
    Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities.......................     (74,347)      37,244      (37,071)
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
Financing activities
  Net increase (decrease) in NOW accounts, money market accounts and passbook
    accounts..................................................................         (90)      14,719      (51,794)
  Net increase in time deposits...............................................      75,952       66,802      213,993
  Net decrease in short-term borrowings.......................................          --     (128,600)    (136,741)
  Increase (decrease) in long-term debt to affiliates.........................       1,500           --         (500)
  Increase in capitalized interest component of long-term debt to
    affiliates................................................................       1,825        1,640           --
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
    Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities.......................      79,187      (45,439)      24,958
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents..............................      16,459       (2,816)      (5,782)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year................................      18,394       21,210       26,992
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year......................................   $  34,853    $  18,394    $  21,210
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
                                                                                 ---------    ---------    ---------
</TABLE>
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-22
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
               CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS--(CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        FOR THE YEARS ENDED
                                                                                            DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                   ------------------------------
                                                                                    1997       1996        1995
                                                                                   -------    -------    --------
<S>                                                                                <C>        <C>        <C>
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information
  Cash paid during the year for interest........................................   $62,475    $62,978    $ 70,098
  Cash paid during the year for income taxes....................................     4,083        832         495
 
Supplemental schedule of noncash investing and financing activities
  Receivable resulting from sale of servicing rights............................   $   371    $    --    $    528
  Real estate acquired through foreclosure......................................     4,260      4,443       5,373
  Securities transferred to available for sale securities.......................        --         --     125,987
  Long-term debt resulting from refinance of long-term debt to affiliates and
     related accrued interest...................................................        --     15,048          --
</TABLE>
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-23
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
1. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING AND REPORTING
POLICIES
 
  Organization
 
     UCBH Holdings, Inc. (the Company), is a savings institution holding company
that conducts its business through its principal subsidiary, United Commercial
Bank (United), a federally chartered savings bank based in California. Through
December 31, 1997, United was known as United Savings Bank, F.S.B. and through
March 30, 1998, the Company was known as USB Holdings, Inc. The Company is a
wholly-owned subsidiary of Chief Investments, Ltd.
 
  Principles of Consolidation and Presentation
 
     The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company
and its wholly owned subsidiaries. The Company's business consists primarily of
attracting retail deposits from consumers and business customers and originating
loans. The Company originates loans secured by mortgages on residential real
estate and loans secured by commercial real estate, including multi-family
housing, mixed use properties, retail and other commercial uses. The Company
also offers commercial loans and lines of credit, trade finance lines and other
commercial loans, as well as a variety of consumer loan products. The Company
also provides a variety of fee-generating services to both commercial customers
and consumers. Substantially all loans are originated for portfolio and held for
investment. All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been
eliminated in consolidation. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior
years' consolidated financial statements to conform to the December 31, 1997
presentation.
 
     On April 17, 1998, the Company completed a 6,000-for-1 stock split.
Accordingly, the financial statements for all years presented have been restated
to reflect the impact of the stock split. On April 17, 1998, the Company's
long-term debt to affiliates was converted to 1,974,000 shares of common stock,
as adjusted for the aforementioned stock split. Given the occurrence of this
conversion, management has considered this long-term debt to affiliates as
convertible debt for purposes of its calculation of diluted earnings per share.
 
  Risks and Uncertainties
 
     In the normal course of its business, the Company encounters two
significant types of risk: economic and regulatory. There are three main
components of economic risk: interest rate risk, credit risk and market risk.
The Company is subject to interest rate risk to the degree that its
interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice at different speeds, or on a
different basis, than its interest-earning assets. Related to interest rate risk
is prepayment risk. Prepayment risk is the risk associated with the prepayment
of assets, and the write-off of premiums associated with those assets, should
interest rates fall dramatically. Credit risk is the risk of default, primarily
in the Company's loan portfolio that results from the borrowers' inability or
unwillingness to make contractually required payments. Market risk reflects
changes in the value of securities, the value of collateral underlying loans
receivable and the valuation of real estate owned.
 
     The Company is subject to the regulations of various governmental agencies.
These regulations change significantly from period to period. Such regulations
can also restrict the growth of the Company and United as a result of capital
requirements. The Company also undergoes periodic examinations by the regulatory
agencies which may subject it to further changes with respect to asset
valuations, amounts of required loss allowances and operating restrictions. Such
changes may result from the regulators' judgments based on information available
to them at the time of their examination.
 
  Use of Estimates in Preparation of Financial Statements
 
     The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and
 
                                      F-24
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
1. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING AND REPORTING
POLICIES--(CONTINUED)
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the
reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
  Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
     Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash and noninterest bearing deposits,
federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell. For
purposes of the statements of cash flows, the Company considers all highly
liquid debt instruments with original maturities when purchased of three months
or less to be cash equivalents.
 
  Securities Purchased Under Agreements to Resell
 
     The Company periodically purchases securities under agreements to resell
(repurchase agreements). The amounts advanced under such agreements represent
short-term loans. During the agreement period, the securities are maintained by
the dealer under a written custodial agreement that explicitly recognizes the
Company's interest in the securities.
 
  Investment and Mortgage-backed Securities
 
     In accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 115
(SFAS 115) 'Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities,'
the Company has designated a portion of the investment and mortgage-backed
securities portfolio as 'held to maturity' securities. As such, this portion of
the portfolio is carried at cost, adjusted for the amortization of premiums and
accretion of discounts. Cost is determined on a specific identification basis.
Inasmuch as the Company has the ability and intent to hold the 'held to
maturity' securities in its portfolio until maturity, the carrying value has not
been adjusted to reflect decreases in market value from book value, if any. Also
in accordance with SFAS 115, the Company has designated a portion of the
mortgage-backed securities portfolio as 'available for sale.' Such securities
are carried at fair value. Fair value is the quoted market price. Unrealized
holding gains or losses for 'available for sale' securities are excluded from
earnings and reported in a separate component of stockholders' equity, net of
tax. Premiums and discounts on investment and mortgage-backed securities are
amortized against interest income, using the interest method, with the
amortization period extending to the maturity date of the securities. Gains or
losses on the sale of securities are recognized when sold.
 
     In November 1995, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued a Special
Report, 'A Guide to Implementation of Statement 115 on Accounting for Certain
Debt and Equity Securities.' Concurrent with the implementation of the Guide,
but not later than December 31, 1995, all institutions could conduct a one time
reassessment of the classification of all securities held at that time. In
accordance with the provisions of the Guide, management elected to transfer
securities with a fair value of $123.3 million and amortized cost of $126
million from the held-to-maturity classification to the available-for-sale
classification. The unrealized holding gain (loss) at the transfer date of $1.6
million (tax effected) has been reflected as a separate component of
shareholder's equity.
 
  Loans
 
     Loans are carried at the principal balance outstanding adjusted for the
amortization of premiums and the accretion of discounts. Premiums and discounts
are recognized as an adjustment of loan yield by the interest method based on
contractual term of the loans. Interest is accrued as earned.
 
     Loans are generally placed on nonaccrual status when the payments become 90
days past due, or earlier if, in management's opinion, the full and timely
collection of principal or interest becomes uncertain. Any accrued and unpaid
interest on such loans is reversed and charged against current income.
 
                                      F-25
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
1. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING AND REPORTING
POLICIES--(CONTINUED)
   
     The Company recognizes interest income on nonaccrual loans to the extent
received in cash. However, where there is doubt regarding the ultimate
collectibility of the loan principal, cash receipts, whether designated as
principal or interest, are applied to reduce the carrying value of the loan.
    
 
     Loan origination fees, net of certain direct origination costs, are
deferred and recognized as an adjustment of the loan yield over the contractual
life of the loan. Amortization of deferred loan fees is discontinued on
nonperforming loans.
 
   
     On January 1, 1995, the Company adopted prospectively the provisions of
Statement of Financial Standards No. 114, (SFAS 114) 'Accounting by Creditors
for Impairment of a Loan' as amended by Statement of Financial Standards No. 118
(SFAS 118), 'Accounting by Creditors for Impairment of a Loan--Income
Recognition and Disclosures.' These standards require the Company to evaluate
loans for possible impairment. The Company considers a loan to be impaired when,
based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be
unable to collect all amounts due according to the contractual terms of the loan
agreement, including scheduled interest payments. For a loan that has been
restructured, the contractual terms of the loan agreement refer to the
contractual terms specified by the original loan agreement, not the contractual
terms specified by the restructuring agreement.
    
 
   
     When evaluating loans for possible impairment, the Company makes an
individual assessment for impairment when and while such loans are on nonaccrual
status, or the loan has been restructured. When a loan has been identified as
being impaired, the amount of impairment will be measured by the Company using
discounted cash flows, except when it is determined that the primary remaining
source of repayment for the loan is the operation or liquidation of the
underlying collateral. In such cases, the current fair value of the collateral,
reduced by estimated costs to sell, will be used in place of discounted cash
flows. The Company does not apply the loan-by-loan evaluation process described
above to large groups of smaller balance homogeneous loans that are evaluated
collectively for impairment, such as residential mortgage (1 to 4 family) loans
with balances up to $500,000, home equity, and other consumer loans.
    
 
   
     If the measurement of the impaired loan is less than the recorded
investment in the loan (including accrued interest, net deferred loan fees or
costs and unamortized premium or discount), an impairment is recognized by
creating or adjusting an existing allocation of the allowance for loan losses.
The Company's charge-off policy with respect to impaired loans is similar to its
charge-off policy for all loans. Specifically, loans are charged off in the
month in which they are considered uncollectible.
    
 
   
     The adoption of SFAS 114 and 118 did not affect the Company's accounting
policies regarding income recognition, charge-offs, or recoveries and did not
affect the comparability of the Company's disclosures regarding classification
of nonaccrual or other problem loans.
    
 
  Allowance for Loan Losses
 
     The allowance for loan losses is based on management's continuous
evaluation of various factors affecting collectibility of the loan portfolio.
These factors include, but are not limited to, changes in the composition of the
portfolio, current and forecasted economic conditions, overall portfolio
quality, review of specific problem loans, and historical loan-loss experience.
The allowance for loan losses is based on estimates, and ultimate losses may
vary from the current estimates. These estimates are reviewed periodically and,
as adjustments become necessary, they are reported in earnings in the period in
which they become known. The allowance is increased by provisions charged to
expense and reduced by loan losses, net of recoveries.
 
   
     The determination of the allowance for loan losses is based on estimates
that are susceptible to changes in the economic environment and market
conditions. Management believes that, as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, the
allowance for loan losses is adequate based on information currently available.
If recent improvements in the economies of the Company's principal market areas
are not sustainable, the Company's loan portfolios could be
    
 
                                      F-26
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
1. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING AND REPORTING
POLICIES--(CONTINUED)
adversely affected and higher charge-offs and increases in non-performing assets
could result. Such an adverse impact could also require a larger allowance for
loan losses.
 
  Mortgage Banking Activities
 
     Through 1996, the Company operated a mortgage banking division. This
division was closed in early 1997 and mortgage banking activities are no longer
a significant business activity for the Company. The Company periodically sells
some of its mortgage loan production for cash proceeds equal to the market value
of the loans. Gain or loss is recognized to the extent of the difference between
the cash proceeds received and the carrying value of the loans sold. In
addition, for loans sold in which servicing has been retained by the Company,
gain is recognized and an asset is recorded at the time of sale based upon the
present value of amounts expected to be received resulting from the difference
between the borrowers' contractual interest rates and the rates paid to the
investors.
 
     Through December 31, 1996, the Company accounted for its loan servicing
assets in accordance with the provisions of Statement of Financial Standards No.
122 (SFAS 122) 'Accounting for Mortgage Servicing Rights,' which required that
rights to service mortgage loans be recognized as separate assets, whether
originated or acquired. Management implemented this Statement on December 31,
1995.
 
     On January 1, 1997, the Company adopted Statements of Financial Accounting
Standards No. 125, 'Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets
and Extinguishments of Liabilities' (SFAS 125). SFAS 125 requires application of
a financial components approach that focuses on control. Under this approach,
after a transfer of financial assets, an entity recognizes the financial and
servicing assets it controls and the liabilities it has incurred, derecognizes
financial assets when control has been surrendered, and derecognizes liabilities
when extinguished. The statement also distinguishes transfers of financial
assets that are sales from transfers of financial assets that are secured
borrowings.
 
     SFAS 125 supersedes the provisions SFAS 122; however, mortgage banking
activities are now an insignificant part of the Company's business, and there
are no significant differences in The Company's accounting for mortgage banking
activities or mortgage servicing rights under SFAS 125.
 
     Implementation of the provisions of SFAS 125 did not have a significant
effect on the Company's financial position or results of operations.
 
  Premises and Equipment
 
     Premises and equipment are carried at cost, less accumulated depreciation
and amortization. Provisions for depreciation and amortization are determined on
a straight-line basis over the lesser of the estimated useful lives or the terms
of the leases. Terms range from three to ten years for furniture, equipment, and
computer software, and from forty to fifty years for premises.
 
  Foreclosed Assets
 
     Foreclosed assets (other real estate owned) consist of properties acquired
through, or in lieu of, foreclosure and are carried at the lower of cost or fair
value (less estimated selling costs). Cost includes the unpaid loan balance
adjusted for applicable accrued interest, unamortized deferred loan fees and
acquisition costs. In the event that the fair value (less estimated selling
costs) is less than cost at the time of acquisition, the shortfall is charged to
the allowance for loan losses. Subsequent write-downs, if any, and disposition
gains and losses are reflected as charges to current operations.
 
                                      F-27
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
1. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING AND REPORTING
POLICIES--(CONTINUED)
  Goodwill
 
     Goodwill resulted from a variety of transactions, including branch
acquisitions and is generally amortized over seven years. Goodwill is included
in other assets.
 
  Securities Sold Under Agreements to Repurchase
 
     The Company periodically enters into sales of securities under agreements
to repurchase (reverse repurchase agreements). Fixed-coupon reverse repurchase
agreements are treated as financings. Accordingly, the securities underlying the
agreement remain in the asset accounts and the obligations to repurchase
securities sold are reflected as a liability in the consolidated balance sheets.
The securities underlying the agreements are delivered to the dealers who
arrange the transactions. Under some agreements, the dealers may sell, lend, or
otherwise dispose of the securities to other parties and agree to resell to the
Company substantially identical securities at the maturities of the agreements.
 
  Interest Rate Swap and Cap Agreements
 
     The Company periodically enters into interest rate swap and cap agreements
as a means of managing its interest rate exposure. The differential to be paid
or received on interest rate swap agreements entered into to reduce the impact
of changes in interest rates is recognized over the life of the agreements.
Premiums paid on cap agreements are amortized over the life of the agreements.
The results of swap and cap transactions are recognized currently as an
adjustment to interest expense.
 
  Accounting for Income Taxes
 
     The Company accounts for income taxes in accordance with Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards No. 109 (SFAS 109), 'Accounting for Income
Taxes.' SFAS 109 requires the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities
for the expected future tax consequences of events that have been recognized in
the Company's financial statements or tax returns. The Company provides a
valuation allowance against net deferred tax assets to the extent that
realization of the assets is not considered more likely than not.
 
     The Company and United file a consolidated federal income tax return and a
combined California tax return. The Company allows all tax benefits generated
within the consolidated group to be retained by United.
 
  Impairment of Long-Lived Assets
 
     On January 1, 1996, the Company adopted prospectively, the provisions of
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 121 (SFAS 121), 'Accounting for
the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed
Of.' This Statement establishes accounting standards for the impairment of
long-lived assets, certain identifiable intangibles, and goodwill related to
those assets to be held and used, and for long-lived assets and certain
identifiable intangibles to be disposed of. Long-lived assets and identifiable
intangibles held by the Company consist of premises and equipment, other real
estate owned, and goodwill. Implementation of SFAS 121 did not have an effect on
the financial position or results of operations of the Company since management
determined that there was no impairment with respect to premises and equipment
or goodwill. The Company's previous accounting treatment of other real estate
owned was substantially identical to the treatment required under SFAS 121.
Accordingly, no adjustment was required in connection with the implementation of
SFAS 121.
 
2. SECURITIES PURCHASED UNDER AGREEMENTS TO RESELL
 
     Securities purchased under agreements to resell averaged $44.0 million and
$22.1 million during 1997 and 1996, respectively, and the maximum amounts
outstanding at any month-end during 1997 and 1996 were
 
                                      F-28
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
2. SECURITIES PURCHASED UNDER AGREEMENTS TO RESELL--(CONTINUED)
$70 million and $20 million, respectively. At December 31, 1997 and 1996, there
were no securities purchased under agreements to resell.
 
3. INVESTMENT SECURITIES
 
     The amortized cost and approximate market value of investment securities
classified as held to maturity at December 31, 1997 and 1996 were (dollars in
thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        1997
                                                  ------------------------------------------------
                                                                 GROSS         GROSS
                                                  AMORTIZED    UNREALIZED    UNREALIZED    MARKET
                                                    COST         GAINS         LOSSES       VALUE
                                                  ---------    ----------    ----------    -------
<S>                                               <C>          <C>           <C>           <C>
Held to maturity
     FHLB Note.................................    $ 2,000         $--          $  2       $ 1,998
     FNMA Note.................................      2,000         --             --         2,000
                                                  ---------       ---            ---       -------
                                                   $ 4,000         $--          $  2       $ 3,998
                                                  ---------       ---            ---       -------
                                                  ---------       ---            ---       -------
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        1996
                                                  ------------------------------------------------
                                                                 GROSS         GROSS
                                                  AMORTIZED    UNREALIZED    UNREALIZED    MARKET
                                                    COST         GAINS         LOSSES       VALUE
                                                  ---------    ----------    ----------    -------
<S>                                               <C>          <C>           <C>           <C>
Held to maturity
     FHLB Note.................................    $ 8,670         $2           $ 43       $ 8,629
     FHLB CD...................................      2,000         --             --         2,000
     Other.....................................      5,000         --             12         4,988
                                                  ---------       ---            ---       -------
                                                   $15,670         $2           $ 55       $15,617
                                                  ---------       ---            ---       -------
                                                  ---------       ---            ---       -------
</TABLE>
 
     For 1996, other investments consisted primarily of medium-term notes and
certificates of deposit with financial institutions and medium-term notes with
governmental agencies.
 
     The amortized cost and approximate market value of investment securities
classified as held to maturity at December 31, 1997 and 1996, by contractual
maturity, are shown below (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        1997
                                                                --------------------
                                                                AMORTIZED    MARKET
                                                                  COST        VALUE
                                                                ---------    -------
<S>                                                             <C>          <C>
Held to maturity
     Due in one year or less.................................    $ 2,000     $ 1,998
     Due after one year through five years...................      2,000       2,000
                                                                ---------    -------
                                                                 $ 4,000     $ 3,998
                                                                ---------    -------
                                                                ---------    -------
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        1996
                                                                --------------------
                                                                AMORTIZED    MARKET
                                                                  COST        VALUE
                                                                ---------    -------
<S>                                                             <C>          <C>
Held to maturity
     Due in one year or less.................................    $11,670     $11,662
     Due after one year through five years...................      4,000       3,955
                                                                ---------    -------
                                                                 $15,670     $15,617
                                                                ---------    -------
                                                                ---------    -------
</TABLE>
 
     During 1996, $29 million of securities classified as investments held to
maturity were called by the issuer.
 
                                      F-29
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
4. MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES
 
     The amortized cost and approximate market value of mortgage-backed
securities classified as held to maturity and available for sale at December 31,
1997 and 1996, were (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                      1997
                                                -------------------------------------------------
                                                               GROSS         GROSS
                                                AMORTIZED    UNREALIZED    UNREALIZED     MARKET
                                                  COST         GAINS         LOSSES       VALUE
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
<S>                                             <C>          <C>           <C>           <C>
Held to maturity
     FHLMC...................................   $  48,536        --          $1,918      $ 46,618
     FNMA....................................     117,184        --           4,396       112,788
     Other...................................      16,075        --             509        15,566
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                $ 181,795       $--          $6,823      $174,972
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
Available for sale
     FNMA....................................   $  87,237       $--          $2,929      $ 84,308
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                      1996
                                                -------------------------------------------------
                                                               GROSS         GROSS
                                                AMORTIZED    UNREALIZED    UNREALIZED     MARKET
                                                  COST         GAINS         LOSSES       VALUE
                                                ---------    ----------    ----------    --------
<S>                                             <C>          <C>           <C>           <C>
Held to maturity
     FHLMC...................................   $  61,629        --          $2,615      $ 59,014
     FNMA....................................     124,710        --           5,489       119,221
     Other...................................      22,216        --             968        21,248
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                $ 208,555       $--          $9,072      $199,483
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
Available for sale
     FNMA....................................   $ 123,982       $--          $4,468      $119,514
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
                                                ---------       ---        ----------    --------
</TABLE>
 
     Approximately $45.6 million and $75.5 million of mortgage-backed securities
have been pledged to secure contractual arrangements entered into by the Company
at December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
 
     Proceeds from the sale of available for sale securities during 1997 and
1996 totaled $23.4 million and $8.8 million, respectively. There were no sales
of available for sale securities during 1995. Gross realized losses totaled
$806,000 and $335,000 for 1997 and 1996, respectively.
 
     Mortgage-backed securities sold under agreements to repurchase as of
December 31, 1997 and 1996 were (dollars in millions):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                1997        1996
                                                               ------      ------
<S>                                                            <C>         <C>
Book value.................................................... $  --       $  --
Market value..................................................    --          --
Obligations...................................................    --          --
Weighted average interest rate at end of period...............    --          --
Weighted average interest rate during the period..............  5.47%       6.31%
Average balance during the year...............................   5.3        15.8
Maximum amount outstanding at any month end during the year...    --        74.4
</TABLE>
 
     When the Company enters into these transactions, the obligations generally
mature within one year and generally represent agreements to repurchase the same
securities.
 
                                      F-30
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
4. MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES--(CONTINUED)
     As of December 31, 1997 and 1996, remaining maturities on mortgage-backed
securities classified as held to maturity and available for sale were as follows
(dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       1997
                                                               ---------------------
                                                               AMORTIZED     MARKET
                                                                 COST        VALUE
                                                               ---------    --------
<S>                                                            <C>          <C>
Held to maturity
     In one year or less....................................   $   1,413    $  1,406
     After one year through five years......................          --          --
     After five years through ten year......................       2,961       2,881
     After ten years........................................     177,421     170,685
                                                               ---------    --------
                                                               $ 181,795    $174,972
                                                               ---------    --------
                                                               ---------    --------
Available for sale
     After ten years........................................   $  87,237    $ 84,308
                                                               ---------    --------
                                                               ---------    --------
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       1996
                                                               ---------------------
                                                               AMORTIZED     MARKET
                                                                 COST        VALUE
                                                               ---------    --------
<S>                                                            <C>          <C>
Held to maturity:
     In one year or less....................................   $   4,595    $  4,485
     After one year through five years......................       1,845       1,820
     After five years through ten year......................       3,096       2,995
     After ten years........................................     199,019     190,183
                                                               ---------    --------
                                                               $ 208,555    $199,483
                                                               ---------    --------
                                                               ---------    --------
Available for sale
     After ten years........................................   $ 123,982    $119,514
                                                               ---------    --------
                                                               ---------    --------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-31
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
5. LOANS
 
     As of December 31, 1997 and 1996, the composition of the loan portfolio was
as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              1997          1996
                                                           ----------    ----------
<S>                                                        <C>           <C>
Consumer
     Residential mortgage (one to four family)..........   $  691,167    $  541,156
     Home equity........................................       16,743        10,673
     Other..............................................        2,732         2,642
                                                           ----------    ----------
                                                              710,642       554,471
                                                           ----------    ----------
Commercial
     Secured by real estate - multifamily...............      339,257       361,591
     Secured by real estate - nonresidential............      115,366       123,003
     Construction.......................................       26,603        19,892
     Lines of credit....................................       21,146         6,595
                                                           ----------    ----------
                                                              502,372       511,081
                                                           ----------    ----------
Gross loans.............................................    1,213,014     1,065,552
Net deferred loan costs.................................        1,223           816
Allowance for loan losses...............................      (12,142)      (11,682)
                                                           ----------    ----------
Net loans...............................................   $1,202,095    $1,054,686
                                                           ----------    ----------
                                                           ----------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
     In the table above, construction loans are presented net of undrawn
commitments of $71.0 million and $25.8 million at December 31, 1997 and 1996,
respectively.
 
     As of December 31, 1997, loans at fixed interest rates amounted to $241.5
million, and loans at variable interest rates amounted to $971.5 million. Loans
of approximately $9.9 million and $19.5 million were on nonaccrual status at
December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
 
     As of December 31, 1997, the portfolio above contained $685.0 million of
loans that were interest-rate sensitive within one year, $304.2 million from one
to five years, $12.3 million from five to ten years, $175.2 million from ten to
twenty years and $36.3 million over twenty years.
 
     As of December 31, 1997, loans with a book value and market value of $245.3
million were pledged to secure FHLB advances (see Note 10).
 
     The Company serviced real estate loans for others of $11.0 million and
$300.0 million at December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively. These loans are not
included in the consolidated balance sheets. In connection therewith, the
Company held trust funds of approximately $2.1 million and $4.7 million as of
December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, all of which were segregated in
separate accounts and included in the respective balance sheets.
 
     Some agreements with investors to whom the Company has sold loans have
provisions which could require repurchase of loans under certain circumstances.
Management does not believe that any such repurchases will be significant.
 
                                      F-32
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
5. LOANS--(CONTINUED)
     The following table sets forth impaired loan disclosures as of and for the
year ended December 31, 1997 and 1996 (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     1997      1996
                                                                    ------    ------
<S>                                                                 <C>       <C>
Impaired loans with an allowance.................................   $1,359    $2,894
Impaired loans without an allowance..............................       20     6,218
                                                                    ------    ------
     Total impaired loans........................................   $1,379    $9,112
                                                                    ------    ------
                                                                    ------    ------
Allowance for impaired loans under SFAS 114......................   $  109    $  315
                                                                    ------    ------
                                                                    ------    ------
</TABLE>
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    1997      1996       1995
                                                                   ------    -------    ------
<S>                                                                <C>       <C>        <C>
Interest income recognized on impaired loans during the
  period........................................................   $   68    $   181    $  167
                                                                   ------    -------    ------
                                                                   ------    -------    ------
Average recorded investment in impaired loans...................   $3,425    $10,394    $2,268
</TABLE>
    
 
     In the table above, loans included in the 'Impaired loans without an
allowance' category are those loans for which the discounted cash flows,
collateral value (net of estimated selling costs) or market price equals or
exceeds the carrying value of the loan. Such loans do not require an allowance.
 
     For the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, the activity in the
allowance for loan losses was as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 1997       1996       1995
                                                                -------    -------    -------
<S>                                                             <C>        <C>        <C>
Balance at beginning of year.................................   $11,682    $13,699    $ 7,550
Provision for loan losses....................................     1,154      1,476      8,777
Loans charged off............................................    (1,069)    (4,562)    (2,696)
Recoveries of loans previously charged off...................       375      1,069         68
                                                                -------    -------    -------
Balance at end of year.......................................   $12,142    $11,682    $13,699
                                                                -------    -------    -------
                                                                -------    -------    -------
</TABLE>
 
6. PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
 
     As of December 31, 1997 and 1996, premises and equipment were as follows
(dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  1997        1996
                                                                --------    --------
<S>                                                             <C>         <C>
Land and buildings...........................................   $ 19,054    $ 18,866
Leasehold improvements.......................................      8,420       7,901
Equipment, furniture and fixtures............................     11,853       9,936
                                                                --------    --------
                                                                  39,327      36,703
Less accumulated depreciation and amortization...............    (15,396)    (13,864)
                                                                --------    --------
     Total...................................................   $ 23,931    $ 22,839
                                                                --------    --------
                                                                --------    --------
</TABLE>
 
     Depreciation and amortization expense was $2.3 million, $2.0 million and
$1.6 million for the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.
 
                                      F-33
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
7. SERVICING ASSETS
 
     Included in other assets are servicing assets. For the years ended December
31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, activity with respect to servicing assets was as
follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             1997
                                                            --------------------------------------
                                                            CAPITALIZED    PURCHASED    ORIGINATED
                                                              EXCESS       MORTGAGE      MORTGAGE
                                                             SERVICING     SERVICING    SERVICING
                                                               FEES         RIGHTS        RIGHTS
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
<S>                                                         <C>            <C>          <C>
Beginning balance, net...................................      $ 546        $ 1,832       $  382
     Sales...............................................         (5)        (2,532)        (428)
     Additions...........................................         --             --           44
     Amortization:
          Normal.........................................       (206)          (150)         (51)
     Decrease in valuation allowance.....................         --            850          147
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
Ending balance, net......................................      $ 335        $    --       $   94
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             1996
                                                            --------------------------------------
                                                            CAPITALIZED    PURCHASED    ORIGINATED
                                                              EXCESS       MORTGAGE      MORTGAGE
                                                             SERVICING     SERVICING    SERVICING
                                                               FEES         RIGHTS        RIGHTS
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
<S>                                                         <C>            <C>          <C>
Beginning balance, net...................................      $ 672        $ 2,509       $   --
     Additions...........................................         --             --          576
     Amortization:
          Normal.........................................       (126)          (627)         (47)
     Increase in valuation allowance.....................         --            (50)        (147)
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
Ending balance, net......................................      $ 546        $ 1,832       $  382
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             1995
                                                            --------------------------------------
                                                            CAPITALIZED    PURCHASED    ORIGINATED
                                                              EXCESS       MORTGAGE      MORTGAGE
                                                             SERVICING     SERVICING    SERVICING
                                                               FEES         RIGHTS        RIGHTS
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
<S>                                                         <C>            <C>          <C>
Beginning balance, net...................................      $ 902        $ 3,806       $   --
     Additions...........................................         --             --           --
     Amortization:
          Normal.........................................       (230)          (497)          --
     Increase in valuation allowance.....................         --           (800)          --
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
Ending balance, net......................................      $ 672        $ 2,509       $   --
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
                                                            -----------    ---------    ----------
</TABLE>


<PAGE>

 
     For the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, the activity in the
valuation allowance for servicing assets was as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         1997     1996    1995
                                                                         -----    ----    ----
<S>                                                                      <C>      <C>     <C>
Balance, beginning of year............................................   $ 997    $800    $ --
Provision for impairment..............................................      --     197     800
Reversal of valuation allowance.......................................    (997)     --      --
Write-downs...........................................................      --      --      --
                                                                         -----    ----    ----
Balance, end of year..................................................   $  --    $997    $800
                                                                         -----    ----    ----
                                                                         -----    ----    ----
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-34
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
8. FORECLOSED ASSETS
 
     As of December 31, 1997 and 1996, other assets include $412,000 and $1.6
million, respectively, in real estate acquired through foreclosure.
 
9. DEPOSITS
 
     As of December 31, 1997 and 1996, deposit balances were as follows (dollars
in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       1997
                                                              ----------------------
                                                                            WEIGHTED
                                                                            AVERAGE
                                                               BALANCE        RATE
                                                              ----------    --------
<S>                                                           <C>           <C>
NOW and checking accounts..................................   $  111,984      0.80%
Money market accounts......................................       20,986      2.48%
Passbook accounts..........................................      212,013      2.11%
Time deposits:
     Less than $100,000....................................      831,292      5.12%
     $100,000 or greater...................................      292,712      5.41%
                                                              ----------    --------
     Total.................................................   $1,468,987      4.38%
                                                              ----------    --------
                                                              ----------    --------
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       1996
                                                              ----------------------
                                                                            WEIGHTED
                                                                            AVERAGE
                                                               BALANCE        RATE
                                                              ----------    --------
<S>                                                           <C>           <C>
NOW and checking accounts..................................   $  106,491      0.79%
Money market accounts......................................       22,111      2.39%
Passbook accounts..........................................      216,471      2.20%
Time deposits:
     Less than $100,000....................................      773,571      4.87%
     $100,000 or greater...................................      274,481      5.16%
                                                              ----------    --------
     Total.................................................   $1,393,125      4.17%
                                                              ----------    --------
                                                              ----------    --------
</TABLE>
 
     As of December 31, 1997, remaining maturities on time deposits were as
follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                      <C>
1998..................................................................   $1,111,927
1999..................................................................       10,324
2000..................................................................        1,753
                                                                         ----------
Total.................................................................   $1,124,004
                                                                         ----------
                                                                         ----------
</TABLE>
 
     For the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, interest expense on
deposits was as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 1997       1996       1995
                                                                -------    -------    -------
<S>                                                             <C>        <C>        <C>
NOW and demand deposit accounts..............................   $   875    $   826    $   781
Money market accounts........................................       517        561        654
Passbook accounts............................................     4,834      4,772      4,797
Time deposits................................................    55,570     53,360     50,046
Less penalties for early withdrawal..........................      (283)      (246)      (240)
                                                                -------    -------    -------
     Total...................................................   $61,513    $59,273    $56,038
                                                                -------    -------    -------
                                                                -------    -------    -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-35
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
9. DEPOSITS--(CONTINUED)
     As of December 31, 1997 and 1996, the composition of deposits by interest
rate was as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              1997          1996
                                                           ----------    ----------
<S>                                                        <C>           <C>
Under 3%................................................   $  345,473    $  345,027
3.00% to 3.99%..........................................       45,148        49,750
4.00% to 4.99%..........................................      262,607       423,922
5.00% to 5.99%..........................................      681,977       562,446
6.00% to 6.99%..........................................      133,313        11,099
7.00% to 7.99%..........................................           --           251
8.00% to 8.99%..........................................          469           630
                                                           ----------    ----------
     Total..............................................   $1,468,987    $1,393,125
                                                           ----------    ----------
                                                           ----------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
10. FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK ADVANCES
 
     The Company maintains a secured credit facility with the Federal Home Loan
Bank of San Francisco (FHLB-SF) against which the Company may take advances. The
terms of this credit facility require the Company to maintain in safekeeping
with the FHLB-SF eligible collateral of least 100% of outstanding advances.
There were no advances outstanding at December 31, 1997 or 1996. At December 31,
1997, credit availability under this facility was approximately $291 million.
 
11. LONG-TERM DEBT TO AFFILIATES
 
     The Company has a promissory note to United Holdings Int'l Ltd. (UHIL)
dated April 1, 1996 for a principal sum of $15,548,000. This note refinanced
previous affiliate debt and related accrued interest. Interest is capitalized on
the note through December 31, 1999 and calculated at a compound annual interest
rate of 10%. As of January 1, 2000, accrued interest is payable annually within
60 days after each year end. The Company has an additional promissory note to
Chief Investments Limited (Chief) dated February 28, 1997 for a principal sum of
$1,500,000. Interest is capitalized on the note through December 31, 1999 and
calculated at a compound annual interest rate of 10%. Annual payments
representing the lesser of $1,000,000 or the outstanding balance of the note are
to be paid within 60 days of each calendar year end, effective December 31,
1999. Chief is the Company's parent and UHIL is another related party.
 
     At December 31, 1997, future principal payments (including capitalized
interest) on long term debt are payable as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                         <C>
1998.....................................................................   $    --
1999.....................................................................        --
2000.....................................................................     1,000
2001.....................................................................     3,127
2002.....................................................................     3,000
Aggregate thereafter.....................................................    12,933
                                                                            -------
     Total...............................................................   $20,060
                                                                            -------
                                                                            -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-36
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
12. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY AND REGULATORY CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS
 
     The Company and United are subject to various regulatory requirements
administered by the federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital
requirements can initiate certain mandatory--and possibly additional
discretionary--actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct
material effect on the Company's financial statements. Under capital adequacy
guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, United
must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of
United's assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated
under regulatory accounting practices. United's capital amounts and
classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about
components, risk weightings, and other factors.
 
     Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy
require United to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the table
below) of total and Tier I capital (as defined in the regulations) to
risk-weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier I capital (as defined) to average
assets (as defined). Management believes, as of December 31, 1997, that United
meets all capital adequacy requirements to which it is subject.
 
     As of December 31, 1997, the most recent notification from the Office of
Thrift Supervision categorized United as well capitalized under the regulatory
framework for prompt corrective action. To be categorized as well capitalized,
United must maintain minimum total risk-based, Tier I risk-based, Tier I
leverage ratios as set forth in the table. There are no conditions or events
since that notification that management believes have changed the institution's
category. As of December 31, 1996, the Office of Thrift Supervision categorized
United as adequately capitalized under the regulatory framework for prompt
corrective action.
 
     United's actual capital amounts and ratios are also presented in the
following table (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                         TO BE WELL
                                                                                                      CAPITALIZED UNDER
                                                                          FOR CAPITAL                 PROMPT CORRECTIVE
                                                 ACTUAL                ADEQUACY PURPOSES              ACTION PROVISIONS
                                             --------------          ---------------------          ---------------------
                                             AMOUNT   RATIO          AMOUNT          RATIO          AMOUNT          RATIO
                                             -------  -----          -------         -----          -------         -----
<S>                                          <C>      <C>            <C>             <C>            <C>             <C>
As of December 31, 1997:
Total Capital (to risk weighted assets)...   $94,547  11.15%         $67,837         8.00%          $84,796         10.00%
Core Capital (to adjusted tangible
  assets).................................    83,927   5.37%          62,519         4.00%           78,148          5.00%
Tier I Capital (to risk weighted
  assets).................................    83,927   9.90%          33,919         4.00%           50,864          6.00%
Tangible Capital (to tangible assets).....    83,927   5.37%          23,444         1.50%            N/A            N/A
</TABLE>
 
     The following table is a reconciliation of United's capital under Generally
Accepted Accounting Principles ('GAAP') with its regulatory capital at December
31, 1997 (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         TANGIBLE     CORE      RISK-BASED
                                                                         CAPITAL     CAPITAL     CAPITAL
                                                                         --------    -------    ----------
<S>                                                                      <C>         <C>        <C>
GAAP Capital..........................................................   $ 82,556    $82,556     $ 82,556
Nonallowable components:
  Unrealized losses on securities available for sale..................      1,728      1,728        1,728
  Goodwill............................................................       (348)      (348)        (348)
  Mortgage servicing rights-excess....................................         (9)        (9)          (9)
Additional capital components:
  Allowance for loan losses--allowable in risk-based capital..........         --         --       10,620
                                                                         --------    -------    ----------
United regulatory capital.............................................   $ 83,927    $83,927     $ 94,547
                                                                         --------    -------    ----------
                                                                         --------    -------    ----------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-37
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
12. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY AND REGULATORY CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS--(CONTINUED)
     The Company, as a savings institution holding company, is not subject to
regulatory capital requirements separate from its subsidiary, United.
 
     United is prohibited by federal regulations from paying dividends if the
payment would reduce United's net worth below certain minimum requirements. The
Company has agreed that United would not declare or pay in any year a dividend
that exceeds 50% of The Company's net operating income (dividends may be
deferred and paid in a subsequent year) without the prior written consent of the
Office of Thrift Supervision (OTS). At December 31, 1997, $5.1 million of
United's retained earnings were available for distribution as dividends to the
Company.
 
13. FEDERAL AND STATE TAXES ON INCOME
 
     Following is a summary of the provision for taxes on income (dollars in
thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            YEAR ENDED
                                                                           DECEMBER 31,
                                                                    --------------------------
                                                                     1997     1996      1995
                                                                    ------    -----    -------
<S>                                                                 <C>       <C>      <C>
Current tax (benefit) expense:
  Federal........................................................   $3,244    $ 174    $  (783)
  State..........................................................    1,881       28        317
                                                                    ------    -----    -------
                                                                     5,125      202       (466)
                                                                    ------    -----    -------
Deferred tax (benefit) expense:
  Federal........................................................    1,155     (327)    (2,199)
  State..........................................................     (490)     (52)      (741)
                                                                    ------    -----    -------
                                                                       665     (379)    (2,940)
                                                                    ------    -----    -------
                                                                    $5,790    $(177)   $(3,406)
                                                                    ------    -----    -------
                                                                    ------    -----    -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-38
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
13. FEDERAL AND STATE TAXES ON INCOME--(CONTINUED)
     Deferred tax liabilities (assets) are comprised of the following (dollars
in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         YEAR ENDED
                                                                                        DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                    --------------------
                                                                                      1997        1996
                                                                                    --------    --------
<S>                                                                                 <C>         <C>
Deferred tax liabilities:
  Deferred loan fees.............................................................   $  3,356    $  3,812
  FHLB dividends.................................................................      2,803       2,456
  Amortization of excess servicing fees..........................................        138         225
  Market value adjustments on certain loans and securities.......................         81       1,409
  Purchase accounting adjustments................................................        229         306
  Capitalized originated mortgage servicing......................................         39         153
                                                                                    --------    --------
                                                                                       6,646       8,361
                                                                                    --------    --------
Deferred tax assets:
  Net operating loss carryforwards...............................................        (84)     (3,282)
  Loan and OREO loss allowances..................................................     (4,162)     (4,028)
  Servicing rights impairment allowance..........................................         --        (331)
  AMT credit carryover...........................................................     (1,166)     (1,707)
  State taxes....................................................................       (539)       (129)
  Depreciation...................................................................       (396)       (270)
  Unrealized losses on securities available for sale.............................     (1,130)     (1,707)
  Deferred compensation..........................................................       (132)       (211)
  Other deferred deduction items.................................................     (2,562)     (1,749)
                                                                                    --------    --------
                                                                                     (10,171)    (13,414)
                                                                                    --------    --------
Deferred tax assets valuation allowance..........................................         --         286
                                                                                    --------    --------
Net deferred tax assets..........................................................   $ (3,525)   $ (4,767)
                                                                                    --------    --------
                                                                                    --------    --------
</TABLE>
 
     The following table reconciles the statutory income tax rate to the
consolidated effective income tax rate:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             YEAR ENDED
                                                                            DECEMBER 31,
                                                                      ------------------------
                                                                      1997     1996      1995
                                                                      ----     -----     -----
<S>                                                                   <C>      <C>       <C>
Federal income tax rate...........................................    34.0%    (34.0)%   (34.0)%
State franchise tax rate, net of federal income tax effects.......     7.2%     (7.6)%    (7.6)%
                                                                      ----     -----     -----
Statutory income tax rate.........................................    41.2%    (41.6)%   (41.6)%
(Reduction) increase in tax rate resulting from:
  Amortization of intangibles.....................................     0.2%      2.0%      0.4%
  Reversal of taxes previously provided...........................      --        --     (16.0)%
  Reversal of valuation allowance.................................    (2.2)%      --        --
  Other items, net................................................     5.0%      3.0%      3.3%
                                                                      ----     -----     -----
                                                                      44.2%    (36.6)%   (53.9)%
                                                                      ----     -----     -----
                                                                      ----     -----     -----
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-39
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
13. FEDERAL AND STATE TAXES ON INCOME--(CONTINUED)
     Taxes on income included the following (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                YEAR ENDED
                                                                               DECEMBER 31,
                                                                            ------------------
                                                                             1997       1996
                                                                            -------    -------
<S>                                                                         <C>        <C>
Net deferred (asset) liability:
  Federal income tax.....................................................   $(3,429)   $(5,004)
  State franchise tax....................................................       (96)       237
                                                                            -------    -------
                                                                             (3,525)    (4,767)
(Prepaid income taxes) taxes payable.....................................        40       (656)
                                                                            -------    -------
                                                                            $(3,485)   $(5,423)
                                                                            -------    -------
                                                                            -------    -------
</TABLE>
 
     The Company computes its bad debt deduction using the experience method for
Federal and state tax purposes which considers current year charge-offs together
with those from the previous five years.
 
     During 1996, legislation was enacted which eliminated the Company's tax
exposure relating to tax bad debt reserve that arose prior to 1988. In
accordance with SFAS 109, a deferred tax liability of $946,000 had not been
recognized at December 31, 1995 for $2,784,000 of these temporary differences.
 
     Tax years 1996 through 1997 remain open for Internal Revenue Service
purposes and tax years 1994 through 1997 remain open for California Franchise
Tax Board purposes.
 
     At December 31, 1997, the Company had regular Federal net operating loss
carryovers of $248,000 which expire 2005.
 
14. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH
    OFF-BALANCE-SHEET RISK
 
     The Company is a party to derivative financial instruments and financial
instruments with off-balance-sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet
the financing needs of its customers and to reduce its own exposure to
fluctuations in interest rates. The Company does not hold or issue financial
instruments for trading purposes. Financial instruments in the normal course of
business include commitments to extend and purchase credit, forward commitments
to sell loans, long put and call options, letters of credit and interest-rate
swaps and caps. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of
credit and interest-rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in the
statement of financial position. The contract or notional amounts of those
instruments reflects the extent of involvement the Company has in particular
classes of financial instruments.
 
     The Company's exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the
other party to the financial instrument for commitments to extend credit is
represented by the contractual or notional amount of those instruments. The
Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional
obligations as it does for on-balance-sheet instruments. For interest-rate swap
and cap transactions and forward commitments to sell loans, the contract or
notional amounts do not represent exposure to credit loss. The Company controls
the credit risk of its interest-rate swap and cap agreements and forward
commitments to sell loans through credit approvals, limits, and monitoring
procedures. The Company does not require collateral or other security to support
interest-rate swap transactions with credit risk.
 
                                      F-40
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
14. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH
OFF-BALANCE-SHEET
    RISK--(CONTINUED)
     Contract or notional amounts of derivative financial instruments and
financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk as of December 31, 1997 and
1996 are as follows (dollars in millions):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          1997     1996
                                                                                          -----    -----
<S>                                                                                       <C>      <C>
Financial instruments whose contract amounts represent credit risk:
  Commitments to extend credit:
     Consumer (including residential mortgage).........................................   $65.0    $47.0
     Commercial (excluding construction)...............................................    10.8     16.0
     Construction......................................................................    78.7     29.5
  Commitments to purchase loans........................................................     0.1      0.4
  Letters of credit....................................................................     1.9      1.3
Financial instruments whose notional or contract amounts exceed the amount of credit
  risk:
  Forward commitments to sell loans....................................................     3.5      4.2
</TABLE>
 
     Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long
as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract.
Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses.
The Company evaluates each customer's credit worthiness on a case-by-case basis.
The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the Company upon
extension of credit, is based on management's credit evaluation of the
counterparty. Collateral held generally includes residential or commercial real
estate, accounts receivable, or other assets.
 
     Commitments to purchase loans are agreements to buy loans from a primary
broker/dealer as long as there are no violations of any condition established in
the contract. Commitments terminate on the final closing date mutually agreed
upon by the purchaser and seller as defined in the contract. The Company
evaluates each loan's worthiness on a loan-by-loan basis. Each loan is
collateralized by residential real estate.
 
     Letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Company to
guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. The credit risk
involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved
in extending loan facilities to customers. These letters of credit are usually
secured by inventories or by deposits held at the Company.
 
     Interest rate swap transactions generally involve the exchange of fixed-
and floating-rate interest payment obligations without the exchange of the
underlying principal amounts. Interest-rate swaps are entered into to reduce the
Company's exposure to interest rate movements and are used as part of
asset/liability management. The Company typically becomes a principal in the
exchange of fixed- and floating-rate interest payment obligations with another
party and, therefore, is exposed to loss if the other party defaults. The
Company minimizes this risk by performing normal credit reviews on its swap
counterparties.
 
     Interest rate caps are interest rate protection instruments that involve
the payment from the seller to the buyer of an interest differential. This
differential represents the difference between current interest rates and
agreed-upon rate applied to a notional principal amount. The Company is a
purchaser of interest rate caps.
 
     Entering into interest-rate swap agreements involves not only the risk of
dealing with counterparties and their ability to meet the terms of the
contracts, but also the interest-rate risk associated with unmatched positions.
Notional principal amounts often are used to express the volume of these
transactions, but the amounts potentially subject to credit risk are much
smaller.
 
     Forward contracts are contracts for delayed delivery of securities or loans
in which the seller agrees to make delivery at a specified future date of a
specified instrument at a specified price or yield. Risks arise from the
possible inability of counterparties to meet the terms of their contracts and
from movements in security values and interest rates. In order to minimize the
exposure arising from forward contracts, the Company entered into
 
                                      F-41
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
14. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH
OFF-BALANCE-SHEET
    RISK--(CONTINUED)
long put options amounting to $1 million and $4 million as of December 31, 1997
and 1996, respectively. The Company had $0.6 million and $1.1 million of long
call options as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
 
     Interest rate swaps with a notional amount of $20 million matured in 1996.
 
     For the years ended December 31, 1996 and 1995, costs associated with the
interest rate swaps and caps negatively impacted net interest income by $137,000
and $538,000, respectively.
 
15. CONCENTRATIONS OF CREDIT RISK
 
     All of the Company's loan activity is with customers located throughout the
State of California. Substantially all residential and commercial real estate
loans are secured by properties located in the State of California. The Company
is required by law to maintain 70% of its portfolio assets--as defined by
regulations-- in qualifying residential or small business assets. As of December
31, 1997, 91.1% of the Company's portfolio assets consisted of such qualifying
assets.
 
     Substantially all real estate loans in the portfolio are originated at 80%
loan-to-value or better. Management believes that the risk of significant losses
in excess of underlying collateral value is low.
 
16. LEASE COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES
 
  Lease Commitments
 
     The Company leases various premises under noncancelable operating leases,
many of which contain renewal options and some of which contain escalation
clauses.
 
     Future minimum rental payments, which do not include common area costs, due
each year under existing operating leases that have initial or remaining
noncancelable lease terms in excess of one year as of December 31, 1997, are
payable as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                         <C>
1998.....................................................................   $ 3,016
1999.....................................................................     2,017
2000.....................................................................     1,853
2001.....................................................................     1,382
2002.....................................................................     1,208
Aggregate thereafter.....................................................    10,642
                                                                            -------
Total minimum payments required..........................................   $20,118
                                                                            -------
                                                                            -------
</TABLE>
 
     Rental expense was approximately $3.2 million, $3.5 million and $3.0
million for the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.
 
  Contingent Liabilities
 
     The Company is subject to pending or threatened actions and proceedings
arising in the normal course of business. In the opinion of management, the
ultimate disposition of all pending or threatened actions and proceedings will
not have a material adverse effect on the Company's operations or financial
condition.
 
17. FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
 
     Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 107, 'Disclosures about
Fair Value of Financial Instrument,' requires all entities to estimate the fair
value of all financial instrument assets, liabilities, and off-balance-sheet
transactions. Fair values are point-in-time estimates that can change
significantly based on
 
                                      F-42
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
17. FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS--(CONTINUED)
numerous factors. Accordingly, management cannot provide any assurance that the
estimated fair values presented below could actually be realized. The fair value
estimates for financial instruments were determined as of December 31, 1997 and
1996, by application of the described methods and significant assumptions.
 
  Cash and Short-Term Investments
 
     For these short-term instruments, the carrying value of $34,797,000 at
December 31, 1997 and $18,383,000 at December 31, 1996 is a reasonable estimate
of fair value.
 
  Investment And Mortgage-Backed Securities
 
     The aggregate fair value of investment and mortgage-backed securities is
$277,192,000 at December 31, 1997 and $347,696,000 at December 31, 1996. Fair
value equals quoted market price, if available. If a quoted market price is not
available, fair value is estimated using quoted market prices for similar
securities.
 
  Loans Receivable
 
     The aggregate fair value of loans receivable is $1,212,105,000 at December
31, 1997 and $1,036,369,000 at December 31, 1996. Fair value is estimated by
discounting the future cash flows using the current rates at which similar loans
would be made to borrowers with similar credit ratings at the same remaining
maturities. In addition, the allowance for loan losses was considered a
reasonable adjustment for credit risk for the entire portfolio.
 
  Capitalized Servicing Fees
 
     Fair value is estimated by discounting estimated future cash flows using
current rates which are required for similar assets. Fair value is estimated to
be the same as the carrying value of $429,087 at December 31, 1997 and $929,000
at December 31, 1996.
 
  Deposit Liabilities
 
     Fair value of demand deposits, savings accounts, and certain money market
deposits is the amount payable on demand at the reporting date. The fair value
of fixed maturity certificates of deposit is estimated using the rates currently
offered for deposits of similar remaining maturities. The aggregate fair value
of deposits is $1,426,274,000 at December 31, 1997 and $1,392,058,000 at
December 31, 1996.
 
  Federal Home Loan Bank Advances
 
     No Federal Home Loan Bank advances were outstanding at December 31, 1997 or
1996.
 
  Long-term Debt to Affiliates
 
     Due to the related party nature of the Company's long-term debt, management
does not believe that fair value estimates are meaningful. Accordingly, such
estimates have not been presented.
 
  Securities Sold Under Agreement to Repurchase
 
     No securities sold under agreement to repurchase were outstanding at
December 31, 1997 or 1996.
 
  Interest Rate Swap and Cap Agreements
 
     The fair value of the swap and cap agreements used for hedging purposes is
the estimated amount that the Company would receive or pay to terminate the
agreements at the reporting date, taking into account current
 
                                      F-43
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
17. FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS--(CONTINUED)
interest rates and the current creditworthiness of the swap and cap
counterparties. There were no swap of cap agreements at December 31, 1997 and
1996.
 
  Commitments to Extend Credit, Commitments to Purchase Loans, Securities Sold
  But Not Owned, and Options on Interest Rate Futures
 
     The fair value of commitments is estimated using the fees currently charged
to enter into similar agreements, taking into account the remaining terms of the
agreements and the present creditworthiness of the counterparties. For
fixed-rate commitments, fair value also considers the difference between current
levels of interest rates and the committed rates. Fair values for securities
sold but not owned and options on interest rate futures are based on quoted
market prices or dealer quotes. The fair value of commitments to extend credit
and commitments to purchase loans cannot be readily determined. The fair value
of put options on interest rate futures is $56,875 at December 31, 1997 and
$50,625 at December 31, 1996. The fair value of call options on interest rate
futures is $28,437 at December 31, 1997 and $11,016 at December 31, 1996.
 
18. PARENT COMPANY
 
     Condensed unconsolidated financial information of UCBH Holdings, Inc. is
presented below. See Note 11 for information regarding the Company's long-term
debt.
 
                            CONDENSED BALANCE SHEET
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                     ------------------
                                                                                      1997       1996
                                                                                     -------    -------
<S>                                                                                  <C>        <C>
                                      ASSETS
  Cash and due from banks.........................................................   $    56    $    11
  Investment in subsidiary........................................................    82,556     71,069
                                                                                     -------    -------
     Total assets.................................................................   $82,612    $71,080
                                                                                     -------    -------
                                                                                     -------    -------
                                   LIABILITIES
  Long-term debt to affiliates....................................................   $20,060    $16,736
                                                                                     -------    -------
     Total liabilities............................................................    20,060     16,736
                                                                                     -------    -------
                               STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
  Common stock....................................................................        10         10
  Additional paid-in capital......................................................    30,278     30,278
  Unrealized loss on subsidiary's mortgage-backed securities available for sale...    (1,728)    (2,637)
  Retained earnings...............................................................    33,992     26,693
                                                                                     -------    -------
     Total stockholders' equity...................................................    62,552     54,344
                                                                                     -------    -------
     Total liabilities and stockholders' equity...................................   $82,612    $71,080
                                                                                     -------    -------
                                                                                     -------    -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-44
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
18. PARENT COMPANY--(CONTINUED)
                         CONDENSED STATEMENT OF INCOME
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                FOR THE YEARS ENDED
                                                                                   DECEMBER 31,
                                                                           -----------------------------
                                                                            1997       1996       1995
                                                                           -------    -------    -------
<S>                                                                        <C>        <C>        <C>
                                 INCOME
Dividends from subsidiary...............................................   $   250    $    --    $   354
                                                                           -------    -------    -------
     Total income.......................................................       250         --        354
                                                                           -------    -------    -------
                                EXPENSE
Interest expense in long-term debt to affiliates........................     1,825      1,640      1,741
Miscellaneous expense...................................................       205         --         --
                                                                           -------    -------    -------
     Total expense......................................................     2,030      1,640      1,741
                                                                           -------    -------    -------
Loss before taxes and equity in undistributed net income (loss) of
  subsidiary............................................................    (1,780)    (1,640)    (1,387)
Income tax benefit......................................................        --         --         --
Equity in undistributed net income (loss) of subsidiary.................     9,078      1,334     (1,521)
                                                                           -------    -------    -------
     Net income.........................................................   $ 7,298    $  (306)   $(2,908)
                                                                           -------    -------    -------
                                                                           -------    -------    -------
</TABLE>
 
                       CONDENSED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          FOR THE YEARS ENDED
                                                                                             DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                     -----------------------------
                                                                                      1997       1996       1995
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
<S>                                                                                  <C>        <C>        <C>
                               OPERATING ACTIVITIES
Net income (loss).................................................................   $ 7,298    $  (306)   $(2,908)
  Adjustment to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used for) operating
     activities:
     Equity in undistributed net (income) loss of subsidiary......................    (9,078)    (1,334)     1,521
     Increase in accrued interest payable.........................................        --         --      1,457
     Decrease in dividends payable................................................        --         --        417
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
       Net cash (used for) provided by operating activities.......................    (1,780)    (1,640)       487
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
                               INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Capital contribution to subsidiary................................................    (1,500)        --         --
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
       Net cash used in investing activities......................................    (1,500)        --         --
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
                               FINANCING ACTIVITIES
Long-term debt to affiliates issued...............................................     1,500         --         --
Long-term debt to affiliates repaid...............................................        --         --       (500)
Increase in capitalized interest component of long-term debt to affiliates........     1,825      1,640         --
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
       Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities........................     3,325      1,640       (500)
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents..............................        45         --        (13)
Cash and cash equivalents beginning of year.......................................        11         11         24
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
Cash and cash equivalents end of year.............................................   $    56    $    11    $    11
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
                                                                                     -------    -------    -------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-45
<PAGE>
                              UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
19. LEGISLATION ENACTED IN 1996
 
     Legislation was enacted in 1996 to recapitalize the FDIC's Savings
Association Insurance Fund (SAIF). Under this legislation, all institutions with
SAIF-insured deposits, including the Company's subsidiary United, were required
to pay a one-time assessment to recapitalize this insurance fund. For the
United, this assessment was approximately $7.7 million, which resulted in a
charge against 1996 earnings. This assessment was tax deductible and is expected
to substantially reduce the level of future periodic SAIF assessments paid by
United.
 
20. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
 
     On March 30, 1998, the Company changed its name from USB Holdings, Inc. to
UCBH Holdings, Inc.
 
21. EARNINGS PER SHARE
 
     The following is a reconciliation of the numerators and denominator of the
basic and diluted earnings per share:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997, 1996 AND 1995
                                                              -------------------------------------------
                                                                INCOME           SHARES         PER SHARE
                                                              (NUMERATOR)     (DENOMINATOR)      AMOUNT
                                                              -----------     -------------     ---------
<S>                                                           <C>             <C>               <C>
(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)
1997:
Basic:
     Net income............................................     $ 7,299          6,000,000       $  1.22
Effect of long-term debt to affiliates.....................       1,077          1,974,000
                                                              -----------     -------------
Diluted:
     Net income and assumed conversions....................     $ 8,376          7,974,000       $  1.05
                                                              -----------     -------------
                                                              -----------     -------------
1996:
Basic:
     Net loss..............................................     ($  306)         6,000,000       ($ 0.05)
Effect of long-term debt to affiliates.....................         968          1,974,000
                                                              -----------     -------------
Diluted:
     Net income and assumed conversions....................     $   662          7,974,000       ($ 0.05)
                                                              -----------     -------------
                                                              -----------     -------------
1995:
Basic:
     Net loss..............................................     ($2,908)         6,000,000       ($ 0.48)
Effect of long-term debt to affiliates.....................       1,027          1,974,000
Diluted:
                                                              -----------     -------------
     Net loss and assumed conversions......................     ($1,881)         7,974,000       ($ 0.48)
                                                              -----------     -------------
                                                              -----------     -------------
</TABLE>
 
     For the years ended December 31, 1996 and 1995, the assumed conversions of
long-term debt to affiliates would be considered anti-dilutive. Accordingly,
diluted loss per share for these periods is equal to basic loss per share.
 
                                      F-46

<PAGE>


                               -------------------

                                TABLE OF CONTENTS
   
                                                                          PAGE
                                                                          ----
Summary.................................................................
Selected Consolidated Financial Data....................................
Risk Factors............................................................
The Private Offerings and the Redemption Transactions...................
Use of Proceeds.........................................................
Dividends and Market for Common Stock...................................
Consolidated Statements of Operations...................................
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
    Condition and Results of Operations.................................
Business................................................................
Supervision and Regulation..............................................
Management of the Company and the Bank..................................
Description of Capital Stock of the Company.............................
Restrictions on Acquisition.............................................
Anti-Takeover Effects of the Company's
    Certificate Of Incorporation and Bylaws and
    Management Remuneration.............................................
Registration Rights.....................................................
Selling Holders.........................................................
Plan of Distribution....................................................
Shares Eligible for Future Sale.........................................
Experts.................................................................
Legal Matters...........................................................
Additional Information..................................................
Index to Consolidated Financial Statements..............................
    


<PAGE>


                                     PART II
                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 13.  Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution.(1)

The following statement sets forth the estimated amount of expenses (other than
the underwriting discounts and commissions) to be incurred in connection with
the issuance and distribution of the securities being registered.





SEC filing fee(1).............................................         $ 41,300
Exchange listing fee(1).......................................           40,833
Printing and distribution.....................................           25,000
Legal fees and expenses ......................................          150,000
Accounting fees and expenses..................................           50,000
Blue Sky fees and expenses....................................            5,000
Miscellaneous.................................................            2,867
                                                                       ---------
TOTAL.........................................................         $315,000
                                                                       =========

- --------------------
(1)  Actual expenses based upon the registration of 9,333,333 shares at $15.00
     per share. All other expenses are estimated.


Item 14.  Indemnification of Directors and Officers.

In accordance with the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware (being
Chapter 1 of Title 8 of the Delaware Code), Articles 10 and 11 of the
Registrant's Certificate of Incorporation provide as follows:

TENTH:

A. Each person who was or is made a party or is threatened to be made a party to
or is otherwise involved in any action, suit or proceeding, whether civil,
criminal, administrative or investigative (hereinafter a "proceeding"), by
reason of the fact that he or she is or was a Director or an Officer of the
Corporation or is or was serving at the request of the Corporation as a
Director, Officer, employee or agent of another corporation or of a partnership,
joint venture, trust or other enterprise, including service with respect to an
employee benefit plan (hereinafter an "indemnitee"), whether the basis of such
proceeding is alleged action in an official capacity as a Director, Officer,
employee or agent, or in any other capacity while serving as a Director,
Officer, employee or agent, shall be indemnified and held harmless by the
Corporation to the fullest extent authorized by the Delaware General Corporation
Law, as the same exists or may hereafter be amended (but, in the case of any
such amendment, only to the extent that such amendment permits the Corporation
to provide broader indemnification rights than such law permitted the
Corporation to provide prior to such amendment), against all expense, liability
and loss (including attorneys' fees, judgments, fines, ERISA excise


                                      II-1
<PAGE>



taxes or penalties and amounts paid in settlement) reasonably incurred or
suffered by such indemnitee in connection therewith; provided, however, that,
except as provided in Section C hereof with respect to proceedings to enforce
rights to indemnification, the Corporation shall indemnify any such indemnitee
in connection with a proceeding (or part thereof) initiated by such indemnitee
only if such proceeding (or part thereof) was authorized by the Board of
Directors of the Corporation.

B. The right to indemnification conferred in Section A of this Article TENTH
shall include the right to be paid by the Corporation the expenses incurred in
defending any such proceeding in advance of its final disposition (hereinafter
an "advancement of expenses"); provided, however, that, if the Delaware General
Corporation Law requires, an advancement of expenses incurred by an indemnitee
in his or her capacity as a Director or Officer (and not in any other capacity
in which service was or is rendered by such indemnitee, including, without
limitation, services to an employee benefit plan) shall be made only upon
delivery to the Corporation of an undertaking (hereinafter an "undertaking"), by
or on behalf of such indemnitee, to repay all amounts so advanced if it shall
ultimately be determined by final judicial decision from which there is no
further right to appeal (hereinafter a "final adjudication") that such
indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified for such expenses under this
Section or otherwise. The rights to indemnification and to the advancement of
expenses conferred in Sections A and B of this Article TENTH shall be contract
rights and such rights shall continue as to an indemnitee who has ceased to be a
Director, Officer, employee or agent and shall inure to the benefit of the
indemnitee's heirs, executors and administrators.

C. If a claim under Section A or B of this Article TENTH is not paid in full by
the Corporation within sixty days after a written claim has been received by the
Corporation, except in the case of a claim for an advancement of expenses, in
which case the applicable period shall be twenty days, the indemnitee may at any
time thereafter bring suit against the Corporation to recover the unpaid amount
of the claim. If successful in whole or in part in any such suit, or in a suit
brought by the Corporation to recover an advancement of expenses pursuant to the
terms of an undertaking, the indemnitee shall be entitled to be paid also the
expenses of prosecuting or defending such suit. In (i) any suit brought by the
indemnitee to enforce a right to indemnification hereunder (but not in a suit
brought by the indemnitee to enforce a right to an advancement of expenses) it
shall be a defense that, and (ii) in any suit by the Corporation to recover an
advancement of expenses pursuant to the terms of an undertaking the Corporation
shall be entitled to recover such expenses upon a final adjudication that, the
indemnitee has not met any applicable standard for indemnification set forth in
the Delaware General Corporation Law. Neither the failure of the Corporation
(including its Board of Directors, independent legal counsel, or its
stockholders) to have made a determination prior to the commencement of such
suit that indemnification of the indemnitee is proper in the circumstances
because the indemnitee has met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in
the Delaware General Corporation Law, nor an actual determination by the
Corporation (including its Board of Directors, independent legal counsel, or its
stockholders) that the indemnitee has not met such applicable standard of
conduct, shall create a presumption that the indemnitee has not met the
applicable standard of conduct or, in the case of such a suit brought by the
indemnitee, be a defense to such suit. In any suit brought by the indemnitee to
enforce a right to indemnification or to an advancement of expenses hereunder,
or by the Corporation to recover an advancement of expenses pursuant to the
terms of an undertaking, the burden of proving that the indemnitee is not
entitled to be indemnified, or to such advancement of expenses under this
Article TENTH or otherwise shall be on the Corporation.

D. The rights to indemnification and to the advancement of expenses conferred in
this Article TENTH shall not be exclusive of any other right which any person
may have or hereafter acquire under any statute, the


                                      II-2
<PAGE>



Corporation's Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws, agreement, vote of
stockholders or Disinterested Directors or otherwise.

E. The Corporation may maintain insurance, at its expense, to protect itself and
any Director, Officer, employee or agent of the Corporation or subsidiary or
Affiliate or another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other
enterprise against any expense, liability or loss, whether or not the
Corporation would have the power to indemnify such person against such expense,
liability or loss under the Delaware General Corporation Law.

F. The Corporation may, to the extent authorized from time to time by the Board
of Directors, grant rights to indemnification and to the advancement of expenses
to any employee or agent of the Corporation to the fullest extent of the
provisions of this Article TENTH with respect to the indemnification and
advancement of expenses of Directors and Officers of the Corporation.

ELEVENTH:

A Director of this Corporation shall not be personally liable to the Corporation
or its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a
Director, except for liability: (i) for any breach of the Director's duty of
loyalty to the Corporation or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not
in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of
law, (iii) under Section 174 of the Delaware General Corporation Law, or (iv)
for any transaction from which the Director derived an improper personal
benefit. If the Delaware General Corporation Law is amended to authorize
corporate action further eliminating or limiting the personal liability of
Directors, then the liability of a Director of the Corporation shall be
eliminated or limited to the fullest extent permitted by the Delaware General
Corporation Law, as so amended.

Any repeal or modification of the foregoing paragraph by the stockholders of the
Corporation shall not adversely affect any right or protection of a Director of
the Corporation existing at the time of such repeal or modification.

Item 15.  Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

In accordance with Item 701 of Regulation S-K, the following information is
presented with respect to securities sold by the Registrant within the past
three years which were not registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended ("Securities Act"):

     (a)  On April 17, 1998, the Registrant sold in a private placement an
          aggregate of 9.3 million share of its common stock, par value $.01 per
          share ("Common Stock"). Additionally, on that date, UCBH Trust Co.
          (the "Trust"), a statutory business trust formed under the laws of the
          State of Delaware and sponsored by the Registrant, sold $30 million
          aggregate liquidation amount of its 9 3/8% Capital Securities
          (liquidation amount $1,000 per Capital Security) (the "Capital
          Securities"). The proceeds from the sale of the Capital Securities and
          938 of the Common Securities of the Trust to the Registrant (together,
          the "Trust Securities") were used to purchase $30,928,000 principal
          amount of the Registrant's 9 3/8% Junior Subordinated Deferrable
          Interest Debentures due May 1, 2028.



                                      II-3
<PAGE>



     (b)  Sandler O'Neill & Partners, L.P. ("Sandler O'Neill") acted as
          Placement Agent for the Registrant and the Trust in connection with
          the private placement transaction. The Common Stock and the Capital
          Securities were offered and sold to institutional and accredited
          investors.

     (c)  The Registrant's Common Stock was sold for an aggregate price of $140
          million. The Trust's Capital Securities were sold for an aggregate
          price of $30 million. Sandler O'Neill received an aggregate of $11.5
          million as compensation in the transaction, plus reimbursement of
          expenses.

     (d)  Based upon representations of the offerees and purchasers, the Common
          Stock and the Capital Securities were offered and sold in reliance
          upon an exemption from registration under Section 4(2) of the
          Securities Act and in compliance with Rules 502 and 506 promulgated
          thereunder.

     (e)  Not applicable.

     (f)  Not applicable.


Item 16.  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

The exhibits and financial statement schedules filed as a part of this
Registration Statement are as follows:

(a) List of Exhibits (Filed herewith unless otherwise noted)

   
<TABLE>

<S>      <C>                                                                        
3.1      Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of UCBH Holdings, Inc.*
3.2      Bylaws of UCBH Holdings, Inc.*
4.0      Form of Stock Certificate of UCBH Holdings, Inc.*
4.1      Purchase Agreement among UCBH Holdings, Inc., Sandler O'Neill and the Purchasers named
         therein, dated April 13, 1998*
4.2      Registration Rights Agreement between UCBH Holdings, Inc., Sandler O'Neill and the Purchasers
         named therein, dated April 13, 1998*
5.0      Opinion of Patton Boggs LLP re: legality*
10.1     Employment Agreement between United Commercial Bank and Tommy S. Wu*
10.2     Employment Agreement between UCBH Holdings, Inc. and Tommy S. Wu*
10.3     Form of Termination and Change in Control Agreement between United
         Commercial Bank and certain executive officers*
10.4     Form of Termination and Change in Control Agreement between UCBH Holdings, Inc. and certain
         executive officers*
10.5     UCBH Holdings, Inc. 1998 Stock Option Plan*
23.1     Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
23.2     Consent of Patton Boggs LLP (included in Exhibit 5.0)*
24.1     Powers of Attorney (located on the signature page hereto)*
27.0     Financial Data Schedule
</TABLE>
- ----------
* Previously filed.
    
                                      II-4
<PAGE>



(b)  Financial Statement Schedules

All schedules have been omitted as not applicable or not required under the
rules of Regulation S-X.

Item 17.  Undertakings.

          The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes:

          (1)  To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being
               made, a post-effective amendment to this Registration Statement:

               (i)  To include any Prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of
                    the Securities Act of 1933;

               (ii) To reflect in the Prospectus any facts or events arising
                    after the effective date of the Registration Statement (or
                    the most recent post-effective amendment thereof) which,
                    individually or in the aggregate, represent a fundamental
                    change in the information set forth in the Registration
                    Statement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any increase or
                    decrease in volume of securities offered (if the total
                    dollar value of securities offered would not exceed that
                    which was registered) and any deviation from the low or high
                    end of the estimated maximum offering range may be reflected
                    in the form of prospectus filed with the Commission pursuant
                    to Rule 424(b) if, in the aggregate, the changes in volume
                    and price represent no more than a 20 percent change in the
                    maximum aggregate offering price set forth in the
                    "Calculation of Registration Fee" table in the effective
                    registration statement;

              (iii) To include any material information with respect to the
                    plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the
                    Registration Statement or any material change to such
                    information in the Registration Statement;

          (2)  That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the
               Securities Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall
               be deemed to be a new Registration Statement relating to the
               securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities
               at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering
               thereof.

          (3)  To remove from registration by means of a post-effective
               amendment any of the securities being registered which remain
               unsold at the termination of the Offering.

         Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities
Act of 1933 may be permitted to trustees, officers and controlling persons of
the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the
Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange
Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act
and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification
against such liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses
incurred or paid by a trustee, officer or controlling person of the Registrant
in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
trustee, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being
registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public
policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of
such issue.


                                      II-5
<PAGE>


CONFORMED
                                   SIGNATURES
   
         Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the
Registrant has duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of San
Francisco, State of California, on September 1, 1998.
    
UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.

By:  /s/ Tommy S. Wu
     -------------------------------------
     Tommy S. Wu
     President and Chief Executive Officer

       
         Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this
Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the
capacities and on the dates indicated.
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
      Name                                                                              Date
      ----                                                                              ----

<S>                                         <C>                                        <C> 
/s/ Tommy S. Wu                             President, Chief Executive Officer and     September 1, 1998
- ------------------------------------        Director (principal executive officer)
Tommy S. Wu                                 


/s/ Jonathan H. Downing                     Senior Vice President, Chief               September 1, 1998
- ------------------------------------        Financial Officer, Treasurer and  
Jonathan H. Downing                         Director (principal accounting and
                                            financial officer)                
                                            


                  *                         Director                                   
- ------------------------------------ 
Robert Fell


                  *                         Director                                   
- ------------------------------------ 
Sau-wing Lam


                  *                         Director                                   
- ------------------------------------ 
Godwin Wong
</TABLE>

- -------------
* Signed pursuant to a power of attorney filed with the Commission as Exhibit
  24.1 on July 1, 1998.
    
                                      II-6


<PAGE>



                               TABLE OF CONTENTS

List of Exhibits (Filed herewith unless otherwise noted)
   
<TABLE>

<S>      <C>                                                                        
3.1      Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of UCBH Holdings, Inc.*
3.2      Bylaws of UCBH Holdings, Inc.*
4.0      Form of Stock Certificate of UCBH Holdings, Inc.*
4.1      Purchase Agreement among UCBH Holdings, Inc., Sandler O'Neill and the Purchasers named
         therein, dated April 13, 1998*
4.2      Registration Rights Agreement between UCBH Holdings, Inc., Sandler O'Neill and the Purchasers
         named therein, dated April 13, 1998*
5.0      Opinion of Patton Boggs LLP re: legality*
10.1     Employment Agreement between United Commercial Bank and Tommy S. Wu*
10.2     Employment Agreement between UCBH Holdings, Inc. and Tommy S. Wu*
10.3     Form of Termination and Change in Control Agreement between United Commercial Bank and 
         certain executive officers*
10.4     Form of Termination and Change in Control Agreement between UCBH Holdings, Inc. and certain
         executive officers*
10.5     UCBH Holdings, Inc. 1998 Stock Option Plan*
23.1     Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
23.2     Consent of Patton Boggs LLP (included in Exhibit 5.0)*
24.1     Powers of Attorney (located on the signature page hereto)*
27.0     Financial Data Schedule
</TABLE>
- ----------
* Previously filed.
    



                                                                    Exhibit 23.1

                       CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS

We hereby consent to the use in the Prospectus constituting part of this
Pre-effective Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 of our
report dated March 30, 1998, relating to the financial statements of UCBH
Holdings, Inc., which appears in such Prospectus. We also consent to the
reference to us under the heading "Experts" in such Prospectus.



/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
- ------------------------------
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

San Francisco, California
September 1, 1998

<TABLE> <S> <C>


<ARTICLE>                                            9
<LEGEND>
     This schedule contains summary financial information extracted from the
financial statements included in this Form S-1 and is qualified in its entirety
by reference to such financial statements.
</LEGEND>
<CIK>                         0001061580         
<NAME>                        UCBH HOLDINGS, INC.
<MULTIPLIER>                                     1,000
<CURRENCY>                                U.S. Dollars
       
<S>                             <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                    6-MOS
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                          DEC-31-1998
<PERIOD-START>                             JAN-01-1998
<PERIOD-END>                               JUN-30-1998
<EXCHANGE-RATE>                                      1
<CASH>                                          15,855
<INT-BEARING-DEPOSITS>                               0
<FED-FUNDS-SOLD>                                     0
<TRADING-ASSETS>                                     0
<INVESTMENTS-HELD-FOR-SALE>                    401,556
<INVESTMENTS-CARRYING>                         173,754
<INVESTMENTS-MARKET>                           168,258
<LOANS>                                      1,272,151
<ALLOWANCE>                                    (13,207)
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                               1,910,379
<DEPOSITS>                                   1,474,270
<SHORT-TERM>                                    96,000
<LIABILITIES-OTHER>                             10,000
<LONG-TERM>                                    232,000
                                0
                                          0
<COMMON>                                            93
<OTHER-SE>                                      98,016
<TOTAL-LIABILITIES-AND-EQUITY>               1,910,379
<INTEREST-LOAN>                                 47,954
<INTEREST-INVEST>                               10,237
<INTEREST-OTHER>                                     0
<INTEREST-TOTAL>                                58,191
<INTEREST-DEPOSIT>                              31,254
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                              33,759
<INTEREST-INCOME-NET>                           24,432
<LOAN-LOSSES>                                    1,401
<SECURITIES-GAINS>                                 307
<EXPENSE-OTHER>                                 17,294
<INCOME-PRETAX>                                  7,469
<INCOME-PRE-EXTRAORDINARY>                       7,469
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                      0
<CHANGES>                                            0
<NET-INCOME>                                     4,399
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                     0.60
<EPS-DILUTED>                                     0.56
<YIELD-ACTUAL>                                    7.37
<LOANS-NON>                                      9,056
<LOANS-PAST>                                         0
<LOANS-TROUBLED>                                     0
<LOANS-PROBLEM>                                 20,717
<ALLOWANCE-OPEN>                                12,142
<CHARGE-OFFS>                                      346
<RECOVERIES>                                        10
<ALLOWANCE-CLOSE>                               13,207
<ALLOWANCE-DOMESTIC>                            13,207
<ALLOWANCE-FOREIGN>                                  0
<ALLOWANCE-UNALLOCATED>                          5,023
        


</TABLE>


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission